Handbook of Ship Calculations, Construction and Operation
Handbook of Ship Calculations, Construction and Operation
Handbook of Ship Calculations, Construction and Operation
CALCULATIONS
CONSTRUCTION
and OPERATION
CHARLES H.HUGHES
HANDBOOK OF
SHIP CALCULATIONS,
OFFICERS, SHIP
BY
CHARLES
H.
HUGHES
- >
1917
Copyright, 1917, bt
D.
PREFACE
This
handbook
has
been
Marine Insurance.
on Ship Calcula-
on
Machinery, valuable data on the overhauling of boilers, on indicator cards, on the operating of pumps, condensers and motors,
and many other practical subjects. They will find useful also
the sections on Loading and Stowing of Cargoes, Ship Machinery,
and many other subjects.
will find
sizes of
different classes
and
their
the same, the text contains frequent special references to warships, as on the subject of electric propulsion, electric steering
gears, electric winches, etc.
To
Preface
vi
any other published work. The verj^ latest marine practice is given,
and such subjects as electric propulsion, geared turbines, Diesel
engines, and oil fuel are fully treated, as are also recent and special
types of construction, such as tankers, battle cruisers, submarine
chasers, and submarines.
The handbook represents many years of collection and classification of material, assembled primarily for the writer's
everyday
use.
works consulted and used, the writer wishes to make here a general
acknowledgment of his indebtedness to many other workers in the
He wishes to thank particularly the editors of Intermarine field.
national Marine Engineering and Shipping Illustrated. Prof. H. E.
Everett kindly revised the section on Freeboard. Mr. J. C. Craven
checked Structural Details, while other friends in the trade read over
various sections: To Mr. F. G. Wickware, of D. Appleton and Co.,
he is indebted for the typographical arrangement and many suggestions.
Chas. H. Hughes.
New
York,
June
26, 1917.
CONTENTS
(See also Index)
SECTION
4
5
6
7
8
8
9
10
Board Measure
Water, Weights of Different Units of
Feet Board Measure in Timber
Inches and Fractions in Decimals of a Foot
Water Conversion Table
Composition of Salt Water
Specific Gravities and Weights of Materials
Cubic Feet per Ton or Stowage Sizes of Materials
Shipping Weights of Lumber
Weights of Miscellaneous Units of Different Products
!
Bundling Schedule
of
11
12
13
16
18
19
Pipe
Barrels, Sizes of
Horse Powers
Equivalent Values of Mechanical and Electrical Units
Logarithms
Powers and Roots of Numbers
Circumferences and Areas of Circles
Geometrical Propositions
Circle and Ellipse, Formulae pertaining to
Areas of Plane Figures and Surfaces of Solids
Volumes of Solids
Trigonometry^-Trigonometric Functions
Oblique Triangles
Trigonometric Formulae
Natural Sines, Cosines, etc., Table of
Moment of Inertia, Radius of Gyration and Center of Gravity
Center of Gravity of a Cross Section of a Ship
Center of Gravity of a Water Plane
20
20
22
23
24
25
25
26
26
27
28
29
29
31
32
33
36
39
41
42
43
50
50
51
52
Properties of Sections
vii
Table of Contents
viii
section n
STRENGTH OF MATERIALS
Definitions
PAGE
Stress, Strain, Tension, etc
70
71
73
74
75
Beam Formula
76
Beams Under Various Loading Conditions
78
Columns Formulae for
84
and I Columns
Safe Loads for
86
Safe Loads for Square and Round Wood Columns
87
Safe Loads for Wrought Iron Pipe, Strong and Extra Strong Columns ....
88
89
Torsional Stresses
90
Springs
90
Tubes, Pipes and Cylinders, Formulae for
91
Bursting and Collapsing Pressures of Wrought Iron Tubes
91
Ship Fittings, Strength of
93
Shearing and Tensile Strength of Bolts
?
94
Tests of Hooks
95
Tests of Shackles
95
Tests of Eye Bolts
Tests of Hoist Hooks
96
97
Tests of Turnbuckles
97
Formulae for Davits
98
Stresses in Cranes, Derricks and Shear Legs
101
Rivet Heads and Points
102
Proportions of Rivets
102
Diameters of
102
for
Lengths
Ordering
103
Signs for Rivets
104
Shearing and Tensile Strength of Steel Rivets
Formulae for Riveted Joints
105
107
Shearing Value of Rivets and Bearing Value of Riveted Plates
Reduction of Diameters to Inches
108
109
Weight of Cone Head Rivets
Number of Cone Head Rivets in 100 lbs
110
Timber, Strength of
Beams Neutral Axes, Bending Moment, Shearing Stresses, etc
.
SECTION
III
SHIPBUILDING MATERIALS
Steel
and Iron
Ill
Steel, Methods of Manufacture
112
Carbon, Manganese, Nickel and Alloy Steels
Structural Steel Lloyd's, Am. Bureau of Shipping and Am. Soc. of Testing
114
Materials, Requirements
117
Rivet Steel
118
Cast Steel
Table of Contents
ix
PAGE
Iron
Wrought
119
120
120
Iron
Cast Iron
Malleable Iron
121
121
121
Hundredths of an Inch
Weights
Standard Gauges United States and Great Britain for Sheets and Plates
Diamond Checkered Plates
Weights of Sheets and Plates of Steel, Copper and Brass (Birmingham Wire
Gauge)
Weights of Sheets and Plates of Steel, Copper and Brass (American or Brown
and Sharpe Gauge)
Sizes of Steel Plates and Heads
Sizes and Properties of Structural Shapes
Weights and Areas of Square and Round Bars, and Circumferences of Round
122
123
125
of Steel Plates in
Bars
Weights
126
127
128
129
143
Bars
149
Copper
Aluminum
Zinc
Lead
Tin
Brasses
Muntz Metal
Naval Brass
Alloys
Wood
Sawing and Seasoning
Hardness of Wood, How Measured
Table of Relative Hardness of Soft Woods
Table of Relative Hardness of Hard Woods
Hard Wood
Soft
Wood
157
158
158
159
159
160
Sizes
Sizes
Characteristics,
Weights
and
Specific
Gravities of
Woods used
building
in Ship-
160
Oakum
162
Caulking Cotton
162
162
162
163
Boiler Covering
163
Portland Cement
Insulating Materials
Magnesia,
Wool
Table of Contents
PAGE
164
164
165
Cylinder Covering
Tests of Insulating Materials
Relative Value of Non-Conducting Materials
SECTION IV
SHIP CALCULATIONS
Lengths
Breadth
Depth
Draft
Displacement
Displacement Curve
Deadweight
Registry
Tonnage
Cubic Capacity
of
Immersion
Wetted Surface
Center of Buoyancy
,
Transverse Metacenter
Metacentric Heights
Moment of Inertia of a Water Plane about
Displacement Sheet
Curves of Stability
its
Center Line
'
Notes on Stability
Trim
Lines
Quantity of Water That Will Flow Into a Ship Through a Hole in Her Side.
Compartment Flooded, Calculation of Trim, by Trim Lines
Compartment Flooded, Calculation of Trim, by Mean Sinkage
Center of Gravity of a Vessel, Fore and Aft Position of
Center of Gravity of a Vessel, Vertical Position of
Heights of the Center of Gravity above the Base
Heights of the Metacenter above the Base
Effects of
To Find
Moving Weights
Freeboard
Freeboard
Freeboard
Freeboard
Freeboard
Moving Weights
Calculations
Calculations for a Shelter
Deck Steamer
Notes
Markings
Powering Vessels
Approximate I. H. P. to Propel a Vessel
Effective Horse Power
Towing
Engine Revolutions to Drive a Vessel at a Given Speed
Formula for Estimating Speed of a Motor Boat
166
166
167
167
168
169
169
169
169
170
170
171
172
172
173
174
176
177
183
189
190
190
192
195
195
196
200
202
202
202
203
204
205
213
218
220
221
222
222
223
223
224
224
Table of Contents
xi
PAGE
Resistance
Law
of
225
226
227
227
228
229
231
232
233
Comparison
Launching
Launching Ways
Launching Calculations
Releasing and Checking Devices
Launching Data
Declivity of Ways and Launching Velocity
SECTION V
HULL CONSTRUCTION
and Organizations Governing Shipping
Merchant Vessels
Classification Societies
Types
War
of
Vessels
Armor
Armament
Types of War Vessels
Systems of Construction
Frames
Reverse Frames
Merchant
of
Vessels.
Shell Plating
Double Bottom
Keelsons and Longitudinals
Keels
...
Pillars
Stringers
Bulkheads
Wood
Vessels
Curve
Curve
of
Buoyancy
of
Loads
Moment
of Inertia Calculations
"
234
238
238
244
245
247
253
255
256
258
261
263
264
264
265
266
268
268
268
272
275
277
277
278
279
282
284
287
290
294
294
296
296
297
298
298
Table of Contents
xii
PAGE
Curve
of
Bending Moments
Machinery
Equipment
Lumber Steamers
Trawlers
Dredges
Shallow Draft Steamers
Tunnel Vessels
299
300
301
301
302
303
304
305
306
308
308
309
310, 311
312
314
316
317
318
319
320
320
327
327
327
328
330
330
331
332
334
334
335
336
337
337
338
340
,
Boilers
Estimates, Preparing
Labor Costs
SECTION VI
MACHINERY
Steam
Definitions British Thermal Unit, Mechanical Equivalent of Heat, Calorie..
Superheated Steam
Dry Steam
Wet Steam
Steam Table
'
Properties
of
Saturated Steam
,,,,,,,
341
342
343
343
343
343
344
Table of Contents
xiii
PAGE
Fuels
Coal Required to Evaporate one Pound of Water
Coal Consumption
Coal or Oil Consumptioon
Evaporation per Pound of Combustible
Heat Values of Coal
Calorific Value of Coal from its Chemical Analysis
Sizes of Coals
Heat Values of Wood
349
349
350
350
351
351
351
352
353
353
of Fire
Temperature
Air Required
for
Combustion
of Fuel
Oil
Products
Fuel Oil, Table of Beaume" Gravity, Specific Gravity,
Beaum6 Gravity
Specific Gravities and Weights of Oils
Definitions Flash Point, Fire Point, Viscosity, etc
its
Heat Values
of Oil
Burning Systems
etc.,
of
353
354
355
355
356
356
356
357
358
360
Boilers
Types
of Boilers
Locomotive Boilers
Leg Boilers
Safety Valve
Stop Valve
Steam Gauges
Water Gauges and Cocks
Boiler Circulators
Fusible Plugs
Injectors and Inspirators
Hydrometer
Superheaters
Ash Ejectors
363
363
364
366
366
368
370
371
371
373
374
375
376
376
377
377
378
378
378
379
379
379
380
381
382
384
Table of Contents
xiv
PAGE
385
385
386
386
387
Boiler Operating
Firing
Out
Boilers
'.
Draft
389
389
390
390
391
392
393
Systems
Measurement
Draft
Air
Pressure Escaping into the Atmosphere
of
under
Velocity
Air Required
,
Blowers
Forced Draft Installations
Frictional Resistance of Stack
of
of
'
Mean
Shafting
Cylinders
Connecting
Piston
Rod
Rod
Pistons
Bearing Surfaces
Engine Fittings
Thrust and Line Shafting Bearings
Engine Room Floors
Operating
Trials.
394
394
395
396
397
399
400
401
402
404
404
405
405
406
410
411
411
412
413
413
414
414
414
414
418
419
419
421
Propellers
Table of Propellers
Formulae for Slip, Speed, Revolutions and Pitch
Rule for Finding Pitch of a Propeller
424
425
426
428
428
Table of Contents
xv
PAGE
Rule
for
-.
Weights of Propellers
Speed Table, When Pkch, Slip and R. P. M. Are Given
429
429
429
430
431
432
433
Paddle Wheels
Breadth of Floats, etc
Formula
436
436
437
Steam Turbines
Turbines
Types
Geared Turbines
Trials of Geared Turbines and Reciprocating Engines
Turbo-electric Propulsion
Comparative Performance of Different Systems of Propulsion
of
Efficiency
Steam Consumption
Weights
Calculation of Horse Power
Steam per Shaft Horse Power
Auxiliaries
Steam Plant
Auxiliaries
Thermodynamics of Condensers
Types of Condensers
Surface Condensers
Operating
Pump
Evaporators
Pumps, Types
of
Reciprocating Pumps
Centrifugal Pumps
Pumps installed in a Freight Steamer
Installing
439
442
443
444
445
446
446
446
447
448
448
449
449
450
452
453
454
455
456
456
457
459
459
462
462
463
464
465
467
470
470
474
477
477
Table of Contents
xvi
PAGE
Internal Combustion Engines
478
479
480
Fuels
Operation
Horse Power Formula
Table of Engines (Electric Ignition)
Carburetors and Vaporizers
481
Starting
Reverse Gears
Lubricating Systems
Valves
Ignition Systems
Timers and Distributors
Magnetos
Spark Plugs
Motor Trouble
Hot Bulb Engines
Diesel Engines
of Diesel Engines, Steam Engines and Turbines
General Features of Diesel Engines
Comparison
Operation
Types
of Diesel
Engines
and
482
482
483
484
484
486
487
489
490
491
492
495
495
496
498
501
506
Fittings
Trade Terms
507
Tables of Standard, Extra Strong, and Double Extra Strong Wrought Iron
508, 509
Pipe
Boiler Tubes
510, 511, 512
513
Copper Tubes
Brass and Copper Tubes
514
518
Brass and Copper Pipe
Formula for Working Pressure
518
519
Copper Tubes
519
Bending Pipes and Tubes
Flow of Water through Pipes
520
521
Comparative Areas of Pipes
522
Flanges
Bolt and Pipe Threads
524
Gaskets
526
526
Nipples and Couplings
Unions
526
Materials for Piping Systems
527
528
Valves, Cocks and Fittings
SECTION
VII
ELECTRICITY
Definitions Ohm, Ampere, Volt, Coulomb, etc
Voltage
Wires, Calculation of Size of
Tables of Sizes of Wires
531
532
533
534, 535, 536, 537
Table of Contents
xvii
PAGE
. 1 1
Lamps
Searchlights
Primary Batteries
Storage Batteries
Grouping
of Cells
Generating Sets
Windings of Generators
Engine Horse Power
Tables of Direct Connected Sets
Operating Notes
533
539
541
543
543
544
547
559
551
552
553
554
554
557
557
558
558
559
560
561
562
563
564
564
565
SECTION VIII
HEATING, VENTILATION, REFRIGERATION, DRAINAGE, PLUMBING
AND FIRE EXTINGUISHING SYSTEMS
Heat Passing Through a Ship's Side or Bulkhead
Heating Systems
Heating by Steam
Steam Heating Installations
Sizes of Radiators
Square Feet of Radiation for a
Heating Surfaces of Pipes
Heating by Thermotanks
Heating by Electricity
Heating by Special Systems
567
568
568
568
569
570
571
571
573
574
Room
Ventilation
Systems
Rooms
Fans, Types of
.-...-
575
576
576
578
579
579
580
582
Table of Contents
xviii
PAGE
582
583
584
584
585
Ducts
Data on the Escape of Air into the Atmosphere .....'
Duct Areas
Laying Out Ventilating Systems
Loss of Pressure by Friction of Air in Pipes
Refrigeration
587
587
588
591
593
594
594
595
596
596
597
598
599
600
600
600
Drainage
Systems
Main Drain
Auxiliary Drain
U. S. Steamboat-Inspection and Lloyd's Requirements
601
602
603
603
and Fittings
Pipe, Valves
Capacity of
Ammonia Compressors
Plumbing
606
609
609
Fixtures
Waste Lines
Fresh Water Service
Fire Extinguishing
General Requirements
Fire Main (Water)
Sizes of Water Streams
Main (Steam)
Sulphur Dioxide System
Sprinkler Systems
Fire
Fire Alarms
SECTION IX
SHIP EQUIPMENT
Steering Gears
Arrangements
Installations
615
615
616
617
618
Table of Contents
xix
PAGE
Transmission
Tables of Capstans
Towing Machines
Rope, Trade Terms
Hoisting Speeds
Knots and Hitches
Tackles, Types of
Capacities of Lifeboats
Lundin Lifeboats
. ,
620
623
623
624
624
625
626
627
628
628
630
630
631
632
632
633
634
634
636
637
638
640
640
641
642
642
643
644
645
646
646
646
648
648
648
650
652
655
656
657
657
658
659
660
663
665
669
670
671
672
xx
Table of Contents
PAGE
Life Preservers
672
673
673
673
673
676
676
678
679
680
681
682
Buoys
Boats Carried by War Vessels
Boat Davits
Rotating Davits
Pivoted Davits
Quadrant Davits
Heel of a Vessel When Lowering a Boat
Rigs of Vessels
Wireless Equipment
Storm
Oil
Line-carrying
SECTION X
SHIP OPERATING
Loading and Stowing of Cargoes
General Considerations
Oil Cargoes
Bulk
Stability,
etc
Lumber Cargoes
.-.
MACHINERY OPERATING
683
684
685
686
688
688
688
692
693
693
693
694
695
(see Index)
Maintenance
When
Hull
Surveys Are to Be
Shell Plating
Made
696
698
698
698
698
699
699
699
Working
Decks Leaking
Removing of Rubbish fiom Bilges
'.
Galvanic Action
Corrosion in Double Bottom
Sea Valves and Outboard Bearings
.
Docking.
Machinery, Care of
Surveys
Taking Indicator Cards
Care of Boilers
Log to Be Kept by Engineer
700
700
701
701
702
Table of Contents
xxi
PAGE
Ship Chartering 1
Trip Charters
Contracts for the
Time Charter
Charter Forms
Preamble Clause
Movement
of Freight
Delivery
Redelivery
Trading Limits and Insurance Warranties
703
704
704
704
707
707
708
708
708
709
709
709
Marine Insurance
Insurable Value
711
Ship
711
711
711
Freight.
Goods
Policies,
Kinds
Paragraphs in
711
713
.'
of Policies
713
714
715
715
715
715
General Average
Particular Average
Inchmaree Clause
Export and Shipping Terms
Abbreviations and
Authorities
Index
Terms
716
Quoted
718
721
S.
and English)
XXIV
F.P.
HANDBOOK OF
SHIP CALCULATIONS,
Handbook of
Ship Calculations, Construction
and Operation
SECTION
=
=
12 ounces
pennyweight
ounce
1
20 pwts.
Used for weighing
and
gold, silver
pound
ounce
jewels.
Apothecaries' Weight
20 grains
=
=
1 dram
The ounce and pound
3 scruples
8 drams
12 ounces
1 scruple
same
=
=
as in
pound
Troy weight.
Avoirdupois Weight
27.344 grains
16 drams
16 ounces
=
=
=
dram
ounce
pound
2000 pounds
2240 pounds
=
=
Shipping Weight
16 ounces
28 pounds
4 quarters or 112 pounds
20 hundredweight or 1
2240 pounds
j
=
=
=
=
pound
quarter (qr).
hundredweight (cwt.)
t0n (T
/rn
(lb.)
1 short
1
ton
long ton
Measure
Shipping
United States shipping ton
=
=
1 register
1
ton
bushels
=
=
3 feet
5 yards =
12 inches
1
1
yard
rod
40 rods
8 furlongs
or 5280 feet J
1 foot
furlong
mile (statute)
"1
4 inches
= 1
inch; 7.92 inches
1 chain; 10 chains = 1 furlong.
=
mils
Mariner's Measure
6080 feet = 1 nautical mile (knot)
= 1 league
1 cable length
3 knots
=
=
cable length
120 fathoms
960 spans = 720 feet = 219.457
6 feet
120 fathoms
1
=
=
fathom
meters.
circle of
1
U.
S.
1853.25 meters.
1
1853.19 meters.
The knot
.
30
M square yards
=
=
=
generally adopted
is
Square Measure
square foot
square yard
square rod
6080 feet =
the one of 6080 feet.
Time Measure
60 seconds = 1 minute
60 minutes = 1 hour
=
28, 29, 30 or 31 days
in computing interest)
365 days m 1 year
24 hours
7 days
1
calendar
month
366 days
=
=
1
1
day
week
(30 days
1 leap
month
year
MEASURES
Circular Measure
60 seconds
60 minutes
m
=
minute
degree
90 degrees
quadrant
360 degrees
circumference
H X 2 ttR
measure of 180
is
x,
60
-5-,
etc.
An
'
11
Hence the
An
grees
circular
measure of 115
is
^i
may
The
=
\^
10
As
180 for x.
.63
lo
10
180
be reduced to de-
x, or
by substituting
84.
57.2958
by multiplying by 57.2958.
be reduced
2
2
Thus the angle - = o
o
may
38.1972.
Dry Measure
2 pints
quart
4 pecks
bushel
8 quarts
peck
36 bushels
chaldron
One United
law
ft.
By
its
bushel.
The
or 1.032 U. S. bushels.
1.2837 cu.
ft.
Measure
Liquid
=
=
=
4 gills
2 pints
4 quarts
One United
A gallons
31 X
pint
quart
gallon
1 barrel
2 barrels or 63 gallons
1 hogshead
ft.,
The
multiply
by
To
1.2.
1.2.
Metric System
The fundamental
centi
for all
deci
-TTji,
1000, myrie
so on.
10000.
deca
hecto
10,
Thus a millimeter
is
y^
100, kilo
of a meter,
am
The
water weighs
kilogram at 4 C.
Bolivia,
is
Brazil,
specified
by law
Bulgaria,
Chile,
in Argentina,
Austria
Colombia, Denmark
Luxemburg
Mexico, Montenegro, Norway, Peru, Portugal, Roumania, Servia
Siam, Spain, Sweden, Turkey and Uruguay.
Finland, France, Germany, Holland, Hungary, Italy,
'
Linear Measure
10 millimeters
milliliters
1 centiliter
centiliters
deciliters
1 deciliter
liters
decaliters
hectoliters
liter is
=
=
=
=
=
=
1 liter
equal to the
decaliter
hectoliter
1 kiloliter
.61
6.10
61.02
.353
3.53
35.31
volume occupied by
cubic
cubic
cubic
cubic
cubic
cubic
inches
inches
inches
feet
feet
feet
cubic decimeter of
water at 4 C.
Weight
10
10
10
10
10
10
milligrams
centigrams
decigrams
grams
decagrams
hectograms
1000 kilograms
One gram
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
1
1
centigram
decigram
gram
decagram
hectogram
1
1
1
.154
1.54
15.43
154.3
.220
kilogram
metric ton
=
=
grains
grains
grains
grains
pound avoirdupois
2.204 pound avoirdupois
2204.621 pound avoirdupois
Measurement
distance = 1 centimeter
= 1 gram
-
time
Unit of acceleration
=
=
=
second
centimeter in
second
dyne
is
32.185 X 12
- = 981
dynes.
gram =
.3937
Unit of work
Unit of power
=
=
=
h P
'
756
00134 h P
-
ft. lb.
CGS
unit
of
current
electric
the
is
CGS
one-tenth of the
unit.
Board Measure
To
find the
number
board measure
by the breadth in
of feet
feet,
in a stick of timber,
feet,
by the thickness
in inches.
Example.
2
of
a piece of timber 20
ft.
long, 2
ft.
wide by
ins. thick.
20
ft.
To convert board
To convert board
ft.
ins.
What
A
is
1,000,000
12
83f 333 cu
ft .
lb.
per cu.
ft.
38
3,166,654
lb.
Water
cubic foot of fresh water weighs 62.42 lb. at its maximum density
39.1 F.
One cubic foot of salt water weighs 64 lb.
35.88 cubic feet of fresh water weighs one ton (2240 lb.)
35 cubic feet of salt water weighs one ton
One cubic foot of water (fresh or salt) = 7.48 gallons (U. S.)
One gallon (U. S.) of fresh water weighs 8.33 lb.
One gallon (U. S.) of salt water weighs 8.58 lb.
One cubic foot of ice (fresh) weighs 56 lbs., specific gravity .9.
One
BOARD MEASURE
in Feet
Size in Inches
2x4
2x6
2x8
2 x 10
2 x 12
2 x 14
2 x 16
2*x 12
2*x 14
2*x 16
3x6
3x8
3 x 10
3 x 12
3 x 14
3 x 16.
4 x
4 x
4 x
4 x 10
4 x 12
4 x 14
6x6
6x8
6 x 10
6 x 12
6 x 14
6 x 16
8 x
8 x 10
8 x 12
8 x 14
10 x 10
10 x 12
10 x 14
10 x 16
12 x 12
12 x 14
12 x 16
14 x 14
14 x 16
10
12
6?
10
10
12
13*
12
14
16
18
20
13*
16f
16
20
18!
23*
21*
26!
32
24
30
26!
33*
40
29*
36!
44
46*
53*
50
51*
58!
55
20
23J
26|
25
29*
33*
24
28
32
30
35
40
15
18
20
25
30
35
40
24
30
36
42
48
13
16
24
32
26!
33* 40
48
40
46* 56
36
30
48
40
60
50
72
60
84
70
80
96
53* 64
66| 80
96
80
112
93*
83* 100
100 120
116! 140
133* 160
120 144
140 168
160 192
163* 196
186! 224
20
14
9*
28
16
18
36
42
48
45
20
22
24
26
28
30
32
H!
16
24
32
40
17*
26
18!
22
28
21*
32
34!
43*
52
37*
46!
56
20
30
40
60!
65*
74
70
81
48
56
64
60
46! 52* 58* 64* 70
46! 53* 60
66! 73* 80
24
21
30
33
27
36
28
32
36
40
44
48
35
40
45
50
55
60
42
48
60
54
66
72
49
56
63
70
77
84
56
64
80
72
88
96
26 s 29* 32
18! 21* 24
28
32
36
40
44
48
48
37* 42
53* 5S S 64
46! 53* 60
66! 73* 80
56
64
80
88
72
96
84
112
65* 74!
93* 102
42
48
54
60
66
72
56
64
80
72
88
96
70
80
90 100 110 120
84
96 108 120 132 144
98 112 126 140 154 168
112 128 144 160 176 192
74! 85* 96 106! 117* 128
93* 106! 120 133* 146! 160
112 128 144 160 176 192
130! 149* 168 186! 205* 224
116! 133* 150 166! 183* 200
140 160 180 200 220 240
163* 186! 210 233* 256! 280
186! 213* 240 266! 293* 320
168 192 216 240 264 288
196 224 252 280 308 336
224 256 288 320 352 384
228! 261* 294 326! 359* 392
261* 298! 336 373* 410! 448
32!
37*
35
40 5
37*
42!
40
69*
65
75
86!
50
60
70
80
75
42|
53*
64
74!
85*
80
87* 93*
93* 100 106
42
39
45
48
52
56
60
64
65
70
75
80
84
78
90
96
91
98 105 112
104 112 120 128
34
37* 40
42!
52
56
60
64
69* 74! 80
85*
86! 93* 100 106!
104 112 120 128
121* 130! 140 149*
78
84
90
96
104
130
156
182
208
112
140
168
196
224
120
150
180
210
240
208
224
242! 261*
216! 233*
260 280
303*
34C!
312
364
416
326!
373*
336
392
448
424! 457*
485* 522!
240
280
250
300
350
400
360
420
480
490
560
128
160
192
224
256
170!
213*
256
298f
266!
320
373*
426|
384
448
512
522!
597*
Thus a
stick of timber
Foot
in
Inches
and
Fractions
FRESH WATER
Fresh
11
12
Weight and
Gallons of Fresh
Water
Cubic
Weight
in
Gallons
of
a Gallon
Inches in
a Gallon
Cubic
Weight of a cubic
Foot
foot of fresh water,
in a
Pounds
English standard,
6.232102
7.480519
10.00
8.33111
277 .274
231.
Imperial or English
United States
62 .321
lb.
avoirdupois.
Salt Water
The composition
world, but
Pure water
Common
96 2
2.71
54
.
salt
Sulphate of lime
Sulphate of magnesium.
Calcium bicarbonate
Organic matter
08
..
Magnesium chloride
01
Magnesium bromide
About 5 ounces of solid matter are present in one gallon of
water, and this density can be expressed as a fraction thus
solid
matter
5 oz.
5 oz.
16 X 10
1 gal.
water holding it in solution
that is, one part in 32 of sea water is solid matter,
If an American of 1 gal.
lish gallon of 10 lb. is used.
5 oz.
16 X 8.33
12
01
33
salt
1_
if
32
an Eng8.33
lb.,
26.7
Water
is
at its
maximum
down from
maximum density,
it
contracts to 39.1,
its
all solids
and
liquids.
Weights of Materials*
Material
Specific
Weight,
Gravity 1
per cu.
100%
Alcohol,
79
Alum
49
107
..
Aluminum, bronze
Aluminum, cast
Aluminum, sheet
7.7
2.55-2.75
Asphaltum
1.4-1.7
6.7
2.1-2.8
.62-. 65
1.1-1.5
Babbitt metal
Barley
Barytes
Basalt
Bauxite
4.5
2.7-3.2
2.55
Antimony
Asbestos
Ash, white-red
Beech
Bell metal
Benzine
Birch
73-. 75
Bismuth
Bituminous coal (broken)
9.'
Boxwood
74'
.96
8.4-8.7
1.8-2.0
7.4-8.9
Brass, cast-rolled
Brick, common (1000 weigh about 3 J tons)
Bronze, 7.9 to 14% tin
Camphor
32-. 38
Cedar, white-red
Cement, Portland, loose
Chalk
1.8-2.6
Charcoal (piled)
Cherry
Chestnut
Clay, dry
Clay, moist
Coal see anthracite and bituminous.
70
66
Coke
Concrete, cement
cast, rolled
Copper
Cork
Corn
ore, pyrites
478
160
168
47-58
417
153
40
81
456
38
281
184
159
44
503
46
33
608
49
63
534
120
509
62
22
90
137
10-14
42
41
63
110
23-32
stonesand
Copper,
2.2-2.4
8.8-9.0
4.1-4.3
".
144
556
262
156
.25
.48
48
93
30
Dolomite
Earth, dry loose
Earth, packed and moist
2.9
181
Ebony
Elm
1.25
1.47-1.50
Cotton, pressed
Cypress
The
76
96
79
45
.72
specific gravities of solids
and
lb.
ft.
1Q
C.
The weights
Weights of Materials
Material
Continued
Specific
Weight,
Gravity
per cu.
Emery
2.5-2.6
Felspar
Fir,
.51
Flagging
Flax
1.47-1.50
Flour, loose
Flour, pressed
Flint.
.4-. 5
.7-. 8
Gasoline
.66-. 69
2.4-2.6
2.45-2.72
19.25
2.4
2.5
1.9-2.3
Glass, common
Glass, plate or crown
Graphite
Greenheart
straw bales
Hemlock
42-. 52
74-. 84
Hickory
Hornblende
3.
88-. 92
Ice
India rubber
Iron, cast, pig
Iron,
7.2
7.6-7.9
wrought
Ivory
Kerosene
Lance wood
.66
Lead
11.37
7.3
.86-1.02
1.10
Lignum
vitae
2.5
.73
'.
7.2-8.0
3.7
Manganese
Manganese ore
Mahogany, Honduras
Mahogany, Spanish
Maple
Marble
Mercury
Mica
.
.65
13.6
Muntz metal
Nickel.
Nitric acid
Oak,
live
251
159
32
168
93
28
47
164
42
156
161
1205
159
175
131
62 J
2.3
Gypsum
Hay and
lb.
ft.
8.9-9.2
91%
.
1.5
.95
14
159
20
29
49
187
56
58
450
485
114
42
42
710
465
59
83
53-60
165
58
46
475
259
35
53
49
170
849
183
511
565
94
59
Weights of Materials
Material
Specific
Weight,
Gravity
per cu.
65
Olive
Continued
32
Oregon pine
Paper
.51
.70
.87
.79
Petroleum, crude
Petroleum, refined
Phosphate rock
Phosphor bronze
Pine long leaf yellow
Pine short leaf yellow
Pine white
3.2
.70
.6
.41
1.07
21.1
Pitch.
hammered
Plumbago
48
Poplar
Potatoes, piled
Quartz, flint
2.5
Rubber, caoutchouc
Rubber goods
.92
1.-2.
Rye
Salt, granulated, piled
Saltpeter
Sand, dry, loose
Sand, wet
Sandstone
2.2
10.4
2.6
Sulphur
Talc
Tallow
Tar, bituminous
Teak
Tin, cast,
Tin ore
.4
1.53
.
7.8
1.93
2.6
.82
hammered
Walnut, black
Water, fresh
Water, salt
7.2
6.4-7.0
.61
1.
1.02
Wheat
White metal, Babbitt
Wool, pressed
Zinc, cast, rolled
41
etc.
oil
Platinum, cast,
lb.
ft.
1.32
6.9
3.9
57
32
58
54
50
200
537
44
38
26
69
1330
140
30
42
165
59
94
48
48
67
90-105
120
147
92
656
169
27
96
493
.
490
125
169
59
75
52
459
418
38
62.5
64
48
456
82
440
253
Material
Alcohol in casks
Almonds in bags
Almonds in hogsheads.
Aniseed in bags
Apples in boxes
Arrowroot in bags
Arrowroot in boxes
.
Arrowroot in cases
Asbestos in cases
Asphalt
Bacon in
Bananas
cases
Barley in
Barley in
bags
bulk
Beer in hogsheads
Beeswax
Bone meal
Bones, crushed
Bones, loose
Books
Borate of lime
Borax
in cases
empty, in crates
Bran compressed in bales
Bran in bags
Brandy, bottled, in cases
Bottles,
Brandy
in casks
Bread in bulk
Bread in cases
Bricks
Buckwheat
in bags
Butter in kegs or cases
in cases
Candles in boxes
Canvas in bales
Carpets in rolls
Cassia in cases
Camphor
Cellulose
Cement
in barrels
Chalk in barrels
Cheese
Chicory in sacks
Chloride of lime in casks
*
ft.
Constructor.
Cu.
Material
per ton
Cider in casks
Cigars in cases
Cinchona (Peruvian bark)
Cloth goods in cases ....
Cloves in cases
Coal (Admiralty)
Coal (American)
Coal (Newcastle)
Coal (Welsh)
Cocoa in bags
Cocoanuts in bulk
Coffee in bags
Coir yarn in bales
80
70
108
120
90
52
70
50
53
17
65
90
59
47
68
47
93
125
80
54
74
45
60
85
50
50
52
85
80
110
55
80
124
155
22
65
70
50
56
43
80
184
240
40
38
70
60
80
ft.
per ton
65
180
140
87
50
48
,43
45
40
80
140
61
190
Coke
80
Copper, cast
10
10-20
Copper ore
50
Copper sulphate in casks
52
Copperas in casks
85
Copra in cases
270
Cork wood in bales
of
S.
bale
U.
a
Cotton
cotton is 54 ins. by 27 by
24 to 30
ins.
high de-
is
space occupied
25.3
cu.
Average
stowage per ton
Cotton waste
Cowrie shells in bags.
Creosote in casks
Dates
ft.
Earth, loose
Earthenware
in crates.
Fish in boxes
Fish, frozen
Flax
Flour in bags
Flour in barrels
Freestone
Fuel oil
Furs in cases
Ginger
Glass bottles
Glassware in crates
Granite blocks
Gravel, coarse
Grease
G. Simpson.
16
114
170
75
60
43
25
47
95
.60
105
47
60
16
39-40
130
80
85
180
16
23
65
Material
Guano
Gunny bags
Gunpowder
160
70
120
140
100
70
60
85
120
50
Hair, pressed
in barrels
Ham
Hay, compressed
Hay, uncompressed ....
Hemp
Hemp
in bales
seed in bags ....
Herrings in barrels ....
Herrings in boxes
Hides in bales
Hides in barrels
Hops in bales
'.
260
39
72
67
36
Ice
Lead, pig
Lead
pipes,
random
Linseed in bags
Locust beams in bulk.
Logwood
Manure phosphate ....
Maize in bags
Maize in bulk
Marble in slabs
Margarine in tubs
Marl
Matches
Melons
Mutton
90
220
85
57
84
92
45
51
49
17
69
28
120
in boxes
Pitch in barrels
Potatoes in bags
Potatoes in barrels
Prunes in casks
Raisins
Rape seed
Rice in bags
12
Lemons
sizes
about
Leather in bales
Leather in rolls
Oats in bags
Oats in bulk
10
40
70
8
'.
Nails, kegs
Nitrate of soda
Nuts, Brazil, in barrels
Nuts, pistachio, in cases
Oatmeal in sacks
80
45
50
70
25
65
110
Rice meal
Rope
in
Salt in bulk
Salt in barrels
Saltpeter
61
60
49
75
50
67
77
90
60
16
120
50
42
60
45
55
68
52
52
60
48
62
135
66
70
19
Sand, fine
Sand, coarse
Sandstone
20
14
83
125
112
Shellac
13
Sponge
21
32
90
70
65
78
53
55
37
52
36
bags
Sago
Silk in bales
Silk in cases
Slate
Soap in boxes
Soda in bags.
Soda in casks
ft.
per ton
28
58
(China clay) in
Lard
Cu.
Material
42
50
50
48
Gum
Ivory
Jute
Kaolin
bags
ft.
per ton
Cont.
.'
46
57
54
152
Material
barrels
in
40
54
60
27
40
60
70
34
and
tierces
Tallow in hogsheads.
Tamarinds in cases
Tamarinds in casks or
.
58
70
45
54
48
57
54
100
in barrels
Ties,
oak
(Rough Lumber in
Ash, black
Ash, white
Basswood
Beech
Birch
Butternut
Cherry
Chestnut
Cottonwood
Douglas fir
Elm, rock
Elm, soft
red
lb.
40
150
80
60
110
36
35
52
48
39
39
Beech
51
Fir
Greenheart
Mahogany
Wool in sheets
Wool in bales,
per 1,000
ft.
pressed.
Lumber
board measure)
3,000
3,000
4,500
3,000
3,500
3,000
3,900
3,900
2,800
4,200
3,000
2,800
4,000
Hemlock
Hickory..
Mahogany
Maple, soft
Maple, hard
Oak
Poplar, yellow
Shortleaf pine
Sycamore
Tupelo
Walnut
ft.
60
65
34
34
260
100
'
Gum, sap
3,200
3,500
2,500
4,000
4,000
2,500
3,800
2,800
2,800
3,300
3,800
3,000
3,300
38
85
Ash
Gum,
Elm
extract
Tapioca
Tar
small bales
Turmeric
Turpentine in barrels
Vermic. Hi
Water, fresh
Water, salt
Wheat in bags
Wheat in bulk
Whitening in casks
Woods, sawn into planks
kegs
Tan
15
13
ft.
per ton
Ties, steel
Tiles, roofing, in crates.
Tobacco, Brazilian, in
bales
in
Tobacco,
Turkish,
80
Sulphur in cases
Sulphur in kegs
Sumac in bags
Cu.
Material
100
50
Syrup
Tallow
ft.
per ton
Cont.
board measure
8,000 to 10,000
lb.
7,000 to
8,000
lb.
6,000 to
7,000
lb.
off
18
WEIGHTS
19
Keg
Lb.
100
56
68
80
100
48
60
48
30
50
60
56
70
34
57
32
60
56
45
60
Bushel of malt
Bushel of onions
Bushel of oats
Bushel of potatoes
Bushel of rye
Bushel of Timothy seed
Bushel of wheat
480
Quarter or 8 bushels of wheat
Gallon of m3lasses
12
Bale of United States cotton weighs
500
Bale of Peruvian cotton weighs
200
Bale of Brazilian cotton weighs
250
Bale of East Indian cotton weighs
400
Bale of Egyptian cotton weighs
750
Bale of jute weighs
440
One bushel of wheat = 60 lb. = 1.244 cu. ft.
Eight bushels of wheat = one quarter = 9.952 cu. ft. = 480 lb.
= 4% quarters = 46.43 cu. ft. = 2240 lb.
One ton of wheat
A case of kerosene oil generally contains two 5-gallon cans
or ten 1 -gallon, in the former taking up 2 cu. ft. and in the
latter 2.1.
Some hold fifteen 1-gallon cans and take up 3.2
-
cu.
ft.
Gallon of honey
Gallon of crude oil about
7 bags of sugar (one ton)
1 1 bags of potatoes (one ton)
One bag
83^
2240
2240
140
4369
2862
of flour
12
:
ft.
20
m.
No.
Size
of Pieces
per Bundle
H
H
V%
A
H
App ox/ No
/
'
A PP X
^BuSdlT
42(Approx.)500
24
450
18
340
12
245
'
7
5
140
100
1M
1^2..
60
58
Weight
"*
Lb
120
190
190
210
160
168
138
158
42
24
Vs
%
V%
A
18
12
7
5
3
3
M1
l
l
A
A
l
500
450
330
245
140
100
60
58
157
241
244
266
206
217
180
211
V
K
5
3
3
3
1%
1^2
1
Adopted on June
1st,
126
95
60
60
60
215
230
220
310
380
and Supplies
Association.
Barrels
There is no standard size of barrel universally adopted either
by Great Britain or the United States. In Great Britain an old
wine barrel = 26 }/i imperial gallons, an ale barrel = 31J^ imperial
= 36^2 imperial gallons. A French
gallons and a beer barrel
barrique of Bordeaux 228 liters = 50 imperial gallons. Four
barriques
tonneau.
BARRELS
21
26
circumference 64
outside measurements, representing as nearly as possible 7050 cu. ins. or 4.08 cu. ft., equivalent
Besides the above the different states specify
to 105 dry quarts.
dimensions
of
barrels
for various commodities.
the
The usual
barrel for liquids contains 31% U. S. wine gallons of 231 cu. ins.
ins.,
Below
is
a table of
Material Held
wood
ins.,
all
barrels.
Diameter
Top and
Diameter
at
Bilge
Height
Bottom
(in3.)
(ins.)
(ins.)
21%
19%
25%
28%
Fish....
20
Meat.
Molasses
21%
22%
22%
25%
27%
30
33
35
Salt ....
18%
16
16
21
18
30
Cement
Lime
Sugar
Flour.
Oil
21
Apple
19%
17%
Potato
17%
15
Tar
19%
The above
18
19
16%
21%
Cubic Feet
30
5.60
4.36
8.37
52 gals.
6.23
8.37
10.04
60 gals.
5.34
3.75
3.75
4.33
3.22
5.60
33
28%
28%
28%
28%
30
Rieley, Cleveland, O.
An
oil
company
(Piatt
& Washburn
Ref'g Co.,
drums
Diam.
Material
Wood
Wood
Drum
half barrel
(steel)
Half-drum
wood
New
York) gave
barrels
and
steel
22
Horse Powers
Horse Power
(h. p.),
weight of 33,000
lb.
2.64
hour from
watts
746
One
lb.
.746 kw.
horse power
ft. lb.
33,000
550
ft. lb.
per minute
per second
2,545
42.4
L =
A =
= number
ber of revolutions
Then
(i.
h. p.)
QQ nnn
oo
,UUU
See Boilers.
Lloyd's formulae are as follows:
Nominal Horse Power
(n. h. p.).
(1)
Where the
h p
n
= ^
~^~
/ >
V 100
"*"
1000
* 2
s
590
1500
( 100
boilers are fitted with forced
P +
If
boiler pressure
'
in.
V ^
i
15/
low 160
lb.
is
is
HORSE POWER
Equivalent Values of Mechanical and Electrical Units
Unit
23
24
Effective
Horse Power
(t.
(e.
h. p.)
h. p.) is the
Thrust in
lb.
33000
dist.
is
thrust in
lb.
dist.
33000
Horse power
1
min.
THERMOMETERS
25
Thermometers
Fahrenheit (F.) thermometer is used in the United States and
The freezing point of water is marked 32 and
in Great Britain.
the boiling at sea level 212, the distance between these points is
divided into 180 parts or degrees. 32 parts are marked off from
the freezing point downwards, and the last one marked
or zero.
is
taken as
0,
readings into
To convert
and the
Reaumur
Reaumur
The
To
is
convert Fahrenheit
by
f.
and add
32.
tract
from 32."
26
MATHEMATICAL TABLES
Involution and Evolution
The quantity represented by the letter a multiplied by a quantity represented by the letter b, is expressed a X b or ab.
Quantities in brackets thus (a
6)
(a
b) signify
be multiplied together.
To square a number multiply the number by
2
square of 4 (often written 4 ) is 4 X 4 = 16.
To cube a number
cube of 4 (written 4
To
3
)
itself.
they are to
Thus
the
Thus
logarithm.
V~ is the radical sign and either with or without the index figure
2 as
indicates that the square root of the quantity under it is
Thus the
to be taken.
to be taken as
VI
is
2.
\/
is
root as \/256 is 4.
root is the square root of the square root, and the sixth
the cube root of the square root.
\/8
is
2.
The fourth
root
is
Any
logarithm of
number
root of a
as
there are decimals, point these off likewise beginning at the decimal
point, and supplying as many ciphers as may be requirecj.
Find the greatest number whose square is less than the first left-
hand
and place it as the first figure in the quotient. Subtract its square from the left-hand period, and to the remainder
annex the two figures of the second period for a dividend.
Double the first figure of the quotient for a part ial__di visor. Find
period,
how many
is
and
numit
to
the right of the partial divisor, forming the complete divisor. Mul-
by the second
27
and subtract
3.141592
1.772
square root
27
214
189
347
2515
2429
3542 8692
7084
Point
off
the
number
hand or
into periods
units' place.
of three figures each, beginning at the right
Point off decimals in periods of three figures from the decimal point.
Find the greatest cube that does not exceed the left-hand period,
write its root as the first figure in the required root.
Subtract
the cube from the left-hand period, and to the remainder bring
down the next period for a dividend.
Square the first figure of the root, multiply by 300, and divide
the product into the dividend for a trial divisor, write the quotient
after the first figure of the root as a trial second figure.
Complete the divisor by adding to 300 times the square of the
first figure, 30 times the product of the first by the second figure
and the square of the second figure. Multiply this divisor by the
second figure, and subtract the product from the remainder. Should
the product be greater than the remainder the last figure of the root
and the complete divisor are too large; substitute for the last figure
the next smaller number and correct the trial divisor accordingly.
To the remainder bring down the next period, and proceed as
before to find the third figure of the root; that is, square the two
figures of the root already found, multiply
visor, etc.
If
by 300
is less
28
The cube
root of a
number
will contain as
many
figures as there
1,881,365
123.
cube root
GEOMETRICAL PROPOSITIONS
number
31
is
Thus
if
30.53
log.
log.
log.
3.053
log. of
305.3
3053.
=
=
may
be prefixed by the
.484727
1.484727
log. .3053
2.484727
log.
.03053
3.484727
log.
.003053
=
=
9.484727
8.484727
-10
7.484727
-10
- 10
is
logarithms.
Geometrical Propositions
The sum
is
equal to 180.
A straight
is
equal
from the vertex of an isosceles triangle perpendicular to the base bisects the base and the vertical angle.
A circle can be drawn through any three points not in the same
line
straight fine.
parallelogram
bisected
radii.
a radius
perpendicular to a chord,
the arc subtended by the chord.
If
From
it
The tangents
drawn are
so
equal.
to
meets
it at one point,
a
circle
tangent
perpendicular to the radius drawn to that point.
and
to the circle.
is
is
straight fine
and
it
32
at the center.
circle to its
diameter
Diameter of
circle
Circumference of
Circumference of
circle
X
X
X
.88623
.28209
1.1284
To
circle
ol
circle,
c>c
the arc
an arc of a
n
Chord
.
-.
of the arc
o
2
v,
X
r
radius
ks
sin
an S le
in degrees
KV
o
2
s>
aradius
v
X
sin2
an &
le in
degrees
3.1415926
0.497149
log.
T.895090
log.
T.5028501
log.
=2.2418774
log.
log.
1.7581226
AREAS
Let
Ellipse.
D =
d
major
axis
= minor
axis
Approximate circumference
= D X d X
= ^r-^ X
Area
33
3.1416
.78539
3.14159
= base X 14 altitude
= Vs (s a) (s b)
Triangle
Parallelogram
Trapezoid
Trapezium
=
=
=
(s
where
b and c
c)
J/
sum
altitude
\i the
sum
triangles
Circle
Sector of circle
=
=
diameter 2
.7854
length of arc
_ xX
radius'
ic
radius 2
X A the radius
X angle in degrees =
X
radius 2
=-
/3.1416
^^ ^
angle in degrees
line forming the segment cuts the
Segment of circle.
circle, draw lines to the center forming a sector and a center angle A.
Where the
m
ihen area ot
segment
radius 2
XA
in degrees
side
same area as square: diameter
=
side
diameter
Square of same area as circle:
Circle of
"180-
Sln
X
X
1.12838
.88623
Trapezoidal Rule.
ABCD
and
To
34
-4^
-1-/9
Figure
Let h
2/i,
the
common
y2, etc.,
>>
/?
*,
\- 6
-\
interval
ABC D
'V\
1
AD
+ Vi +
2/2+?/3 + 2/4+?/5 +
?/6
Simpson's First Rule. This rule assumes that the curved line
B C forming one side of the curvilinear area A B C D (see Fig. 2)
is a portion of a curve known as a parabola of the second order
whose equation is y = ax 2 + bx + c.
Figure 2
Divide the base into any convenient even number of parts, and
erect perpendiculars to meet the curve.
To the sum of the end
or
ordinates
add
four
times
the even numbered
perpendiculars
ordinates and twice the odd numbered ordinates.
Multiply the
sum by one-third the common interval and the product will be
the area.
ABCD
Or the area
A B C D in Fig.
+ 4^/6+
2/7)
of
in Fig.
-|"
(2/1+
(2/1+
^2/2
2/3)
4y2 + 2y s +
4z/ 4
+ 2ij
35
,:iJ
36
Simpson's
first
rule
is
it is
simpler
quite as accurate.
Surface of Solids. Lateral surface of a right or oblique prism
or cylinder = perimeter of the base
To get the
lateral length.
and
is
total surface
Frustum
lateral surface
height.
surface.
See
Fig. 5.
b.
r.
See Fig. 6.
See Fig. 7.
Volumes of Solids
Volume =
Cylinder, right or oblique, circular or elliptic, etc.
the lateral length of
area of section perpendicular to the sides
a side.
Frustum
of
face.
Pyramid or cone,
area of base
A
X
Frustum
(sum of
Volume
products)
of
A
X
Wedge, parallelogram
perpendicular height
Sphere.
Volume
face.
Volume
= sum
of three edges
perpendicular width.
=}ir
(radius)
or (diameter) 3
.5236.
VOLUMES OF SOLIDS
37
Volume =
it
r2 b
Volume =
it
b 2 (3 r
Figure 4
Spherical Sector
6)
Figure 5
Spherical Segment
>Q
Volume =& x
b (3a 2
*|
Figure 6
Spherical Zone
/?
A>
3
Figure 7
Circular Ring
3
Volume = 2
7T
22 r*
+ 3^+
46 2 )
38
}4
a b
r2
Figure 8
Ellipsoid
Volume = J^ x
Figure 9
Paraboloid
Regular polyhedron. Volume = area of its surface X \i the perpendicular from the center to one of the faces.
The volume of any irregular prismatic solid may be obtained by
dividing it into prisms or other bodies whose contents can be calculated by the above formulae.
The sum of the contents of these
bodies will give the total volume of the solids.
To find the volume of a solid bounded by a curved surface, as the
underwater portion of a ship's hull, divide the solid by a series of
planes or sections spaced an equal distance apart.
The area of each section can be calculated by either the trapezoidal or Simpson's rule, or by means of an instrument called a
planimeter. The areas of the sections can be laid off on ordinates
which are spaced the same distance apart as the sections which
the body was divided into. A curve is drawn through the points
laid off on the ordinates, and the area of the curvilinear figure is
the volume of the solid.
Example. The areas of cross sections of a ship below the load water
apart.
feet,
TRIGONOMETRY
Number of Section
39
40
As the sum
is
and
sine of angle
side, b
OBLIQUE TRIANGLES
First
Second
Third
Fourth
-f-
+
+
+
41
many, thus
side or
if
sin 30
two
.5,
but sin
_1
may
A +B =
is
.5
be
The
Five cases
90.
be distinguished.
Given
and
"
"
"
"
A
A
A
then a
b
=
=
=
c sin
A, b
a cot A, c
b tan A, c
A =
sin
A =
tan
-1
c cos
a cosec
b sec
=V (c-J-a)
= Va2 -f
-1
=
=
=
y,
(ca)
sin
sin
Case
Given two
2.
Then
sides (a
A =
B =
V2
V
2
and
(A
(A
b)
+ B) + Y2 (A - B)
+B) -y2 (A-B)
a sin C
.
rsin
Given two
Case 3.
of them.
sin
B =
sin
sides a
giving
B>1
two values
I>i
and
b,
two values
of B,
opposite one
in
Call-
42
corresponding to
180
(A
B)i and
Ci
B C =
180
(A
B) 2
d =
Bh
2,
That
is,
d
2
C <0 when
2
holds.
Case
4.
Then
sides.
Let
s
cos^i = |/
cos
yB
cos
HC
|/
j/
J/
(a
a sin
sin
C2
only the
first
two solutions
c)
SINES, COSECANTS,
Natural
o
TANGENTS, ETC.
43
44
Natural
o
Continued
SINES, COSECANTS,
Natural
o
TANGENTS, ETC.
Continued
45
46
Natural
o
Continued
SINES, COSECANTS,
Natural
TANGENTS, ETC.
Continued
47
48
Natural
o
Continued
SINES, COSECANTS,
Natural
o
1
TANGENTS, ETC.
Continued
49
50
of Inertia.
The
moment
of inertia of a section
is
the
sum
then the
moment
Radius
Gyration. This
of
quotient of the
expressed,
moment
R = a/
= 2
r2 .
of inertia /
I /A.
o,
is
The
radius of gyration
is
used in column
calculations.
by the area
line,
Number
CENTER OF GRAVITY
51
K X2 X2
H X 2 X 2 X 90.08
H X 2 X 44.60
If
To Find
moment was
4.03
ft.
desired multiply
Ordinate. Lay
X90. 08.
by
2.
its
Middle
52
Sections
Section
Modulus
of Inertia
53
Continued
Radius of Gyration
-Si
a*
a4
12
ai 4
a4
-^==.289a
V12
-^==.577a
V3
ai4
12
"
vT
12
= .289a
a*
12
+ ai>
118a'
Vl2
54
Continued
Distance from Neutral
Axis to Extremities
Sections
of Section
x and x
bd
*=7
bd
Xl
=d
* = "2
6d-bidi
bd
bd
XI
VV +
d*
of Inertia
I
Continued
55
56
Continued
Distance from Neutral
Axis to Extremities
of Section
x and
bd
Xi
xi
= d cos a + b
bd
2
Xl
bd
2
xi
= 2d
=d
^- =.785d*
Xl
sin
Section
bd
12
2
2
(d cos
Modulus
of Inertia
Continued
Radius of Gyration
=I
V?
XI
+b
sin 2 a)
2
db /
/d
CQ82
a -f
jjjgjgj
-\- b sina
V d cosa
bd*
b#
36
24
MP
bd*
12
12
-M*
-*
57
d2 cos2 a
V.
+b
12
~-^==.236d
V18
\A
= .408d
sin 2
58
Continued
Area of Section
Sections
x and xi
7T(d
- dl
.785(d-oV)
= ^=.212d
^ =.393d
o
- 5^-H
fc
Hj
x
+ bi
.
d2 tan. 30
d^
+ bi
d
Xl
--
= bb + 2bi
= .866d2
= bib + 2b
+ bi
'
_d
Mondulus
Section
ir(d-oV)
64
d<
- dV)
7T
(d
.007d
192
+ 4bbi + bi
+ bi)
12
(1
4 cos2 30
(3tt
b
.
d*
+ 2 cos' 30)
== .06d*
M ~_
32
nQR
,uy8
(d*
- dl<)
A.
d=
.024d3
(1
\/q2
+ 2 cos
64
2 (b2
d2
d=.132d
-v
+ 4bbi 4- bi
6(b+b
+ 2 cos
30) 1
4cos2
cos2 30
30
.12d3
4)
+ di2
12tt
+ 4bbi + bi'
+ 2b)
rd
\/d2
12 (bi
36 (b
A f d2
frrg-64
1152r
<-Vl
*1
= .049 (d<
9ir*-64
Continued
Radius of Gyration
of Inertia
I
59
4 cos 30
y
S=
.264d
30
60
Continued
Distance from Neutral
Axis to Extremities
Area of Section
Sections
of Section
jr-
d2
tan. 30
x and
= .866d
'
it
xi
= 2 cos
30
3a
xi
.577d
/T\
2d2 tan.22*=.828d2
-2"
\_L/J
ffbd
.785
bd
?n
Section
Modulus
of Inertia
61
Continued
Radius of Gyration
=
I
A_
12 L
+ 2 cos
(1
30) 1
d(t
A.
4 cos2 30
30
d2
(1+2 cos2
4
cos2
22j)
22*<
= .055d<
rb#
64
30)
.049M3
A
6
io
= .104d*
fd
I
?s/y
4 cos 30
,06d*
A_
12
+ 2 cos
|"
+ 2 cos
(1
4 cos 22*
wbd2
32
1 +
-
22*)
c
= .109d*
= .098bd'
= .264d
4 cos 22
vV
=
.257d
2 cos2 30
2 cos2 22i
62
Continued
x and
f*iff
T&
td
+ 2b'
(s
+ nO
Xl
td
+ 2b'
(s
+ n')
xi
Xl
xi
Ey=u-
m
t3iM
td
+ b'
(s
+ n')
-7T
of Inertia
I
Continued
63
64
Continued
Distance from Neutral
Axis to Extremities
of Section
Area of Section
Sections
x and
x
td
+ b'
(a
+ n')
xi
+ ^ + -|(b-t:
[b2s
+ 2t)l - A
xi = b x
(b
bd
h (b
t)
* = -2
bd
h (b
t)
V*
LZ
4*.
s/
te-
T
f
tf
<
65
66
Continued
Area of Section
Sections
of Section
bd
bd
x and xi
(b
h (b
li
XI
t)
S'
X/
= 2b 2A4- ht
=b x
s
x
t)
xi
-j
^
td
+ s (b -
t)
*=?
67
68
Continued
Distance from Neutral
Axis to Extremities
Area of Section
Sections
of Section
x and xi
dH
bs
+ ht
td2
1?
+a
(b
t)
t)
a(bi
- t) (2d
2A
+ ht -f bis
xi
=dx
>>
(t
tO
3bs2
+ 3th (d + s) + h
6A
xi
-*W
(b
=dx
tf*
a"
2A
xi
bs
(ti
=dx
- t)
(h
tXl3
DX3
Continued
Section Modulus
Radius of Gyration
of Inertia
S=-
(b
t) (x
txi 3
8)3
blXlS
(h
(b
t) (xi
t) (X
s)
bx3
s)
3 (bs
+h
(3t
12
ti)
- A (x - s)
t) (x
s)
+ ht)
(bi
(b
4bs3
|/r
+ bx -
V-
"
bx3
xi
69
t) (xi
s)
+ ht + bis) J
ft
s)
SECTION
II
STRENGTH OF MATERIALS
the general term denoting the force or resistance which
acts between bodies or parts of a body when under the influence
Stress
is
of a load.
It is
measured either
sectional area.
Strain
is
Tension.
-A
body
of a force tends to
strength
fibers
is
is
extend
it
when the
action
Tensile
oppose to separation.
strain in
any
A body
Shearing Strain.
is
is
is
The modulus
or coefficient of elasticity
is
and corresponding
If I be the
strains for a given material.
strain or increase per unit length of a material subjected to tensile
stress, and p the unit stress producing the elongation, the modulus
stresses
of elasticity
Modulus
7)
is
equal to
70
fibers
ULTIMATE STRENGTH
Ultimate
Strength.
The
load
is
it is
breaking load
~-.
cross section
taken before
71
it
,,
Strength of Materials*
(Stresses per
Stresses in
sion
Ulti-
Bend-
Shear-
Elastic
pression
ing
ing
Limit
Ulti-
Ulti-
Ulti-
mate
mate
mate
mate
Aluminum
6.5
12-14
14
12
24-28
20-35
75
85-100
40
60
120
32.6
28.1
18-24
50
8.2
8.6
6
16
28.5
29 4
22
20
22
25-55
10
60
30
100
80
tin,
50
24
tin,
100
15
bars, sheets
wire annealed
Aluminum bronze
5%toX^%al
Brass
al
17%
30%
zinc
zinc.
cast,
common
wire annealed
Bronze
8%
tin
13%
24%
tin
Modulus
Elong-
of Elastic-
ation
ity.
Lb.
tin
gun metal
9% copper, 1%
tin.
19
12
11,000,000
26.7
20.7
30
23.2
26.9
20
42
53
114
43.7
34.5
32
10,000,000
52
10,000,000
36
9,000,000
14,000,000
manganese, cast
10%
2%mang.
2%mang.
10%
phosphorus, cast
9%
l%phos...
phosphorus, wire
9%
l%phos...
tobin, cast
tin,
125
manganese, rolled
tin,
38%
\y2 %
zinc,
tin,
66
Hlead
tobin, rolled
38%
\y2 %
zinc,
tin,
Mlead
Copper
cast
plates, rods, bolts ....
wire annealed
Delta Metal
cast
plates
bars
wire
f
J
I
I
cast
10%
Thousands of Pounds
Com-
Ten-
Square Inch)
55-60% copper
38-40% zinc
21-
4% iron
2% tin
80
40
25
32-35
36
6
10
10
45
68
85
100
Handbook
4,500,000
40
32
22
30
10,000,000
15,000,000
5.5
3.3
STRENGTH OF MATERIALS
72
Strength of Materials
(Stresses per
Stresses in
Goldcast
wire
Iron, Cast
common
gray
malleable
Lead
cast
pipe
rolled sheets
Platinum wire
unannealed
annealed
Silver, cast
Steelship
boiler
box
fire
flange plates
rivets
ships
boilers
castings
soft
medium
hard
concrete bars, plain, structural grade
3.25%
nickel,
untempered
shapes
bars
wire
unannealed
annealed
Zinc
cast
rolled sheets
Continued
Square Inch)
WORKING STRESS
Strength of Materials
(Stresses in
73
Continued
Modulus
Building Materials
Com-
Ten-
Bend-
of
Com-
Bear-
Shear-
pression
sion
ing
Elasticity
pression
ing
ing
12,000
12,000
8,000
5,000
10,000
1,200
1,200
7,000,000
7,000,000
7,000,000
3,000,000
14,000,000
1,200
1,200
1,200
1,200
200
200
800
500
800
500
3,000
2,500
1,600
1,500
1,200
5,000
1,000
1,000
150
150
175
200
600
420
350
280
600
500
400
250
500
300
Stone
bluestone
marble.-.
granite
limestone
sandstone
slate
Brick
common, good
pressed and paving.
Masonry
granite
limestone bluestone
sandstone
rubble
concrete 1, 2^>, 5.
.
140
280
168
common
plaster
terra cotta
Concrete
2H,
5,
It
10,000
6,000
common
brick,
Miscellaneous
glass,
30,000
3,000
700
70
hard stone.
V/i, 5,
1,700
1,200
500
cinders
means
cement,
2J/2
3,000
8,000,000
5,000
soft stone
1,
800
150
1 part
sand, 5
Reinforced Concrete
Modulus
Elastic
Compression
22 5% of ultimate compression on piers or columns of
.
stone
Bearing
32.5%
Shearing
2%
3%
6%
Bond
Working
which
is
Stress:
'
"f
y-7 Tne factor of
factor 01 satety
safety depends to a great extent on the nature of the forces acting
and on the material.
stress.
Thus working
stress
].
-P
oQ
+3
CSCOOCO
ft
COCOt^fN
CI b- iO
CO CO <N
-i-t
"^
CO OS
O 00
GO O
-rH
CO i
tSHOt^
oo
00 **
CO <N CO <N COCO
oo
OO
oooooo
OO'OOOO
oooooo
oooooo
(NiNOOOOSOS
-oo
o
O
'"OOOO
O -b-OOOO
(NO
OOS!>OS
a
d
ro
03
OS
a
03
.2
'-3
"to
H
d<~-2
bfi
*
o m d a
S 9
,
T3
OOOOOO
OOOOOO
OOlNCiNO
oooooo
oooooo
OcN
O
cN ci <N
rtj^
i-h
rt*
t>
'(NCNKN
OSO
oooooo
oooooo
ON^NNO
ooo
ooo
OO
oo
oo
oooooo
oooooo
<NOS<N<N
ooo
ooo
oo
oo
BEAMS
Factors of Safety
Material
75
STRENGTH OF MATERIALS
76
algebraic
Fibers which are at equal distances from the neutral axis will
be deformed to the same extent. The resistance to bending is the
combination of the resistances to tension and compression. Thus
let
= bending moment
= distance from the outermost fiber to the neutral axis
=
/
moment of inertia of the section
=
safe or allowable unit fiber stress in pounds per square
V
inch
M or p
Then JL
y
= My
or
M
y
s.
The moment
Mi
of resistance
y
a
beam
is
the
sum
of the
composing the
section.
neutral axis of
all
of
the
Hence Mi =
s p; that
to
the
safe
fiber
stress
multiequal
is
a
wi\
Jin.
IvTJl
\
J?A
/?.
Figure 12
The
by the
principle of
moments.
BEAMS
77
W W
W
Then
R,.
(^X ) + (^X
6)
a,
2
and Wz,
b, and c
and Wz.
+ (^X
c).
Hence
sum of
The
the loads.
that
is,
is
single
maximum
shear
at the supports, and is equal to one half the load or the reaction; the shear changes at every point of the loaded length, the minis
imum
uniform throughout the beam. When a beam supports several concentrated loads, changes in the amount of shear occur only
at the points where the loads are applied.
and
is
Examples. What is the greatest safe load that can be lifted by a boat davit
having an outreach of 5 ft. and a diameter of 7 ins. The davit is of wrought iron.
This is a case of a beam with one end fixed and with the load at the other, hence
=
the bending moment is
X L, where L is the outreach of the davit or 5 ft.
From
the
beam formula
L
/
=
=
section
diameter
W XL
= p X
= pX
wrought iron
modulus
12 ins.
V
d
Hence
60
5 tons
ins.
*S
ins.
S
= p X
r- =
L
Boat Davit.
r *
S ss
vd*
"32"
^r
ou
2}4 tons.
STRENGTH OF MATERIALS
78
Find the safe
resisting
moment
of a
Here Mi
rpu
The
x-
= S
section
The
ins.
wide by
p.
J
i
S
modulus
The modulus
4.
M W
'
10
of rupture for
12
12
6,000
lb.
is
240
= ' =
1,500
lb.
Int.
School
of Correspondence.]
Steel Co.]
y
I
=
= moment
section
of inertia
modulus
about center
in inches
radius of gyration
= a/ r
in inches
'*
CANTILEVER BEAM
1.
Cantilever
Beam.
Concentrated load at
79
free end.
R\ (max. shear)
Wx
wax
distance x
M,
M max. at R\
Wl
W max.
f*
I
Wl*
D max.
2.
Cantilever
Beam.
M,
W
Wx*
distance x
21
2 /
W max.
h*-l
3.
Cantilever
Beam.
Wl*
max.
.Ri
distance x j
M max. at R\
PFmax.
D max.
W
Wx*
3/2
TP7
"3
3/s
TF/3
15Z
STRENGTH OF MATERIALS
80
4.
Beam
Supported at Ends.
(max. shear
if
>
one end.
Wb
a)
I
Ri (max. shear
if
>
6)
'
/-
a -LJ>
\*
-4
M,
distance x
= Wbx
I
-J
Wab
I
W max.
Beam
Supported at Ends.
81
Mma
(max. shear)
M,
R\
Wx
distance x
W max.
Wa
D max.
12
8.
Beam
Supported at Ends.
2f
I {\P
a*)
bi
+W U
2
Wa
Ri
M at W
TFi ai
TF2 a 2
= Ra
Mmax. if
Mat
W = or
>R
= Rai - W (ai - a)
Wi
M max.
+ W =Rot >R
Mm&x. PFi + W = Ri or > Ri
M at W
IV
9.
Beam
W/
if TFi
if
= a 2 -
W (a
TTi (a 2
w.
M max.
Supported at Ends.
if
TF2
Ri or
>
a)
ai)
i?i
S770X
(max shear)
M,
distance x
M max. at center
W max.
D max.
R\
w=
rV-f
STRENGTH OF MATERIALS
82
Beam
10.
Supported at Ends.
end.
2W
R\ (max. shear)
M,
Wx
distance x
H)
Wl
9V3"
27
W max.
D
Beam
11.
Supported at Ends.
.013044
max.
Load
fs
2HlT
WP
EI
decreasing uniformly to
center.
(max. shear)
M,
distance x
Ri
Wx
3^
M max. distance
12
fs
12
TF max.
12.
Beam
Supported at Ends.
ZWP
max.
Load
320
increasing uniformly to
center.
(max. shear)
M,
distance x
=
=
Ri
Wx
2
|
2jrA
2
3/y
(1_
M max. distance i
TF
6
W max.
6/s
WEI
max.
83
(max. shear
<
if
c)
(2c
b)
21
W (2a
Ri
M,
distance x
>
Mi, distance x
Supported at Ends.
Uniform
tinuous.
a)*
b)
Rb
+ b)]
b) [4al -f b (2c
8/ 2
(2c
Beam
26
+ W
8? 2
14.
W (x
Rx
+ b)- = 2a
(a
M max. distance
W max.
W (2x
Rx
W (2c +
<
a or
>a
= Rx -
Mi, distance x
4- b)
2c
b) [4a/ 4- 6 (2c
b)]
W
W
(max. shear
if
>
Wi)
-a)
(21
Wi
21
Wi
Ri
(21
+ Wa
c)
21
= R
distance x
<
Mi, distance x
>
M,
Rx
2 Wal
Wa >
\Va*
and
2a
W (2x
M max. distance x -=
WX*
Wi Ca
WI
Wic
Beam
Continuous over
Two
Supports.
RM
2W
''
W max.
15.
2 j
Two
exterior
(max. shear)
M,
Ri
Wx
distance x
Wa
M max. from R to Ri
2
2 f s
TFmax.
= Wa
D, distance a
(3aZ
12
I
Di, distance
sym-
metrical loads.
a)
= Wa
E
(l
if\
4a 2 )
2a)2
STRENGTH OF MATERIALS
84
16.
Beam
Continuous over
Two
Supports.
Uniformly distributed
load.
R =
Ri
Wa
-T
s,
ty
il/i
at
if
R and
\
)
2Z
/2i
/l
- Ix 4W (x T\2-
M, distance x =
OT
^|/
I (I
- 4a)
= Wa*
21
max.
+ center
*
A/2 at
if
TF
(*
max.
TFi
Wi max. =
I
max.
is
if
I)
__
<
>J(V
Z (
"~
i)
2i-/s
max.
Deflection.
a*
max.
> Z V2
- 4a)
if
4a
if
<
|)
Z (
*-
I)
Beams
steel beams
given in section on
less
Columns
was formerly assumed that the strength of a column depended
largely on the condition of its ends. Many engineers now make no
difference in their calculations for round-ended, pin-ended and
It
P =
Columns.
on column in pounds,
cluding proper allowance for impact
A = minimum
in-
=
=
bers,
P = A
Formulae from
(l6,000
70
Electrical Engineer's
Handbook.
lb.
COLUMNS
(2)
85
-r not to exceed 40
P = A
(3)
(6,100
32
Vi
Timber Columns.
P = A
Short-leaf pine
Or
P = A
and spruce
(l
|1300
I
1100
~\
xtt,)
is
50000
V =
1
36000
r2
supports
50000
V =
1
Steel
flat
24000
r2
V =
1
18000
r2
80000
800 d2
flat
STRENGTH OF MATERIALS
86
Columns of
and
Sections*
lb.
radii.
for lengths of
87
flat
800 d2
Cast iron column, hollow, square, with both ends fixed or resting
on flat supports, S = outside dimension of square.
80000
=
S2
1000
flat
square being S,
5000
=
1
P
250 S2
White
Oak
1,300
Length
ttt-.I
bud/
88
STRENGTH OF MATERIALS
Round Wooden Columns
(Safe loads in thousands of pounds)
Length
~7g)
TORSIONAL STRESSES
89
Columns
Both Ends Fixed
Factor of Safety
Strong
Size
In Tons of 2000
lb.
STRENGTH OF MATERIALS
90
Springs.
Let
To determine the
D v
mean diameter
total load in
=
=
=
Then d
size of steel
in inches of coil.
pounds
'
W
=
=
are
>3
an inch
26 for round (British Admiralty) or 22 (Board of
Trade)
= 32 for square (British Admiralty) or 30 (Board of
Trade)
Formula for Calculating Strength of Tubes, Pipes and Thin
Cylinders. The one (Barlow's) commonly used assumes that the
d
a
where
size in sixteenths of
elasticity
will
of the material at
=
S =
D =
n =
p
Then
^= ^
2t
~
.
S =
t
t
2 St
D
n
DP
DP
2t
for butt-welded steel pipe
50000
n
60000
28000
for
is
assumed to be small
91
STRENGTH OF MATERIALS
92
The
bitts
of the hawser.
Dia. in Inches
BOLTS
Shearing and Tensile Strength of Bolts
93
STRENGTH OF MATERIALS
94
3 ins. diameter
and
of shackles
from J^
in.
12 to
15%
Tests of Hooks
[Boston
&
Lockport Co.]
Size,
Inches
is
meant.
Tests of Shackles
Size,
Inches
X
%
X
X
Tensile
Strength, Lb.
15,400
20,500
22,700
40,100
66,380
68,900
78,900
105,900
121,850
126,700
150,600
170,500
230,200
260,500
280,600
498,000
m
i%
IX
\%
m
XX
2
2M
2X
3
Description
of Fracture
Sheared
Shackle Pin
Shank
3,080
4,100
4,540
8,020
13,276
13,780
15,780
21,180
24,370
25,340
30,120
34,100
46,040
52,100
56,120
99,600
of
Eye
TURNBUCKLES
97
TURNBUCKLES
Drop-forged, with hook and eye, shackle and eye, two eyes, two
hooks, two shackles, or hook an'd shackle.
Size Turn-
STRENGTH OF MATERIALS
98
=
Hence D =
\/
25 and
.0812
12000
X R
length of boat
beam
of boat
depth
of
height of davit
boat
above
its
uppermost point
of support
spread
All the above dimensions are in feet,
constant = 82 when the davit is of wrought iron and
of sufficient strength to safely lower the boat fully
maximum number
of
passengers
diameter of davit in inches
XB
X D
(H +4S)
^AW^vMT
Figure 13
99
he
3y scaling
tie
is
The above
z^JJ^W/WAk
Figure 14
is
B
P X
j^
4_
nL
Figure 15
STRENGTH OF MATERIALS
100
T X
d,
strain
on
The
is
P X
moment
is
If
is
g,
the guy
F X
the strain
tion or
The moment
c.
is
As d decreases the
increases.
strain
moments.
P X
/,
G X
and
and
is
of
by the
the load about the bottom
is
calculated
P Xc
F =
it
If it is inclined,
principle of
of the
is
mast
F and
its
moment
the
P Xc
G =
its direc-
is
(1)
tension in
is
P X
T
T =
and
1
(2)
compression in
P B
B = Xj^ ,hold.
A
1
Figure 16
Shear poles with guys. See Fig. 16. First assume that the two
masts act as one placed at B D and the two guys as one at A 5.
101
Mul-
angle
the two masts or guys make with each other to find the strain in
each mast or guy.
(From Mech. Eng'rs Pocket Book. W. Kent)
head
for
punched
plates,
for drilled.
The advantage
of swelled-neck rivets
is
C7
r\
f
A
Figure 17.
A = pan head B = snap or button head, makes a neater appearance than pan
= countersunk raised head. E head.
C = flush or countersunk flat head.
than is required for a plain
diameter
inch
an
of
rivets.
greater
tap
They are %
rivet to the same thickness of plate or shape (Am. Bureau of Shipping Kules^.
F = snap point, proportions same as button head. G = hammered point. H countersunk point, proportions same for countersunk head.
STRENGTH OF MATERIALS
102
Form
of
ness of plates.
the
societies.
own
different
The U.
Navy
has
its
standard.
S.
classification
<,.
although
universal standards,
Lloyd's is doubtless adopted more
than any other for merchant work.
YZ2
Countersink.
V-B-A
Diameter
of Rivet, Ins.
B, Ins.
H
H
%
11
16
13
1
1
6
5
16
1_
16
3_
1-3A
1 A
16
IV*
when
Diameter
of rivet in ins.
.22 and
.34 and
.48 and
.66 and
.88 and 1.14 and
under .34 under .48 under .66 under .85 under 1.14 under 1.2
V*
1H
Lengths of Rivets for Ordering. The length for ordering panand button-head rivets is measured exclusive of the head; for
countersunk rivets and taps the ordered length includes the head
to the top of the countersink.
sapis
qjog
T3
ft
&
o
a
o3
>
Md
Pn
d
d
o
0>
apis jb j;
apis
jua^
sp^aq
o
o>
o
M
sapis
>
q^og
ft
ft
o
H
I
-d
d
apis
>
jb^
d
3
Q
apis ja^[
o
,d
a
o
Bp^aq
Iinj
omx
STRENGTH OF MATERIALS
104
in
nesses Connected
Type
of
Point
Countersunk
Hammered
Snap
Oval
RIVETED JOINTS
105
(Ins.)
Diameter
Decimals
in
(Ins.)
.125
.187
.250
.312
.375
.437
.500
.562
.625
.687
.750
.812
.875
.937
_3_
"16
X
k
H
16
k
k
5
ii
16
13.
"16
v$
15
16
1.000
1.062
1.125
1.187
1.250
1.312
1.375
1.437
1.500
1A
1A
1A
IK
From Lukens
Iron
&
Steel at
Steel at
40,000 Lb.
Per Sq. Inch
45,000 Lb.
490
552
1,104
1,963
3,068
4,418
6,013
7,854
1,242
2,209
3,452
4,970
6,735
8,836
11,183
13,806
16,705
19,880
23,332
27,060
31,064
35,343
39,899
44,731
49,838
55,224
60,885
66,820
73,035
79,519
9,940
12,272
14,848
17,671
20,739
24,052
27,611
31,416
35,465
39,760
44,300
49,088
54,120
59,396
64,920
70,684
Steel Co.
T
is
be expressed as a percentage.
^f which can
55%
STRENGTH OF MATERIALS
106
70%
65
75
80
85
=
=
p =
diameter of rivets
thickness of plate
T =
C =
S =
pitch of rivets
and
stresses in
Lap
Lap
=
=
=
(p
d)
}/i tc
d2
=
=
=
=
The
=
=
(p
d)
C
2*d*S
2
(p
d)
d C
2ird 2 S
t
(p
d)
2 t d C
4ird 2 S
w
H
<
P-.
H
H
W
>
O
H
P
J
CO
<
CO
w a
o
-*
CO
cp
<
^
h
o
B
P
>
a
g
2
<
H
a
o5
Length
Under
Head
In 100 Pounds*
Length
Under
SECTION
III
SHIPBUILDING MATERIALS
IRON AND STEEL, NON-FERROUS METALS AND ALLOYS,
.WOOD, MISCELLANEOUS NON-METALLIC MATERIALS
cific
is
Cast iron
Steel
Wrought
30 to
iron
.05
7.7
temperable
malleable, not
temperable
manufacture are the crucible process,
the open hearth process, and the Bessemer. In the crucible, impure wrought iron or blister steel with carbon and a flux is fused in
a sealed vessel which air cannot enter: the best tool steels are made
In the open hearth process, pig iron is melted, wrought
thus.
iron scrap being added until the proper degree of carbonization
is secured.
In the Bessemer process, pig iron is completely decarbonized in a converter by an air blast and then recarbonized to the
proper degree by the addition of spiegeleisen. The metal for the
open hearth or for the Bessemer converter is cast into ingots which
The
principal
methods
of
road
rail.
for structural
steel for rail-
The
physical properties of* steel depend upon the method of manufacture and chemical composition, carbon being the controlling
ultimate
elongation.
The higher
the
is
percentage
of
carbon
SHIPBUILDING MATERIALS
112
steel
may
be
Soft,
Carbon
classified as follows:
easily
welded
Medium,
about 1,000 lb. per square inch for each .01% but tends to make the
metal brittle.
in
and compression
Tensile strength
35,000
50,000
30,000
40,000
60,000
100,000
'
Compressive strength
60,000
50,000
Shearing strength
Modulus
Modulus
Modulus
of rupture
120,000
75,000
110,000
of elasticity, tension
of elasticity, shear
30,000,000
30,000,000
12,000,000
12,000,000
same
rule,
from 80 to 400 lb. per square inch for each .01% depending on the
carbon present and whether the steel is acid or basic. In its most
serviceable form manganese steel contains about 13 to 14% of
manganese and is practically non-magnetic. On account of its
extreme hardness it is difficult to machine.
The usual analysis of manganese steel lies between the following
limits, manganese 11 to 14%, carbon 1. to 1.3%, silicon .3 to .8%,
phosphorus .05 to .08%, the sulphur content being so as to be
_m
negligible.
Manganese steel when tested in the form of a
NICKEL STEEL
113
limit
be
made per
foot.
Nickel Steel.
.2
to
.5%
Ordinarily
of carbon.
contains 1.5 to
Nickel steel
and
has a larger resistance to wear
4.5%
of nickel
When
of nickel.
SHIPBUILDING MATERIALS
114
termediate
steels
and 14 to
12%
4.5 to
steels,
26%
in self-hardening or air-hardening
in
steels.
speed
Thehigh
vanadium
Vanadium Steel.
3%. Its effect is to improve the
toughness.
content
is
and
nickel
is
and strength.
This
suitable
Gears,
for
axles,
springs.
is
inch in thickness.
The
less
than
16%
for material
below .375
The elongation
shall be between 28 and 33 tons per square inch.
on a standard test piece having a gauge length of 8 ins. shall not
be less than 20% for material .375 inch in thickness and upwards,
and not less than 16% for material below. For cold and temper
tests the test pieces shall withstand without fracture, being doubled
over until the internal radius is equal to 1}^ times the thickness
and the sides are parallel."
American Bureau of Shipping Rules state: "Steel plates, angles
and shapes shall have an ultimate tensile strength of from 58,000
to 68,000 lb. per square inch of* section, an elastic limit of oneof the test piece
40%
22%
Material
thick and over, and 18% for plates under 18 lb.
than
lb.
tensile
ultimate
of greater
per square inch
strength
68,000
and not above 70,000 lb. may be accepted provided the elongation
18
lb.
specified
tests
meet the
re-
BEND TESTS
115
-.,
.Phosphorus
Acid
< -~
(
Basic
Yield point
maximum
,
Elongation in 8
...
ins.
.5
.
tensile*strength.
minimum
per cent.
% inch in thickness,
1,500,000
*
r.
rr-
tensile strength
made for
minimum
18%.
shall
the specimen.
"Bend Tests.
The
which
is
specimen.
making approximately a
specified;
SHIPBUILDING MATERIALS
116
under 100
ins. in
width,
2.5% above
RIVET STEEL
117
ins. in
and may
Kind
and compression is
kinds of steel be assumed
of steel in tension
of Steel
for different
Ultimate Strength,
55,000
60,000
50,000
60,000
75,000
90,000
100,000
125,000
Machine
steel
steel
Axle steel
Spring steel
Gun
American Bureau
of best
of Shipping:
"Materials for rivets shall be
hearth steel, limit of phosphorus and sulphur .04 of
open
one per cent. Tensile strength to be not less than 45,000 nor
more than 55,000 lb. per square inch."
Abstracts from the Specifications for Rivet Steel for Ships issued
Phosphorus:
Acid
.
-J
Basic
SHIPBUILDING MATERIALS
118
"
Tension Tests.
Elongation in 8
ins.
.5
lb.
tensile strength
minimum
1,500,000
per cent, tensile strength
% inch in diameter,
The
bend cold through 180
specimen
without cracking on the outside of the bent portion.
on
Tests.
shall
test
itself
flat
shall
a diameter of 23^ times the diameter of the shank without cracking at the edges.
The
specified."
It
is
lower in
etc.,
are
made
of
it.
from
test pieces of
American
Bureau
and hammer
tests."
less
and without showing cracks or flaws. For other castings, tests will be the same except that the angle may be reduced
to 90.
Drop tests shall be made from a height not exceeding
10 ft. on a hard road or floor."
The following abstract is from the Specifications of Steel Cast"These
ings issued by the American Society for Testing Materials:
specifications cover two classes of castings, viz., Class A ordinary
castings for which no physical requirements are specified, and
ing 1J^
ins.
IRON
Class
for
Chemical Composition
119
specified.
Class
Carbon
Phosphorus
Sulphur
"Physical Properties.
soft.
Class
SHIPBUILDING MATERIALS
120
Wrought
Iron.
Boat
not be tempered.
fittings are
made
of
davits, rail
It is
it.
composed
chiefly of
Common
Carbon
.05%
.06%
Phosphorus
Sulphur
.35
.06
.04
Silicon
.23
.20
....
.06
Manganese
about 3.3
Siag
Tension. Average
many
of
18
2 .80
tests at
Columbia University,
New
31,000
Ultimate strength
Elongation in 8 ins. per cent
Reduction of area per cent
Modulus
51,000
21
30
of elasticity
gave as follows:
42,000
20,530
Ultimate strength
56,400
Modulus
of elasticity
12,800,000
Compression. Ultimate
Cast Iron.
sion.
lb.
Civil Engineer's
Is brittle,
weak
in tension
and strong
in compres-
cast in a variety of
iron is called for.
When
and
is
gray, and weak in tension and compresSilicon in cast iron up to .5% increases its compressive strength,
and the
below
121
is soft,
1%
is
up
to
2%.
Manganese when
it
brittleness.
foot, 449.2.
Sp.
strength 37,000
Pickling.
lb.
Steel
which must
when the
removed by
The
otherwise
scale is
of
SHIPBUILDING MATERIALS
122
of
any galvanized
article is
not neces-
of its excellence.
The only final test of a
the test of time under actual conditions of exposure.
As this takes too long for commercial purposes, various tests have
sarily
an indication
zinc coating
is
about 3 minutes.
Thickness, Ins.
Standard Gauges
OOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOO OOOOOO
ONINNNMMMMCOroCOCCCOCCWMCCCOMMCOMCOCO
SOOQOOOOQOOOOQQOOOOOOOOOO
ooooooooooooo<_ SOOOOOOOO'
lO
*o
CO
id OS
-
10
*0 CO
'
-i
'
SQQOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOQ
03
ft
3
w
oooooooooooooooooooooo
WtJ(iOO1O51O00C>1NMMMMC0O3O)I^iOC<1Nt|<
ooooooooooooooocoooooo
03
<H(M^o0Nf-iT)<NOOCqiMiN(MCCr.OOCCMiCiH
<
ft
C^C3C^CO^0*OiOkOOcOCOcOOlO0OiO' tf'COCOCO
,
OOOOOOOOOOO'
mN M NN
a;
Or- CI iO
iOS
iO
01<^C<ICOTtl'*<Tt>OiO0JTJ"~)OtO"TiCO0 >*iCOCOCC(N
0Q
oooooooooooooooooooooo
*o
roo-ic^cocor^oico-tio-<ti'*i->+i o
PL,
co >o t>
co
!^C^>C^iTOT*i^-rJ<iOiOOiOiOiOO00'#'^COCOCOC<l
H
O
w
T3
OtMOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOO
OOOOOOM^OlrtfOPli-iT-ilNOONiOOiOCOlXliO
i^'^<^(T<lC0TfiTtt-^O'O'OtOOO->!f<-<*i'>*irt<C0C0CNlCS
OlMQOOOQOOOQQOQOOOOOOO
000)tONOJO00'Hr-iOO!OiOTt<0HN'*
r<iH(N'*'*'*10iiOiOTj4'<J(r)(^Tj(MCONCq
mM
^OOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOO
OOCO-*OaOC^"<*<t--aOGOOOt^-rt<-<t<rHQOC^O<^>CO
iHNCCMM'*'*"*'}(^(^^ T((^ T((cOroMNCq
a
p
OOOOOOOOOOOOOOQOOOO
'HrHCO'*00'HlO^TtllOiHOQO!OlHO>lCCI
(NMMMT)<Ttf*'*T)<'*-*T)<Tj*MMMCl(N(N
ooooooooooooooooooo
ONNCONNOMWHHO)N>(5^0*H
<1
C^C^COCOCOCC-^-^-^-^-^cOCOCOCOCOC^CnICnI
ooooooooooooooooooo
03000K5
10NNNN010K3COIN05NP30
rHC<ic<icococoecicoeoco'*eococococ<ic^e<ic<>
oooooooooooooooooo
C5lr^t^COCOiOiO"D0<OcOCO<MOOOCOCNl05
OOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOO
HiOiOMdT)<Ttic^COCOINN-iO5 5D'*'H00
NNNMCOWmMPJMCCMWCINCINiH
OOOOOOOOOOOOOOOQO
CROfflONNHHHHHON^NON
iHdNClCOMfOMMMMWNiNNINiH
OOOOOOOOO
NNNNtHHHlHlH
MNHOM
N
6 6 6 6 6
128
Sizes
A =
y
I
= distance
= moment
s =
section
of inertia
modulus
about
line
m
V
radius of gyration
Dimensions
Weights
in
pounds per
foot.
Shipbuilding Channels
(Carnegie Steel Co.)
L..LJ
-*U
Depth
02
Sizes
A =
y
/
= distance
= moment
S =
section
of inertia
modulus
about
line
radius of gyration
itfl
of inches
Shipbuilding Channels
(Carnegie Steel Co.)
Depth
Shipbuilding Channels
Continued
Equal Angles
4f
$
Weight
Size, Inches
lVs
1A
l
A-
6X6X1
3^
H.
K.
if.
56.9
54.0
51.0
48.1
45.0
42.0
38.9
35.8
32.7
29.6
26.4
37.4
35.3
33.1
31.0
16.73
15.87
15.00
14.12
13.23
12.34
11.44
10.53
9.61
8.68
7.75
11.00
10.37
9.73
9.09
8.44
7.78
7.11
6.43
5.75
5.06
4.36
9.00
8.50
7.98
7.47
6.94
6.40
5.86
5.31
4.75
4.18
3.61
5.84
5.44
5.03
A-
21
19
17
14
26
24
30.6
28.9
27.2
25.4
23.6
21.8
20.0
Aft
A.
ft
18.1
16.2
14.3
12.3
19.9
18.5
17.1
15.7
14.3
12.8
11.3
it.
%.
ft
ft
A.
ft
Aft
Aft
3H x sy2 x
9.8
8.2
6.6
if.
ft
.
17.1
16.0
14.8
13.6
12.4
of
28.
H>.
X4 X
Foot
Area
Section,
Sq. Ins.
Pounds
H.
H.
ft
H.
per
A*
61
18
75
31
86
2.40
1.94
5.03
4.69
4.34
3.98
3.62
131
98.0
93.5
89.0
84.3
79.6
74.7
69.7
64.6
59.4
54.1
48.6
35.5
33.7
31.9
30.1
28.2
26.2
24.2
22.1
19.9
17.7
15.4
19.6
18.7
17.8
16.8
15
14
13
12
11
10.0
8.7
8.1
7.7
7.2
6.7
6.1
5.6
5.0
4.4
3.7
3.0
5.3
5.0
4.7
4.3
4.0
42
43
44
44
45
17.5
16.7
15.8
14.9
14.0
46
13
12
11
10
47
48
49
2.50
2.51
1.80
1.80
1.81
82
,83
1.83
1.84
1.85
1.86
1.87
1.88
1.48
1.48
1.49
1.50
1.50
1.51
1.52
1.53
1.54
1.55
1.56
1.18
1.19
1.19
1.20
1.21
1.22
1.23
1.23
1.24
1.25
1.02
1.03
1.04
1.04
1.05
9
8
8.6
8.1
7.6
7.2
6.7
5.8
5.5
2.8
2.4
2.41
2.39
37
34
32
30
28
25
23
21
19
1.86
1.84
1.82
1.80
1.78
1.75
1.73
1.71
1.68
1.66
1.64
1.61
1.59
1.57
1.55
1.52
1.50
1.48
1.46
43
41
39
.29
1.5
1.3
1.27
1.25
1.23
1.21
1.18
1.16
1.14
1.12
1.09
1.17
1.15
1.12
1.10
1.08
Equal Angles
Weight
Size,
per
Inches
Foot
11.1
3.25
2.87
2.48
2.09
3.6
3.3
2.9
1.69
2.0
2.6
2.4
2.2
2.0
1.8
1.5
1.2
1.2
9.8
8.5
7.2
5.8
11.5
10.4
9.4
8.3
7.2
,7
Tff
Vs
5
16
3*
X 3J X ^
.'
ft...
7
10
Vs....
s
16
6.1
4.9
7.7
6.8
5.9
5.0
4.1
3.07
2.08
5.3
4.7
3.92
3.19
2.44
1.65
4.6
3.99
3.39
2.77
2.12
1.44
3.35
2.86
2.34
1.80
1.23
2.33
1.92
1.48
1.01
1.49
1.16
ft..,..
2V2 X 2& X H
ft
A
JJ
X A
ft..,*
M-...
16
A
8
1H X IK X
$
16
Vs
VAX VAX H
_5_
16
_a_
16
VAX VAX A
M
3
16
1X1XM-...
3
16
of
Section
Sq. Ins.
Pounds
3^ X 3M X
Area
Continued
.80
2 o
3.36
3.00
2.75
2.43
2.11
1.78
1.44
2.25
2.00
1.06
1.07
1.07
1.08
1.09
1.5
1.3
1.2
.88
.89
.90
1.3
1.2
1.1
.90
.61
1.56
1.36
1.15
1.34
1.17
1.00
.81
.62
.42
.98
.84
.69
.53
.36
.68
.56
.43
.30
.44
.34
.23
.99
.97
.98
.95
.93
.91
.89
.87
.84
.81
.78
.76
.74
.72
.69
.67
.66
.64
.61
.59
.57
.55
.59
.57
.55
.53
.51
.48
.51
.49
.47
.44
.42
.42
.40
.38
.35
.34
.32
.30
.95
.83
.71
.58
.73
.65
.57
.48
.39
.30
.20
.40
.35
.30
.25
.19
.13
.30
.26
.23
.19
.14
.10
.19
.16
.13
.10
.07
.11
.09
.07
.05
.06
.04
.03
.92
.93
.74
.75
.75
.76
.77
.78
.79
.59
.59
.60
.61
.62
.63
.51
.51
.52
.53
.54
.55
.44
.44
.45
.46
.46
.36
.37
.38
.38
.29
.30
.31
.54
.48
.42
.35
.28
.19
.35
.31
.27
.23
.18
.13
.19
.16
.14
.11
.08
.09
.08
.06
.04
.04
.03
.02
.94
.71
.48
.98
.79
.91
.91
1.1
.98
.85
.70
.55
.38
1.73
1.47
1.19
1.06
1.04
1.01
Stove Bolts. Have either button or flush head similar to ordinary wood screws, but have threads for nut at end.
Dia. of bolt,
in.
Threads per
in.
A &
ts
T2
ft
%,
32 28 24 22 18 18 16
Carriage Bolts. Have button heads, and below is a square shank
at end of which are threads for a nut.
Diameter
of bolt, in.
Thickness of head,
Diameter
in.
A A A \i 1/916
A & ^ ft
A Vs % %
V/%
9_
9
3 2
16
H
%
JL.
16
1>
2
1J 1A 1%
depends on the length of the bolt, the thread
being about three times the thickness of the nut. See Table of Bolts
The
of head, in. l
length of thread
and Nuts.
132
Unequal Angles
Unequal Angles
Continued
Unequal Angles
Continued
Depth
of
Depth
of
Beams
Continued
Bulb Beams
a
/
-b\
Depth
of
Bulb Angles
Depth
Equal Tees
Zees
Size
Weights and Areas of Square and Round Bars and Circumferences of Round Bars
One cubic foot of steel weighs 489.6 lb.
Thickness
or
Diameter
in Inches
Diameter
in
Inches
Continued
Diameter
in Inches
Continued
in.
to 12
% ins.
16
X
5
16
Vs
7
16
H
9
16
J*
11
16
Ya
13
16
J*
15
16
1*
1A
1M
IN
I*
13^
ift
l*A
l
IX
1H
IK
lit
3"
\/.
3M
U"
3K
3h
4"
Continued
4M"
4U"
4M"
12"
3.19
3.83
4.40
5.10
3.45 3.72
4.-14 4.46
4.83 5.21
5.53 5.95
3.98
4.78
5.58
6. 8
4.25
5.10
5.95
6.80
4.52
5.42
6.32
7.22
5.74
6.38
7.01
7.65
6.22
6.91
7.60
8.29
7.17
7.97
8.77
9.56
7.65
8.50
9.35
10.20
8.13
9.03
9.93
10.84
8.61
9.56
10.52
11.48
9.08
10.09
11.10
12.11
22.95
25.50
28.05
30.60
8.29
8.93
9.56
10.20
8.98
9.67
10.36
11.05
12.43
13.39
14.34
15.30
13.12
14.13
15.14
16.15
33.15
35.70
38.25
40.80
10.84
11.48
12.11
12.75
11.74
12.43
13.12
13.81
12.64
13.39
14.13
14.88
13.55
14.34
15.14
15.94
14.45
15.30
16.15
17.00
15.35
16.26
17.16
18.06
16.26
17.21
18.17
19.13
17.16
18.17
19.18
20.19
43.35
45.90
48.45
51.00
13.39
14.03
14.66
15.30
14.50
15.19
15.88
16.58
15.62
16.36
17.11
17.85
16.73
17.53
18.33
19.13
17.85
18.70
19.55
20.40
18.97
19.87
20.77
21.68
20.08
21.04
21.99
22.95
21.20
22.21
23.22
24.23
53.55
56.10
58.65
61.20
15.92
16.58
17.21
17.85
17.27
17.96
18.65
19.34
18.59
19.34
20.08
20.83
19.92
20.72
21.52
22.31
21.25
22.10
22.95
23.80
22.58
23.48
24.38
25.29
23.91
24.86
25.82
26.78
25.23
26.24
27.25
28.26
63.75
66.30
68.85
71.40
18.49
19.13
19.76
20.40
20.03
20.72
21.41
22.10
21.57
22.31
23.06
23.80
23.11
23.91
24.70
25.50
24.65
25.50
26.35
27.20
26.19
27.09
28.00
28.90
27.73
28.69
29.64
30.60
29.27
30.28
31.29
32.30
73.95
76.50
79.05
81.60
6.69
7.44
8.18
8.93
150
4.78
12.75
5.74 6.06 15.30
6.69 7.07 17.85
7.65 8.08 20.40
16
M
5
5*
o>4'
5K"
&A"
6"
5.58
6.69
7.81
8.93
9.50
10.63
11.69
12.75
10.04
11.16
12.27
13.39
10.52
11.69
12.86
14.03
11.00
12.22
13.44
14.67
11.48
12.75
14.03
15.30
13.81
14.88
15.94
17.00
14.50
15.62
16.73
17.85
15.19
16.36
17.53
18.70
15.88
17.11
18.33
19.55
14
1M
18.06
19.13
20.19
21.25
18.97
20.08
21.20
22.31
19.87
21.04
22.21
23.38
14
1%
14
1
22.31
23.38
24.44
25.50
23.43
24.54
25 .'66
26.78
14
i^
H*
1M
26.56
27.63
28.69
29.75
l'H
30.81
31.88
32.94
34.00
*A
7
16
a
9
16
16
H
16
J*
15
16
1A
1J*
VA
Hi
6M"
63^"
6M"
12'
16
Continued
6.64 6.91
7.97 8.29
7.17
8.61
9.30 9.67 10.04
10.63 11.05 11.48
12.75
15.30
17.85
20.40
11.95
13.28
14.61
15.94
12.43
13.81
15.19
16.58
12.91
14.34
15.78
17.21
22.95
25.50
28.05
30.60
16.58
17.85
19.13
20.40
17.27
18.59
19.92
21.25
17.96
19.34
20.72
22.10
18.65
20.08
21.52
22.95
33 ..15
35.70
38.25
40.80
20.77
21.99
23.22
24.44
21.68
22.95
24.23
25.50
22.58
23.91
25.23
26.56
23.48
24.86
26.24
27.63
24.38
25.82
27.25
28.69
43.35
45.90
48.45
51.00
24.54
25.71
26.88
28.05
25.66
26.88
28.10
29.33
26.78
28.05
29.33
30.60
27.89
29.22
30.55
31.88
29.01
30.39
31.77
33.15
30.12
31.56
32.99
34.43
53.55
56.10
58.65
61.20
27.89
29.01
30.12
31.24
29.22
30.39
31.56
32.73
aO.55
31.77
32.99
34.21
31.88
33.15
34.43
35.70
33.20
34.53
35.86
37.19
34.53
35.91
37.29
38.68
35.86
37.29
38.73
40.16
63.75
66.30
68.85
71.40
32.35
33.47
34.58
35.70
33.89
35.06
36.23
37.40
35.43
36.66
37.88
39.10
36.98
38.25
39.53
40.80
38.52
39.84
41.17
42.50
40.06
41.44
42.82
44.20
41.60
43.03
44.47
45.90
73.95
76.50
79.05
81.60
151
16
H
5
7*
7M"
7K"
7M"
8"
Continued
8M*
m"
8M"
12"
8.23
9.88
11.53
13.18
8.50
10.20
11.90
13.60
8.77
10.52
12.27
14.03
9.03
10.84
12.64
14.45
9.30
11.16
13.02
14.88
12.75
15.30
17.85
20.40
13.39
14.88
16.36
17.85
13.87
15.41
16.95
18.49
14.34
15.94
17.53
19.13
14.82
16.47
18.12
19.76
15.30
17.00
18.70
20.40
15.78
17 53
19.28
21.04
16.26
18.06
19.87
21.68
16.73
18.59
20.45
22.31
22.95
25.50
28.05
30.60
19.34
20.83
22.31
23.80
20.03
21.57
23.11
24.65
20.72 21.41
22.31 23.06
23.91 24.70
25.50 26.35
22.10
23.80
25.50
27.20
22.79
24.54
26.30
28.05
23.48
25.29
27.09
28.90
24.17
26.03
27.89
29.75
33.15
35.70
38.25
40.80
1A
IK
1A
1M
25.29
26.78
28.26
29.75
26.19
27.73
29.27
30.81
27.09
28.69
30.28
31.88
28.00
29.64
31.29
32.94
28.90
30.60
32.30
34.00
29.80
31.56
33.31
35.06
30.71
32.51
34.32
36.13
31.61
33.47
35.33
37.19
43.35
45.90
48.45
51.00
1A
1M
1A
31.24
32.73
34.21
35.70
32.35
33.89
35.43
36.98
33.47
35.06
36.66
38.25
34.58
36.23
37.88
39.53
35.70
37.40
39.10
40.80
36.82 37.93
38.57 39.74
40.32 41.54
42.08 43.35
39.05
40.91
42.77
44.63
53.55
56.10
58.65
61.20
37.19
38.68
40.16
41.65
38.52
40.06
41.60
43.14
39.84
41.44
43.03
44.63
41.17
42.82
44.47
46.11
42.50
44.20
45.90
47.60
43.83
45.58
47.33
49.09
45.16
46.96
48.77
50.58
46.48
48.34
50.20
52.06
63.75
66.30
68.85
71.40
43.14
44.63
46.11
47.60
44.68
46.22
47.76
49.30
46.22
47.81
49.41
51.00
47.76
49.41
51.05
52.70
49.30
51.00
52.70
54.40
50.84
52.59
54.35
56.10
52.38
54.19
55.99
57.80
53.92
55.78
57.64
59.50
73.95
76.50
79.05
81.60
16
H
A
16
Vs
11
16
k
13
16
%
15
16
l?i
1A
US
W
lft
1J>
IK
1 16
152
Continued
16
M
5
9"
5.74
7.65
9k
9V2
5.90 6.06
7.86 8.08
9K*
10"
10M"
10H"
10M"
12"
9.56
11.48
13.39
15.30
9.83
11.79
13.76
15.73
10.09
12.11
14.13
16.15
10.36
12.43
14.50
16.58
10.63
12.75
14.88
17.00
10.89
13.07
15.25
17.43
11.16
13.39
15.62
17.85
11.42
13.71
15.99
18.28
12.75
15.30
17.85
20.40
17.21
19.13
21.04
22.95
17.69
19.66
21.62
23.59
18.17
20.19
22.21
24.23
18.65
20.72
22.79
24.86
19.13
21.25
23.38
25.50
19.60
21.78
23.96
26.14
20.08
22.31
24.54
26.78
20.56
22.84
25.13
27.41
22.95
25.50
28.05
30.60
24.86
26.78
28.69
30.60
25.55
27.52
29.48
31.45
26.24
28.26
30.28
32.30
26.93
29.01
31.08
33.15
27.63
29.75
31.88
34.00
28.32
30.49
32.67
34.85
29.01
31.24
33.47
35.70
29.70
31.98
34.27
36.55
33.15
35.70
38.25
40.80
32.51
34.43
36.34
38.25
33.42
35.38
37.35
39.31
34.32
36.34
38.36
40.38
35.22
37.29
39.37
41.44
36.13
38.25
40.38
42.50
37.03
39.21
41.38
43.56
37.93
40.16
42.39
44.63
38.83
41.12
43.40
45.69
43.35
45.90
48.45
51.00
1H
40.16
42.08
43.99
45.90
41.28
43.24
45.21
47.18
42.39
44.41
46.43
48.45
43.51
45.58
47.65
49.73
44.63
46.75
48.88
51.00
45.74
47.92
50.10
52.28
46.86
49.09
51.32
53.55
47.97
50.26
52.54
54.83
53.55
56.10
58.65
61.20
lft
1^8
ltt
lJi
47.81
49.73
51.64
53.55
49.14
51.11
53.07
55.04
50.47
52.49
54.51
56.53
51.80
53.87
55.94
58.01
53.13
55.25
57.38
59.50
54.45
56.63
58.81
60.99
55.78
58.01
60.24
62.48
57.11
59.39
61.68
63.96
63.75
66.30
68:85
71.40
55.46
57.38
59.29
61.20
57.00
58.97
60.93
62.90
58.54
60.56
62.58
64.60
60.08
62.16
64.23
66.30
61.63
63.75
65.88
68.00
63.17
65.34
67.52
69.70
64.71
66.94
69.17
71.40
66.25
68.53
70.82
73.10
73.95
76.50
79.05
81.60
T6
Vs
7
16
y2
9
16
%
M
11
16
13
16
15
16
lft
lft
1M
lft
i%
lft
m
i%
m
153
16
ii"
7.01
9.35
ilk
UM"
7.17 7.33
9.56 9.78
12"
115*
12M"
Continued
12^''
12%"
CO
16
%
16
a
7
11.69
14.03
16.36
18.70
11.95
14.34
16.73
19.13
12.22
14.66
17.11
19.55
21.04
23.38
25.71
28.05
21.52
23.91
26.30
28.69
21.99
24.44
26.88
29.33
22.47
24.97
27.47
29.96
4-i
%
11
16
22.95
25.50
28.05
30.60
23.43
26.03
28.63
31.24
23.91
26.56
29.22
31.88
24.38
27.09
29.80
32.51
.s
iO
<n
*3
9
16
ii
||
s^
"
airs
13.
16
%
15
16
ItV
1A
1M
1A
ItV
IK
1A
Hi
m
m
IVs
30.39
32.73
35.06
37.40
00
31.77
34.21
36.66
39.10
32.46
34.96
37.45
39.95
33.15
35.70
38.25
40.80
33.84
36.44
39.05
41.65
34.53
37.19
39.84
42.50
42.45
44.94
47.44
49.94
43.35
45.90
48.45
51.00
44.25
46.86
49.46
52.06
45.16
47.81
50.47
53.13
46.06
48.77
51.48
54.19
31.08
33.47
35.86
38.25
o
P
a>
:
o3 !>
49.09
51.43
53.76
56.10
50.20
52.59
54.98
57.38
51.32
53.76
56.21
58.65
52.43 53.55
54.93 56.10
57.43 58.65
59.93 61.20
54.67
57.27
59.87
62.48
55.78
58.44
61.09
63.75
56.90
59.61
62.32
65.03
58.44
60.78
63.11
65.45
59.77
62.16
64.55
66.94
61.09
63.54
65.98
68.43
62.42
64.92
67.42
69.91
63.75
66.30
68.85
71.40
65.08
67.68
70.28
72.89
66.41
69.06
71.72
74.38
67.73
70.44
73.15
75.86
67.79
70.13
72.46
74.80
69.33
71.72
74.11
76.50
70.87
73.31
75.76
78.20
72.41
74.91
77.40
79.90
73.95
76.50
79.05
81.60
75.49
78.09
80.70
83.30
77.03
79.69
82.34
85.00
78.57
81.28
83.99
86.70
154
O)
!>
03
0tJ
II
CM
"g.3
*
S3
to
o3
155
Copper.
There
Lake, and
and
is
state
and
Lake
very pure.
is
handling.
in conductivity
Copper is very ductile and malleable and can be rolled into sheets,
drawn into wire, or cast. Electric conductivity equal to that of
Cast copper tensile strength 25,000,
silver fuses at around 1930 F.
elastic limit 6,000, copper plates, rods and bolts tensile strength
33,500, elastic limit 10,000, annealed wire 30,000 tensile strength
and elastic limit 10,000. Weight per cubic foot 554 lb. Sp. gr. 8.9.
Aluminum. A very
ductile and malleable.
Can be welded by
2.56.
electricity.
Zinc
is
less
436
lb.
weather.
Tin
It
is
is
lb.
is
and
Alloys
air.
and
from moisture.
Weight
of copper
tin
SHIPBUILDING MATERIALS
156
in bells
25%.
S.
7^%
8.66.
Titan Bronze
gold.
is
while ordinary brass is only slightly malleable. It resists corrosion better than brass and is suitable for pump plungers, propeller
bolts,
motor boat
60,000 to 63,000
shafts, etc.
20%
May
be obtained in bars, in
which case it has a tensile strength of 70,000 to 80,000, elastic
limit 40,000 to 48,000, elongation 40% in 2 ins., reduction of area
inch, elongation 15 to
in 2 ins."
45 to 50%.
Tobin Bronze
copper, y% to 1J^% tin and remainder zinc. Tensile strength 60,000 to 65,000, compression
170,000 to 180,000. Weight per cubic foot 525 lb. Sp. gr. 8.4.
salt water.
Contains 59 to
Manganese Bronze
contains
56%
copper, about
41%
zinc
and
outboard castings of
63%
tin,
strength 60,000.
Brasses. These consist of alloys of copper and zinc, the percentage of zinc varying from 10 to 50%. Brass castings have a
45%
20,000.
lb.
WOOD
Muntz Metal
157
is
Is not affected
ing to the U. S.
by
Navy
of at least 60,000,
an
and an elongation
When
salt water.
requirements
it
must show a
of
not
less
than
25%
in
Common Alloys
Alloy
J/
tensile strength
the ultimate strength
two
inches.
SHIPBUILDING MATERIALS
158
when
first
flat grain.
The
all
drier the
trees of the
spruces, hemlocks,
firs,
In the U.
S.
As no two
make
the required
same
trees of the
strength, and
within rather wide limits, so in making comparisons and in all
strength calculations an ample factor of safety should be taken.
Soft
Alpine
Spruce, Englemann
Cedar, Western Red
Cedar, Northern White.
Fir,
Pine, White
Pine, Lodgepole
Pine, Western Yellow
Pine, Sugar
Fir,
White
Pine, Table
Mountain
219
243
246
266
296
315
320
324
328
333
Woods
Pine, Norway
Spruce, Red
Cypress
Tamarack
Fir, Grand
Hemlock, Eastern
Douglas Fir
Hemlock, Black
Pine, Longleaf
342
346
354
375
375
406
408
464
512
HARD WOOD
SIZES
159
Hard Woods
Basswood
Buckeye, Yellow
Willow, Black
Butternut
Cherry, Red
Elm, White
Ash, Black
.
242
286
334
386
386
511
548
580
592
612
664
700
745
Sycamore
Maple, Silver.
Maple, Red
Cherry, Black
Tupelo
Birch, Yellow
Ash,
752
824
882
888
941
982
Pumpkin
Beech
Maple, Hard
Elm, Rock
Ash, White
Oak, Red
Oak, White
Oak, Swamp White
Laurel, Mountain.
1063
1158
1299
1408
1568
1846
Dogwood
Locust, Black
Locust, Honey
Osage, Orange
2037
Hard Wood
The standard
sizes
Sizes
2V2
3,
3K,
4,
4}i
5,
5H
and 6
ins.
Surfaced
Rough
ins.
S-2-S* to
T6 ins.
"
"
__
16
JL.
16
134
IMins. S-2-S
"
2
2J^
11
_9_
16
((
13.
3H
16
"
a
'
1 32
111.
x 32
Surfaced
Rough
to
13^
ins.
1%
2M
2^
"
"
"
"
334
3M
Lumber
full
of the
above thicknesses.
A-m.
SHIPBUILDING MATERIALS
160
Soft
Wood
Sizes
The standard
Common Woods.
is
oars,
red, the
little.
Weight per cubic foot 43 to 45 lb. Sp. gr. .75. Crushing strength
along the fiber in pounds per square inch, 5,000 to 9,000.
Balsa, very light;
life
made
of
it.
Black walnut, heavy, strong and durable; for cabinet work and
Weight per cubic foot 38 lb. Sp. gr. .61.
interior, decoration.
Cedar
in contact
with water.
Used
durable
motor
There is
durable.
lb.
28
lb.
may
Cypress, light, hard, close grained and durable, adapted for both
outside and inside work. Weight per cubic foot 30 lb.
Sp. gr. .48.
as
Douglas fir. This term covers the timber known
yellow fir,
red
fir,
Note.
Only
common
in ship construction.
The
specific gravity and weight of the same wood varies; the value given is a fair
average for seasoned wood. The moisture contents varies in seasoned timber from
15 to 20% and in green timber up to 50%.
Sp. gr. and weight from 10th U. S.
Census.
HACKMATACK
161
Lignum vitae, hard, strong and close grained with fibers running
Is resinous and is difficult to split.
radially and tangentially.
Is used in ship's blocks, and stern and outboard bearings.
Tensile
strength along the fiber 14,800
Weight per cubic foot 60 to 65
lb.
lb.
Pine (short-leaf),
much
Pine
known
as the loblolly.
and
easily
worked.
Weight
Varieties:
strong,
deal has a tough, straight grain which makes it an excellent maSpars, paddles and oars are often made of spruce.
SHIPBUILDING MATERIALS
162
Black spruce
is
piling.
foot 27
lb.
wood
armor backing,
contact with
it.
lb.
9.
Consists of hemp
is
final
seams
of the
seams.
where
laid as
a covering for the shell plating in the inner bottom. It not only
protects the plating against the corrosive action of foul bilge water
and
boilers,
brine.
Magnesia
expensive.
15% asbestos
it
ASBESTOS
163
85%
ft.
fall
to
felt
may
exists.
efficiencies of
are asbestocel,
the
76.8%,
and
is
is
Next to
made
into pipe form so there are air cells, thus giving (as air is an excellent non-conductor of heat) a cheap and efficient covering.
For
85%
mesh and
SHIPBUILDING MATERIALS
164
wood
Sheet iron
is
strips.
S.
Navy Department
NON-CONDUCTING MATERIALS
165
loss
is
taken as 100%)
Substance
Int.
Heat Loss
Per Cent.
100
105
107
95
15
50
75
30
20
25
20
20
22
25
Loose wool
Geese feathers
Felt, hair, or wool
Carded cotton
Mineral wool
Carbonate of magnesia
Rice chaff, loose
Paper
Cork
Sawdust
Wood
Wood
ashes
across grain.
Coal ashes
Asbestos, paper
Asbestos, fibrous
Air space undivided.
Sand
Value
SECTION IV
SHIP CALCULATIONS
Length over all is" the length measured from the foremost tip of
the stem bar to the aftermost tip of the overhang of the stern.
Length between Perpendiculars. For vessels with straight
vertical stems, the length between perpendiculars is taken from the
fore side of the stem bar to the aft side of the stern post.
When
inclined
the stem is raked, that is,
forward, the length is measured
from the fore side of the stem bar at the upper deck. Should the
vessel have a clipper or curved stem, the length is measured from
the point where the line of the upper deck beams would intersect
the fore edge of the stem if it were produced in the same direction
as the part below the cutwater.
Lloyd's Length is measured from the fore part of the stem to the
after part of the stern post on the range of the upper deck beams
except in awning or shelter-deck vessels, in which cases the length
is measured on the range of the deck beams next below the awning
In vessels in which the stem forms a cutwater the
or shelter deck.
length is measured from the point where the upper-deck beam line
would intersect the fore edge of the stem if it were produced in the
same direction as the part below the cutwater. In vessels having
cruiser sterns, the length is taken as 96% of the extreme length
from the fore part of the stem on the range of the upper-deck
beams to the aftermost part of the cruiser stern, but it is not to be
less than the length from the fore part of the stem to the after
side of sternpost when fitted, or to the fore side of the rudder stock
when a
sternpost
for
is
not
fitted.
Length
Extreme breadth is measured over the outside plating at the
greatest breadth of the vessel.
Breadth molded is taken over the frames at the greatest breadth.
166
DEPTH OF HOLD
167
Figure 18
Depth
of
Hold
is
Most
vessels
any point
is
ins.
high; so
if
the
SHIP CALCULATIONS
168
Extreme
tions
10
ft.
10,
3 ins. or
if
ins.
Proportions. A vessel
it,
ft.
is
In
The displacement
divided by 35, and when
board.
in cubic feet
when
and 36
cu.
ft.
of fresh water
The displacement
lines,
of a steel vessel
7bns
is
is
made
Sao
Figure
19.
CURVE OF DISPLACEMENT
169
2240
lb.
water
on.
line,
WL'
off to
any convenient
WL
W,
W,
etc., to
is
the
Dead weight
is
coal.
of the displacement.
The registry of a vessel as prescribed
equals about
by the U.
is
S.
64%
Treasury
as follows:
The registry of every vessel shall express her length and breadth, together with
her depth and the height under the third or spar deck, which shall be ascertained
in the following manner:
The tonnage deck in vessels having three or more
decks shall be the second deck from below; in all other cases the upper deck is the
tonnage deck. The length from the fore part of the outer planking on the side of
the stem to the after part of the main stern-post of screw steamers and to the
deck
shall
Gross tonnage
is
is
payment
SHIP CALCULATIONS
170
is
Cubic grain measurement is sometimes taken one or two inches inside the molded lines.
Cubic bale measurement is generally understood as being to the
bpttom of the deck beams and to the inboard face of the reverse
frames.
of
Immersion.
how much
If
ment
is
if
the area of a water plane in square feet, then the displaceof a layer 1 ft. thick, supposing the vessel to be parallel sided,
A X
is
= A
cu.
ft.,
or
OO
is
tons,
and
For a layer
this is the
number
1 in.,
in.
of
or
How
(1) A steamer 350 ft. long, 45 ft. beam, has a draft of 20 ft.
tons must be placed on board to make her sink 1 in.?
First find the area of the water plane, assuming a coefficient of fineness of the
water plane as .85. Then the area is
Examples.
many
.85
,
of
= 31.8
immersion =
Therefore,
aboard to
350
j^tj
is
drawing 20
ft.,
_ _
tons.
(2) At a draft of 16 ft., the tons per inch of immersion of a steamer are 12.5.
75 tons of cargo were removed, find the decrease in draft and the new draft.
75
Decrease in draft = Yo~Z = ^ * n3,
1Z.O
If
'
New
draft
16 ft* 6
ins.
15
ft.
ins.
171
1, 2, 3, etc.
(in
t-zo
Z o&c/ A/crfer/. //
/O
Figure 20.
/3 Tans
/Z
//
L
B = beam
For
in
ft.
For medium
For cargo
The
immersion
coefficient of fineness of
immersion
immersion
water plane
is
Let
LXB
600
LXB
650
LXB
500
of the
fine
the ratio between the volume of the displacement and a solid having a transverse area equal to the area of
the immersed midship section multiplied by the length taken for
Prismatic coefficient
is
SHIP CALCULATIONS
172
The
coefficient of fineness of
midship section
is
The
rectangle.
its
circumscribing
from
.85 to .95,
the latter value being for a section with a very flat bottom.
The block coefficient is the ratio of the volume of the displacement to the volume of a block having the same length, breadth and
mean
draft.
vessels:
Barges
cargo vessels up to 8 knots
Full cargo vessels up to 12 knots
Very
Sailing yachts
to
to
76
7
65
6
coefficients
Wetted Surface
mean
Steam yachts
D =
to
Sailing vessels
to
Let
85
to .82
56 to .6
46 to .57
6 to 65
48 to .55
4 to 48
6 to 72
45 to .6
3 to 52
Battleships
Cruisers
trawlers, tugs
Above
to
76
7
65
6
Steam
85 to
.8
full
is
Wetted surface
ft.;
in sq.
H.
Biles.
displacement in tons;
draft in
of Ships, J.
it.
or
or
or
V =
=
volume
1.7
=v
length of vessel in
of displacement in cu.
L X D
15.5
(L
L =
-\-
ft.;
ft.
V
~;
VW X L,
(+4f)
mean
draft to the tbp of the keel, the latter (.45) being the value
For yachts and vessels of unusual shape
TRANSVERSE METACENTER
173
Let
cu. ft.;
V = volume
A = area of
top of keel in
of
ft.
buoyancy below
of
\32
To
and
^A
J
buoyancy
of a
Station
is,
No.
5.
SHIP CALCULATIONS
174
<
,
Figure 21
If
the vessel
new water
is
line,
of
L'
is
displacement has
the
its
center
this point M
called the metaM the transverse metacentric height.
M, and
of the vessel at
is
of
Ship
HEIGHT OF METACENTER
175
is
more comfortable
in a
seaway.
the couple
If
If
If
G
G
G
is
it
will
X G Z.
is
is
is
is
is
librium.
and
if
is
above
moment
moment
The above is called
called the
method
the metacentric
vessel's stability,
of determining a
up
to 15.
vessel 250
centric height of 2
ft.
ft.
ins.
is
(See
long having a displacement of 3300 tons has a metaWhat is her righting moment if she is inclined at an
angle of 12 degrees?
Righting
moment =
To Find Height
X G M X sin
X 2.5 X sin
3300
12
1715
ft.-tons.
of
= draft in feet
B = beam in feet
a = a coefficient varying between
,
.57
and
.54,
depending on
The
SHIP CALCULATIONS
176
C =
C X B
'
To Find
the
parts
Number
of
Ordinate
follows:
Center
number
of
DISPLACEMENT SHEET
177
Approximate Formula for the Distance of the Transverse Metacenter above the Center of Buoyancy.
The formula
B = beam
Let
is
-==
in feet
D =
a
.1
a block coefficient of
Then
BM -
.75)
-jj
for small,
and
Mm
.15, .33
X IK =
-50, etc.
sum
in the
1,
.15
Add
.4
column functions
.2
of areas.
.4
.1
1-25
and
l
by Simpson's multipliers as A, 2, l A, 4, etc., writing
the products in the column multiples of areas. Add up this column
tions of areas
SHIP CALCULATIONS
178
3256 and multiply it by }4 of each interval and by 3^ of the distance the water lines are apart, thus,
X 2 ft. X Vz X 9.5 ft. X 2 (as half-breadths were taken), which will
which
is
To
and
aft center of
by 9.5 ft., the distance the ordinates are apart, and the product
divided by the sum of the multiples of areas will give the location
of the center of buoyancy; in the present vessel it is aft of No. 6,
the midship ordinate, a distance of 1.83 ft.
To
multiplier
giving .50; do the same for the next half -breadth,
as .33 by 2, giving .66, writing the products in the column to the
Continue thus for the other water lines, and add
right and so on.
up each as
son's multipliers as
with arms
them by Simp-
J^, 1, 2, 3, etc.,
the
sum
of
which
is
9416.47.
Multiply
9416.47 by the distance the water lines are apart or 2 ft., and divide
by the sum of the multiples of areas, the quotient being 5.78 ft.,
which is the distance the center of buoyancy is above the base line.
Station
by using a planimeter
Thus for the displace-
CENTER OF BUOYANCY
179
Station
p
o
co
00
00
00
do
O
o
t*
CO
lO
<M
SHIP CALCULATIONS
182
verse center of
by the formula
I being the
-=^,
Thus
~
V
moment
is
given
of inertia of the
1t
<
13748
To
ordinates
Add up
Water Plane.
of
product by the sum of the functions of ordinates 289.12, the quotient being the distance the center of gravity of the water plane is
aft of No. 6 ordinate.
Multiply the functions for the center of gravity of the water
plane by the arms 5, 43^, 4, etc., writing the products in the column
of functions for moment of inertia, the sum of the products being
1758.32.
As the
Let /
y
= moment
= distance
of inertia
nate
A = sum
A distance
2
ordi-
Then
the
new moment
of inertia I
of gravity of
Ay
2
given by the expression I = I
By referring to page 181 the various calculations are shown,
is the distance begiving a value of I as 982923. Hence if B
is
ume
the
moment
of
the quotient
height.
is
64.2
ft.,
which
is
the
longitudinal
~ and
982923
?
sub-
then
metacentric
CURVES OF STABILITY
Curves of
Stability.*
183
arm
found.
buoyancy
The
resulting curves (see Fig. 22) are important and are often
given to the captain so he will know the condition of his vessel
minimum
being 3
ft.
The important
grees.
the inclination
of the curve to the base line at its origin, the angle at which the
maximum inclination occurs, and the length of the righting lever
at this angle.
it
but no cargo,
stores or fresh water on board, and all ballast tanks
bunker
coal,
is light,
water in
boilers,
empty.
(2)
B same
as
(1),
coal, stores
and
fresh water
on board.
h^iO(NOWhO
"r-lCONHCOOOOOO
-r^rjopo'iccioo
<N<N<NCMl-li-t,-lr-l
u c
a>
a<
o
pT3
*-
he
^ o <n o
lO
'-
ct>
feS? 2
&0<N
CO CO CO <*
,
S'
S be
3 C
-<tf
-<tf
T3
rt
v,
;ooo(Ncocor-iT-((M
'CO<N
C?Ohh
5
P
+i C <N CO b- 10 Oi Oi
'ON
1> OS tH OJ
^OCNJrHOiOOS'-IOi
1
J
T-H
*-<
CI
CI
^I>OiCO(N(MOCO(N
4-i
iMINhhmim
e3
JO.
o^
eq
ICO
-iO
O
bfi
O
4>
42
V V
*i
cyj
GO
oo
l>N
QCGO
00 00
oo
(N<N
COCO
'coco
ZJ
>
03
O
^pqoQHfeOW
184
homogeneous cargo
summer
(4)
load
185
line.
same as
(3),
with bunker
coal,
stores
and
fresh water
same as
consumed.
Cross Curves of
(7),
Stability.*
when
coal, stores
and
fresh water
conditions as,
after body,
angles.
the vessel
is light,
Make
the calculation
first for
line
Figure 23
From A
class
and the
inclined
J.
Lovett.
SHIP CALCULATIONS
186
Draw
plane.
are taken.
Ordinates
XX
a line
perpendicular to the inclined water
the line about which the moments of the wedges
Prepare a table as follows for the submerged wedge.
This
is
187
is
SHIP CALCULATIONS
188
XG
In Si
note
if
GZ
sin
= B
RB G sin
= B R
BM
Also find
by
BR
this is
setting up
inclinations.
BR
same manner
Proceed to find
When
in the
GZ
Run
lines
To
GZ
The
show constant inclination at varying displacements. The stability curves show constant displacement at varying inclinations. The cross curves show the value of the righting
arm G Z. A curve of righting moments could also be made showcross curves
In
[displacement] X G Z).
ing the foot-tons (the value of
drawn
to
the
the
sections
are
uppermost
preparing the body plan
continuous deck. If a watertight poop, bridge or forecastle become
of their
station-
NOTES ON STABILITY
189
Notes on Stability. For ordinary vessels the transverse metacenter remains practically unchanged up to 10 inclination. The
should not be less than 10 ins. and have a righting
value of G
arm
30
SO
/.3
70
&o
Figure 26
An
righting lever of 8
but 2
board
ft.
in stability, as the stability immediately begins to decrease when the edge of the deck gets under
water, so that every additional inch of freeboard increases the
is
an important factor
vessel's range.
normal water
GM =
is
inclined, that
line
and the
is,
inclined
center of gravity
and the
metacenter
BM =
distance
the
metacenter
is
of
buoyancy.
GZ =
righting
arm
Then
GZ =
sin
.0
+ ^-^- tan
sin
Up
is
The
values at inclinations of
SHIP CALCULATIONS
190
and 20 are
15
10,
Thus, suppose a vessel draws 12 ft. forward and 15 ft. aft; then she
is said to trim 3 ft. by the stern.
Longitudinal Metacenter. Let B (see Fig. 27) be the center of
buoyancy when floating on an even keel,
L, and suppose the trim
of the vessel to change, the displacement being the same, then Bi
is the new center of buoyancy.
a vertical line meeting
Draw B\
at
tance
M.
Then
Figure 27
in tons,
Gi
G = G
tan $
change of trim
length of load water
Change
L X w X
WXGM
is
moved, then
WXGM
line
of trim in feet
tan 6
moment
get the
Therefore the
WXGM
L X
12
w X
W XGM
w X a
12
L
W X GM
i
change of trim
length of load
191
one inch or
line'
moment
t
1
y* ^
z foot,
thus
'
=w X
a=
-=
foot-tons.
Example. A 350-ft. steamer, displacement 6700 tons at her designed draft, has
a longitudinal metacentric height of 350 ft.
If 10 tons of cargo in her forward
hold was moved 100 ft. aft, find the change in trim.
a/t
++to change
u
Moment
u
trim one inch
WXGM
=
Li
Moment
aft
1*
Hence change
of trim aft
6700
ooO
100
ft.
X
X
=
350
55.8 foot-tons.
1^
1000 foot-tons.
17.9 ins.
o5.8
--
=
Li
1^
In
the formula,
foot-tons,
if
is
moment
assumed
W
foot-tons.
T =
A =
L =
B =
V =
W=
The
results
closer
than the
feet
displacement in tons
buoyancy
assuming
B^
,,
M
^ ** and
= G
M,
i
as
ttt
is
= v l-
A XL
2
.0735
f displacement
^z
= V
05
SHIP CALCULATIONS
192
Then
L
35
x
A
moment
the
trim
alter
one
XV
moment
for the
T =
y =
L =
Then the
displacement
A
ft.
displacement
steamer 350
by the
ins.
draft of 20
is
ft.
is
The displacement
ft.
when
Floating
Out
of
extra
displacement curve
for 2
= 190
= 180
=172
of a Vessel
for
14
ft.
long,
ft.
draws 17
When
stern.
At a
is
foot-tons.
Example.
trimming 7
what
T2
^7
12
draft
T X
f
Li
A*
30.9 X
12
Another formula
inch
A2XL
0735
T
to
1)^
ins.
'-
5850 tons.
for
12
35
;r
o5U
14
16.8 tons,
and
37.8 tons.
To Find
'-
37.8
5887.8 tons.
is
Above the
Center of Buoyancy.
Let V = volume of displacement in cubic feet
I Q = moment of inertia of water plane about a transverse
axis passing through the center of flotation.
Then the
M = ^.
See Meta-
any Mean Draft and Longitudinal Position of the Center of Gravity by Trim Lines or Curves.*
L to represent the mean draft for
Draw a line
See. Fig. 28.
* From
and
Calculations
Cons., G. Nicol.
Ship
To Find
the
Trim Corresponding
to
On
line is required.
193
and a
vessel.
line
NN
Thus the
of
buoyancy
of
it.
is
is
buoyancy
drawn representing the midship
distance
taken
is
at a level
line of the
BN
Figure 28
The
vessel
trimming 2
Change
of trim
by the stern
ft.
of the center of
is
buoyancy
of the
calculated as follows:
tan
(for
change of trim
length of water line
Gi equals nearly B B h or the distance between the centers of buoyancy before and after the trim has been changed, so
Now G
G G = B B = G M X tan 0.
G M is approximately equal
l
water
line,
then substituting
GGi = B B = G
x
tan
= L and
= L X
tan $
change of trim
on the
^-=
line required.
SHIP CALCULATIONS
194
line
movement
when a change
towards
plus
W should be the
BG X
tan
0.
It
is
This
is
due to the movement of weights on board. For if the distance the center of gravity travels aft on account of the movement
of the weights be ascertained and plotted from B along the level line
C, and a vertical line be erected to intercept the trim fine at D, C D
must be the trim by the stern, as the center of buoyancy and center
sired),
of gravity are
A
of
trim line
displacement
only reliable at
is
its
considerable
own
line.
draft,
a new curve
and
light.
Damaged Compartment.
To find the
effect
195
its
true
position.
It will next be necessary to calculate the weight of water in the
compartment, assuming the surface to rise to the level of the new
draft,
and to use
should differ
same way
in the
it
much from
the
first
in
calculation,
may
If this
be necessary
to proceed to a third.
Or instead of the above, which is the trim line method, first determine the amount of mean sinkage due to the loss of buoyancy,
and second, determine the change
of trim caused.
Her
Let
Side.
A =
g
V =
The volumejn
8
line in feet
Then
ond =
is
V =
\/2 g
= S\/H
approximately
VH X A
Example.
= 8 \/h X A = 8 \/l X
= 32 X 60 = 1920.
1920
..^
=32.
54 85 tons.
.
Calculating the Trim by the Trim Line Method when a CompartAssume a box-shaped vessel 210 ft. long, 30 ft.
is Flooded.*
beam, and 20 ft. deep, drawing 10 ft. forward and aft. Suppose
ment
she
is
in collision
Find the
draft.
after
end
is
flooded
SHIP CALCULATIONS
196
WL
at 2
and 4
ft.
30 X
X
210
10
2y
2.
volume
of the
first
line,
L and W* L
of displacement L S L 2
is half the vessel's length,
wedge
is
105
1
moves
and L
1575 cu.
to
tan
then
2)
w X
35
1800
to
to the position
ft.,
one
and
g\
foot, the
in
moving
g2 or
140 #ft.
W XGM
1800
That
B B2 = G M X
a B
B
r > = 1575
and
vessel
when
WL
105X2*
from
those
stern.
is
ft.
W L the wedge
W S W As S L
2
method,
by the
ft.
Assuming the
is
line
is
buoyancy
tan 6
x
X
140
1575
140
1800
35
X 140 = 35
Q( ft
n
X 35
,
Trim
same manner.
can be obtained
Weight
of
Fig.
85.71
tons/
Parallel sinkage assuming water situated amidships
ment open
to sea
= 85.71X35X12 =
1200 X SO
and compart-
mS
'
compartment
flooded
is
10
ft.
long.
ft.,
is
now 200
ft.,
as the
197
water at the increased draft to move into its true position and the
ship's bottom to be intact:
new draft of 10' 6" X 10' length X 30' beam
= 90 tons
w =
35
a
210'
10' (length of
2
:
compartment)
-
Gfla !|a
w a )Xia),
1890
,_100
.;
ft.
+ 90 tons =
1890 tons
t7flfl
A.
Figure 30
Forward =
9'
0^
Aft
11'
v
1W
0"
+ parallel
sinkage of 6*
10' 0"
+ parallel
sinkage of 6"
10'
Y2 (2'
10M") =
Vz (2' 10Ji")
SHIP CALCULATIONS
198
trim.
The weight
11.86
10
30
35
D
,
Parallel
of the
be
101.66 tons.
101.66 tons X 35
smkage =
210 ft
will
cu.
ft.
30
12
ins.
ft
ins
'
nearly.
of gravity
101.66
1800
X~
2
+ 101.66
5.35
ft. aft.
line,
and
2%
ft.
= w X
By
Forward
10' 0'
Aft
10' 0"
Calculating the
Trim
and adding
aft,
become
8' 1
12'
6% ins.
as the
2Y% W
when a Compartment
by
Sinkage
A
Flooded.*
rectangular lighter 100
long, 40
ft.
ft.
beam, 10
ft.
is
deep,
of
to the loss of
buoyancy.
w G = w H X 40
volume G B = G L X 40
ft.
For the
ft.
GL X 40X3
(2)
*
Change
X
X
18..
of trim.
Architecture, L. T. Attwood.
x
3
ft.
01/
Volume
WHEN COMPARTMENT
IS
Displacement
100
40
35
2400
7
FLOODED
100
342
40
tons,
X
is
199
and
50
ft.
this
from
SHIP CALCULATIONS
200
7200
line
1028
66
66
= 15H
ins.
of the
47
100
53
100
X 15^ - 7H ins.
X 15^ - 8M
ins.
New draft aft = 3 ft. + 2J ins. [from (1)] - 7}iins. = 2 ft. 7 ins.
New draft forward = 3 ft. + 2% ins. [from (1)] + 8M ins. =
ft. 10K ins.
CENTER OF GRAVITY.
Coincident with the calculations of the displacement and centers of buoyancy, are made calculations of the fore and aft, and vertical positions of the common center of gravity of the hull, machinery and cargo. The fore and aft position of the center of
gravity of all the weights must come over the fore and aft position
of the center of buoyancy.
If on the first estimate it does not,
To
and
line of the
a table as follows:
CENTER OF GRAVITY
Assuming the moments
moments
aft
moments
201
is
aft
of amidships.
To
table thus
Items
SHIP CALCULATIONS
202
moments
aft
moments
,;;
aft to
=p-
aft of midships.
To
Dist. Cent, of
Item
Weight
Grav. Above
Base
Moment
Hull
Boilers
Engines.
Cargo
Cargo
in forward hold
in aft hold
&c.
W
The sum
of the
moments
is
The
203
Example. A weight of 30 tons was raised from the hold and placed on the deck
steamer at a distance of 20 ft. from its Original position. The steamer had a
displacement of 1000 tons. Find the distance the center of gravity was raised.
of a
weight X distance
displacement
(2)
30 X 20
1000
In
"
ft '
weight
by
its
ft.
weight X distance
displacement -weight
(3)
Adding a Weight.
How much
==
30 X 10
1000 - 30
,3
'**
distance
its
displacement.
Example. A weight of 30 tons was placed on board of a steamer with an original
displacement of 1000 tons 10 ft. below her center of gravity. Find the distance
the center of gravity was lowered.
weight X distance
displacement + weight
30 X 10
1000 + 30
300
1030
'
28
ft "
to starboard.
of 1000 tons.
weight
distance
"
displacement.
20 X 10
1000
-2
ft.
to starboard.
Example.
100
By
(2)
move
vertically
By
(4)
move
horizontally
100
4 5
.
4000
18
-H
ft.
45
ft
SHIP CALCULATIONS
204
In this case, however, the angle of heel is usually calculated instead of the distance the center of gravity moves. Thus in the above example assuming the
20 X 10
20 X 10
=
steamer had a G
of 2 ft. the angle of heel would be
1000 X G
1000 X 2
= .10, consulting the table of natural sines, the angle is found to be 5 degs. 75 mins.
is
no value
lined above, or
it
described below.
is
perfectly upright.
hatches (sometimes two at
line
when the
A weight
3,
vessel
is
inclined.
shifted
noted.
If
Then
W
a
I
GM
=
=
=
=
=
Then (?I =
*
and
similarly 4 is
the weights are returned to their original position.
deviation of the
of 2.
and the
moved on top
1
plumb
line noted,
plumb
plumb
distance weight
line
line in ins.
is
moved
in
ins.
ft.
distance between the center of gravity and the transverse metaeenter in ft.
wXdwXdXl
Wx *
WXa
Architecture, E. L. Attwood.
FREEBOARD
205
Example. A steamer has a displacement of 5372 tons, and draws 16 ft. 9 ins.
forward and 22 ft. 10 ins. aft. Weight used for inclining 50 tons, which was moved
36 ft. Length of plumb line 15 ft. Two plumb lines were used.
SHIP CALCULATIONS
206
roundup
of
Deck
is
its
built
pre-
Board
shown
of
in Fig. 32.
meas-
urement.
legally,
<o
\*.
<u
^S
55
<6
\?
207
<VJ
<
5T
^*
SHIP CALCULATIONS
208
beams
of 34 inch per foot of beam, and has a mean sheer in accordance with that derived from the curves shown on Plate 4.
by the curves
are:
1.
Type
2.
Dimensions
3.
4.
Mean sheer
Round of beam
5.
6.
Coefficient of fineness
of ship
The type
is
placed)
ship's registry.
The depth for freeboard
vessels,
is
side in spar
vessels
and three-deck
is
V>
*o
*Q
209
Y>
^w
SHIP CALCULATIONS
210
when
In a steamer 357
ft.,
ft.
long,
registered tonnage under
deck 2,980 tons, molded depth 29.8 ft., under deck capacity 298,000
that is, the product of the length,
cu. ft., which divide by 382,000
breadth, and depth of hold the quotient is .78 or the coefficient
of fineness.
out erections and length 12 times the molded depth) is 7 ft. 7 ins.,
which corresponds to a reserve buoyancy of 32% of the total bulk.
Vessels rarely conform to the proportions assumed for the standard, and the correct determination of freeboard for the actual
corrected)
Sheer. The tables are framed for vessels having a mean sheer
measured with
reference to the deck at the middle of the length, and where the
lowest point of the sheer is abaft the middle of the length, one-half
of the difference between the sheer amidships and the lowest point
should be added to the freeboard specified in the tables for flush
deck vessels and for vessels having short poops and forecastles only.
Erections on Deck. For steam vessels with topgallant fore-
castles
SHIP CALCULATIONS
212
When
end, a deduction
may
and bridge
house only, the latter in steamers covering the engine and boiler
openings, and being efficiently inclosed with an iron bulkhead at
each end, a deduction may be made from the freeboard given in
the curves according to Curve C, Plate 4.
When the erections on a steamer consist of a short poop or raised
quarter deck of a height from 3 ft. to 6 ft. for lengths of ship of 250 ft.
to 400 ft., and topgallant forecastle only, the former being inclosed
at the fore end with an efficient bulkhead, and when the engine and
boiler openings are entirely covered, a deduction may be made
from the freeboard given in the curves according to Curve D,
Plate
4.
Table
Correction in freeboard for a
ROUND OF BEAM
A
(Curves
should be
213
of the length of the
table.
Round
of
Beam.
In
buoyancy an
allowance has been made for the roundup of 34 inch for every foot
When the total roundup of the
of the length of the midship beam.
beam
deck uncovered.
when
The
standard type:
A vessel 234
side 4
ft.
ins.,
and
aft
ft. 1 in.
Ft.
The mean
sheer
in the vessel,
11
1H
vided by 4
mean
Ins.
ins.
sheer
9 J^
9K
Difference
The combined
9K
SHIP CALCULATIONS
214
Deduct
main deck =
Ins.
1J^
9 3^
& X 3H
2
13
The
That
is
11}^
ins. is to
ter freeboard of 1
1 ft.
ft.
be deducted from 2
11 3^2 ins.
ft.
13^
ins.
may have
less
Table 2
SHIP CALCULATIONS
216
should properly be attempted only from the complete tables referred to earlier, but from the information here presented, it is possible readily to determine the freeboard and therefore
depth for a
curves,
and
for this
depth read
off
efficient of fineness.
Correct this freeboard for sheer and erections and add the
corrected freeboard to the draft to determine a revised molded
2.
for proportions
and the
original
suffice.
are the
same
ASSIGNING FREEBOARDS
217
measured to the deck below the shelter deck (upper deck). There
is no correction for round up of deck beams for awning and shelter
deck vessels. The order of procedure is:
1. Assume a reasonable depth (molded) and read the freeboard
from the curve for this abscissa on Plate 2.
Correct this for sheer and use this corrected freeboard in
mating allowances for erections.
2.
3.
4.
Use
this
Multiply
it
esti-
portions.
5.
Add
is
not
less
than
is
not
less
vessel.
3.
The
deck
is
to be calculated in
efficient
for
deck
is
computed as
SHIP CALCULATIONS
218
prescribed above, plus half the difference between that length and
the length of the vessel.
(b) If efficient means for temporarily closing the openings are
of the
vessel.
openings in the shelter deck are wider than the halfbeam at that point, the addition to the assumed length of erections is to be modified in proportion to the relation which the actual
(c)
If the
Assume
or
=
-jTT-
40
depth
approximately
ft.,
Ft.
At 40
ft.
depth and
The
sheer forward
X 12 = 72
9 4-3
-
from Plate 4
is
is
ft.
ins.
60
ins.,
is
and
11
ft.
aft 3
ft.,
The standard
ins.,
is
-j-
mean
so the
or normal
11 .67
(Plate 2)
12
12
ins.
ins.
is
sheer
mean
72
is
sheer
60
=
25
.25 ft
This
is
is
3) (uncorrected)
3.01
Difference
The
8.41
is
90%
of this
(Curve A, Plate
4),
ft.
excess of length,
x^x
this correction
0708x
'iS=
210
= 35ft
-
iu
1 7
-jr-
in feet
is
Therefore the freeboard corrected for sheer, erections and propor.35 = 9.06 ft., and the molded depth is 9.06
tion becomes 8.71
28
37.06
ft.
This depth does not agree with that first assumed, so a second
solution will be made using the depth just found as a trial depth.
Assume for the second solution a trial depth of 37 ft.
.
Freeboard of
10 50
.
25
.9
2.99
of ship at 28
Depth
2.99
2 69
7 56
.
28.
35.56
draft
ft.
10.25
7.25
427.
490
Difference
63
43
7.99
35.99
Length
of actual ship
Depth
at 28
ft.
draft
28
7.09
re-
Table 3
Allowable reduction from winter freeboard for summer freeboard. Double these reductions allowed for the Indian Summer line
and 2 ins. more required for the Winter North Atlantic line if of 330
ft.
length or
less.
SHIP CALCULATIONS
220
Molded Depth
221
quarter deck."
In Great Britain a committee was appointed by the Board of
Trade in 1883, to formulate rules for the assigning of freeboard to
These rules were revised in 1906, and with slight alteravessels.
tions remain in force today.
sels
the inner edge of a water way of assumed width (see Fig. 32). This
horizontal line is called the statutory deck line and the vertical
distance between it and the deck at the side the statutory allowance
of the
round of beam.
Top of Sfcrft/fory
1
ZfecA /ne ,
i
F*
"5-1 ^erticar/
^
fc
/toe to
*q centre of c//sc
IS
C 7hese /rreasi/re/ne/its
c/pper ea/geofS
Srortzo/7 r<r/ //neper s s4s
/^rat/jh centre of
.
WNA
t/Zsc
/6"' Zona
freeware/
ono"
\t/^esy'.
X/o/rf <mJ\
/'thick
/Var/<//7#
_i
Steamers
/or
6e 2/* forW of i
ce/rfre of a*Ssc
l/err/co/ //'nefp
/rreasvreTnf*
Ae taAet fro/rr
ce/y/re of c/Zsc /o fop
7>rese
t<?
OST&A
f"t/7/C/f-
Freeboard Markings.
SHIP CALCULATIONS
222
The freeboard
made
types.
see Freeboard
Freeboard Markings.
of vessel amidships,
The disks and lines
marks or
i.e.
FW
V.
cutting.
Winter,
WNA
= Summer,
S = Indian Summer, S
Winter North Atlantic.
Fresh Water,
POWERING VESSELS
The
hydroplanes.
The
To Find
Speed.
Let
the Approximate
=
D =
V =
K=
all
craft except
power-driven
H. P.
I.
to Propel
a Vessel at a Certain
speed in knots
coefficient for small launches
100 to 150
speeds
merchant
fair
200
vessels of
moderate
size
220 to
250
= 250 to 300
larger vessels
fast passenger boats = 220 to 280
torpedo boats
cruisers
Then
X \Z&
= 200
'
and
to 250
K
~y=|
l/H X
V = \/
Assume
Then
K =
220
= V* X
= I*
X</_^ =
320
1190
223
=
V =
S =
K=
i.
h. p.
speed in knots
wetted surface in square feet
coefficient for short
Then
beamy
ships
6.
merchant
vessels of ordinary
fine ships
form
5.
4.
KXSXV*
100000
D y
C[
of effective horse
at
any speed,
e. h. p.
nn
ooUUU
is
The
viz.
ratio
t-
l.
-:
'
t
h. p.
For modern
vessels with fine lines a propulsive coefficient of 50% may be expected. In cases with extremely fine forms and fast running engines,
R =
v =
V =
H=
__
H
_,
Then
horse power
RXv
RXV nearly
,
"326-
33000
Example. At a speed of 10 knots per hour (or 1013 ft. per minute) the tow rope
on a tug towing a barge was 10770 lb. Find the horse power necessary to
overcome the resistance of the barge .alone. Work done per minute in footpounds = R Xv = 10770 lb. X 1013 ft.
strain
'
R X
10770 X 1013
33000
33000
17
158
Harbor
ft.
tug, engine
Vessels), can
27
5^
45
(see table of
of 1800 tons
Excursion and
deadweight each
SHIP CALCULATIONS
224
90-ft\ tug,
engine
two square-ended
P =
Then
R, revolutions of engine
S the speed
60
in knots
XPX
60
(1
XPXRX
(1
a decimal.
s)
s)
6080
make
From
X S
P
X
X (1 6080
60
s)
X 10
X (1 -
6080
'
60
16
of Revolutions per
= - QV
A
.1)
Minute
at
Which
to
Run
S =
Ri =
Si =
given speed
required revolutions
required speed
~-^
Then ft =
Example. If a vessel travels at the rate of 16 knots an hour when the engine
making 64 revolutions per minute, what should be the number of revolutions
per minute to reduce the speed to 14 knots? The revolutions required are given by
is
the formula Ri
16
Formula
=
L =
Speed
of
a Motor Boat.
56 revolu-
225
C =
M = cVTxp
g
Thrust horse power, see Horse Powers.
Calculation of thrust, see Propellers.
Resistance.
is
of
it
has been found impossible to formulate a practical law. Experiments made by Mr. Froude in England showed that the frictional
resistance at a 6-knot speed is about 34 of a pound per square foot
wetted surface for ordinary painted ship's bottoms, and that the
total resistance varies about as the square of the speed.
Using
Froude 's value for frictional resistance as 34 lb. per square foot at
6 knots, then frictional resistance of a vessel = square feet of wet-
of
(SD6G(i\
f\
resistance
,
and horse power =
,
The
the
e.
33000
the indicated horse power. Within the lower limits of power and
speed only the frictional resistance need be considered. The fol-
full power.
lowing applies in general from 34 to
1. The indicated horse power varies as the square of the speed.
2. Consumption of fuel varies as the square of the speed.
Example.
hour,
If
x
x
=
=
202
to the consumption at
is to square of speed
212
21 2
=2.2
or 21 knots
2.2 tons
=46.2
226
SHIP CALCULATIONS
At
half -speed the frictional resistance will be only }/i of the frictional resistance at full speed. Since the power required to propel
Displacement in Tons
LAUNCHING
227
However,
for friction
this
when they
is
by B.
S.
Baker.)
Length
of
Vessel in
Feet
SHIP CALCULATIONS
228
usually to the level of the water at low tide, but in cases where the
may be necessary to carry them further out.
The ways
To determine
Let
for vessels to
the breadth,
=
=
Then
is
of the
.8
the
= 7W
breadth of each
The
2 b
about
The area
foot
is
way =
declivity of the
foot in large vessels to
Thus
-7-
let 2.5
= W
hence
the
rp.
vature
support aft and the ship has a tendency to turn about the after
end of the ways and so concentrate the weight at that point; and
second, when the buoyancy aft is sufficient to lift the ship and cause
her to turn about the fore end of the cradle, there is then a long
length* of structure unsupported and a great pressure is exerted over
a short length at the fore end of the cradle and the launching ways.
Launching Calculations.* Assuming that the vessel has no tipping moment but gradually lifts aft as she launches, when she is
almost entirely in the water say when the fore poppet is over the
end of the standing ways the force of buoyancy pressing upward
will react at the fore poppet, causing a downward pressure on the
ways, tending to spread out the standing ways, to break the fore
little
00
CO
to
229
SHIP CALCULATIONS
230
Make
vide
it
section
a tracing of the ship to a small scale (see Fig. 33), and diCalculate the area of each
into displacement ordinates.
up
of areas at
each section.
Moment
volume
of
of displacement
center of
ways =
buoyancy from fore end
end
fore
of
of
ways
mences to
The
rise.
difference
of the
Draw
each
shift.
by
The
calculated
moment.
The
lifting
shifts.
of gravity
is
MOMENT OF BUOYANCY
moment
be no
plied by
of ways,
6000
231
of weight about the after end, because 6000 multithe distance of the center of gravity from the after end
shift the
moment
will
be
*V
Sfo/rreof'of re/ptf a/>o</f fore /bf/zet
,cary&
of df/'s/>/&rer77e/7f'
*Jfore />&/>/>&?
SOsS7&0/77eS7f cf
&uoycr/7cy <r6oi//
starvo'/np ays
trays
<rffer e/?a/
trays.
of
*f-<ir7a///70
Figure 34
The moment
of
buoyancy
is
calculated
poppets.
tipping
moment
weight of #ship
The
SHIP CALCULATIONS
232
been extended and fastened at the shore ends. Care must be taken
that both planks are sawn at the same rate.
Should the vessel refuse to start when released, a hydraulic ram
or jack- may be brought to bear at the end of each launching way,
and
Launching
velocities
is
"
steeper incline, and instead of only two there are several. One of
the advantages of side launching is that the vessel may be built
on an even
keel.
Launching Data
U.
S.
BATTLESHIP "ARIZONA"
233
about 42 seconds.
Freight steamer "Chokyu Maru," 277 ft. 7 ins. O. A., 268 ft. between
perpendiculars, beam molded 40 ft. 9 ins., depth molded 23 ft. 6 ins.;
draft loaded 19 ft. 934 ins., designed displacement 4887 tons, deadweight 3067 tons, engine
^p
i.
h.
speed 11
p. 1060,
knots.
1/17
1/16
217 ft.
Ways
1 ft.
Width
of standing ways
Center to center of sliding
14
ways
on
Average pressure
standing ways
Maximum pressure on fore poppet when the stern
Declivity of
of
200
280
300
430
460
500
ft.
ft.
ins.
315 tons
Vessel
in Feet
ins.
1.35 tons
lifted
Length
Launching
Weight
in Tons
200
1,000
2,200
4,000
5,000
7,000
ft.
ins.
per min.
1033 tons
16.2
ft.
971 tons
ft.
aft
amidships
Declivity
SECTION V
HULL CONSTRUCTION
CLASSIFICATION SOCIETIES AND ORGANIZATIONS
GOVERNING SHIPPING
Merchant
rules pre-
by any of the following societies: Lloyd's Register, AmerBureau of Shipping, British Corporation, Bureau Veritas
scribed
ican
and Norske
By
Veritas.
if
all
In the case of a
new
fication, the plans are first submitted to be approved by the Committee and the building proceeds under the supervision of a local
No steel is used which has not been produced at approved
surveyor.
works and tested at the works by the surveyors. When completed a character is assigned to the vessel by the Committee upon
the surveyor's report.
Vessels built according to Lloyd's Register and classed with
the Society are required at intervals of four years to be given special
These surveys are designated as Nos. 1, 2, and 3, and
surveys.
as long as the vessel maintains her structural strength she keeps
her
class.
its
the rules of the Society. The star or cross before the figure denotes
that the vessel was built under special survey. If the engines and
boilers were built and installed according to the rules, then it is
234
SHIPPING
thus in the book
registered
100
>f
M C.
*%
M C.
235
The
highest rating
is
Lloyd's, the headquarters of the British Underwriters (an organization entirely separate from Lloyd's Register of Shipping), was
incorporated by act of Parliament in 1871, for the carrying on of
of Lloyd's.
is
the protection of
the interests of
freight.
"the
collection and diffusion of intelligence and information bearing on
shipping matters." It has agents all over the world, but these
agents are not insurance agents; in fact they are strictly forbidden
Their duties may be broadly defined as follows:
to act as such.
In case of shipwreck to render to masters of vessels, of which
there are over 40,000 certificates in the British mercantile marine,
require.
is
required to dispatch every item of information likely to be of interest to the members of Lloyd's by the most expeditious route,
telegraphic or otherwise, during the day or night, Sunday and
weekday.
is
for
20 years.
HULL CONSTRUCTION
236
society as
M.
C.
British Corporation.
The British Corporation for the Survey
and Registry of Shipping was founded in 1890 for the purpose of
of vessels classed
of the
chinery
The
Bureau
Veritas.
S.
tests in
connection with the hulls, engines, and boilers and their accessories;
that is to say, on points which are covered by the surveys prescribed in the present classification rules.
The Bureau
Veritas British
vessels,
also
on vessels
BOARD OF TRADE
237
ports and which are not provided with freeboard certificates and
its marks are recognized as equivalent to British requirements.
Vessels are divided into three divisions, viz., I, II, and III.
In
order to retain their class, vessels must be subjected to the inspection of a surveyor to the Bureau Veritas at the following periods:
Vessels of the I division every 4 years.
II division every 3 years.
Ill division every 3 years.
The large I denotes first division classification (out of three).
indicate that the ship is divided into a
Two rings around the
number
/3
I. I.
of watertight
M
+
figure, I,
+M&
K. V.
Registro Nazionale Italiano was formed in 1910 to take over the
Registro Italiano which was founded in 1861. The society has
adopted the rules of the British Corporation, and has an arrangement with the British Corporation by which it can use the services
of that society in British
and
foreign ports.
classification
HULL CONSTRUCTION
238
Act
of 1894.
of
and inspection of boilers, lifeboats to be carried, wireless equipment, and other matters relating to the equipment and running of
motor boats, sail and steam vessels.
tion
Bureau
ferent members, the dimensions used are length (see page 166),
molded breadth and depth, the latter varying with the type of
ence in the frames, beams, etc., for a vessel built according to any
society is slight, but there is variance in the height of the bulkheads.
Broadly speaking, merchant vessels have their machinery amidships, the chief exceptions being tankers, colliers, and lumber carriers.
They have double bottoms which are often utilized for
carrying oil fuel and water ballast. For ships which have to make
long voyages in ballast, top side tanks together with the usual
double bottom give a good distribution of the ballast weights.
Merchant' vessels, according to Lloyd's, can be divided into the
following classes: shelter, awning and bridge deck, one, two, three,
The only reduction allowed
etc., deck vessels and sailing vessels.
in the
MERCHANT VESSELS
239
D
S/ng/e 2)&c/<
hr/f/b / 00/3
r/ &<?>& /"orrccrsf/e
5/?e/ferZ)6>c/c
/fa/see/ &/<7rfer2)ec/(
We//2)ecA
(s/rrgfe we//)
1
01
tfi/rr/ra/7e 2>ecA /br
J/ner/eas?
Figure 35.
'
240
HULL CONSTRUCTION
Shelter deck vessels (see Fig. 35) are usually three deck vessels
with a complete erection all fore and aft inclosed from the sea with
the exception of a few openings for ease in loading and discharging
They have on
means
is a superstructure extending all fore and aft. The peculiar feature is, that
the 'tween-deck space it incloses is not included in the vessel's reg-
is
of closing
it,
and that no
partitioned off or closed in a permanent manner. The necessary opening, referred to as the tonnage
opening, may be formed by one of the hatchways, usually the
after
one which
may
may
or
is
it
must not
members
When
there are
and
plating
is
tie
diagonal
at the ends.
plates in
way
is
The shell
number exceeds
of the masts.
increased .10
fitted in
in.
in.
way
strakes at the
Other
shape of
masts and special panting stringers
special stiffening in the
of the
TURRET VESSEL
Figure 36.
Midship Section
241
of a Turret Vessel.
other for engaging in the coastwise trade, as from New York to New
Orleans, the latter having lighter scantlings than the former. In
all hurricane deckers, the depth is taken from the top of the keel
at middle line, and
the collision bulkhead extends only to the second deck.
The important difference between the two classes is in the fram-
beam amidships
frames
extend to the hurricane deck, while those for the coastwise extend
alternately to the second and hurricane decks except for one-sixth
of the length from the bow where every frame extends to the hurriing.
all their
HULL CONSTRUCTION
242
cane deck, but in no case need this exceed 60 ft. As to the reverse
frames for the transatlantic they extend to the under side of the
hurricane deck stringer, and for the coastwise for a certain length
alternately to the hurricane deck.
Raised Quarter Deck. Here (see Fig. 35) the main deck is raised
3 ft. for vessels up to 100 ft. in length, 4 ft. up to 250 ft. and 6 ft.
to 400
up
is
ft.
amidships, for
it
Figure 37.
Midship Section
of a
Trunk
Vessel.
WAR
VESSELS
243
often limited
forward.
They have a continuous center turret which forms with the harbor
deck an integral part of the hull. They are built without sheer,
and may have on the top of the turret deck erections as poop,
bridge, and forecastle, or such erections may be on the harbor deck,
but in this case the turret must be continuous from the poop to
the forecastk into which it is scarped. Cutting away the outboard
parts of the upper 'tween-decks served the double purposes of reducing the tonnage measurement and port charges, and providing
a center trunk that served as an expansion chamber and made the
vessels self -trimming when loaded with grain or similar cargoes.
are inferior in stability to the usual type
excessive angle.
They
when
heeled to an
WAR
The war
VESSELS
of certain types of
every type, yet there stand out preeminently submarines for preying on merchant vessels, torpedo boat destroyers for patrol purposes and to war on submarines, and battleships for shelling land
fortifications while troops are landing.
Modern
of 3 or
more
HULL CONSTRUCTION
244
Referring to the former there has been a notable use of steam turbines either driving the propellers direct or by gears; or the turbines
may
maximum
As
The
Diesel engines
have been
installed
stow and contains more heat units per pound, thus giving
a larger steaming radius.
In the United States Navy all large vessels are framed on the
longitudinal system (this does not mean on the Isherwood system),
the keel being continuous as also the fore and aft members on either
side called longitudinals, while the frames are intercostal.
This
is
keel
carried out from the
to the protective
system of framing
deck including the inner bottom which extends as far forward and
aft as possible. Above the protective deck the transverse members
are continuous. Forward and aft of the inner bottom the frames
are continuous on both sides of the vertical keel and the longitudinals
are intercostal between them.
In torpedo boats and small vessels having no inner bottoms the
frames are continuous from keel to 'gunwale, and closely spaced
Here the longitudinals are intercostal.
to support the shell plating.
No standard rules, as Lloyd's or British Corporation, are followed,
the U. S. Navy Department, Admiralty, and the various Governeasier to
Armor.
fore
and
This
may be
their
divided into:
own
(1)
broadside extending
(2)
The
hull plating that in turn is reinforced with heavy frames.
of
the
armor is bolted to the hull by bolts screwed into the back
armor.
much
The
outer face
softer
is
The manu-
245
made by
Plates
have a hard
and a tough
Armament.
Under
this
of battleship.
Guns
5 ins.
battleships
and over
14-inch
guns are mounted, firing a projectile weighing about 1,200 lb. and
requiring 500 lb. of powder. The powder and projectiles are
HULL CONSTRUCTION
246
ated by compressed
air.
The ^uns in the turret are raised and lowby electric motors, the turret with its
on rollers. Guns using fixed ammunition
and the other where they are below the water line, the former for
torpedo boats and the latter for submarines, cruisers, and large
war vessels. The torpedoes are discharged from the deck tubes by
Figure 38.
Midship Section
of
a Battleship.
BATTLESHIPS
247
a small charge of powder, but after they have cleared the tube and
the side of the vessel they travel by their own motive power operated
The
driving mechanism for keeping the torpedo in a straight line and at a given distance from the surface is
very complicated. At the front is the warhead, which contains the
by compressed
air.
now mounted
of 2 or
in pairs, the
the pressure being about 1,200 to 1,800 lb. per square inch.
range and when to fire are given from the central station.
The
Warships
may
Designed
Battleships.
Item
Hull
Armor
Armament
Propelling Machinery
Coal
General Equipment
.
Weight as Percentage
Total Displacement
35.0
26.0
19.0
10.5
5.5
4.0
100.0
by R. H. M. Robinson.
of
HULL CONSTRUCTION
248
battleships
all
625
ft.,
water
line
600
ft.,
beam 97
down
ft.,
in 1914.
draft 2S
ft.
Length over
10 ins., normal
belt amidships.
bunkers 4,000 tons of coal. Ten 15-inch guns, 16 6-inch, 12 12pounders, 5 torpedo tubes, armor belt 133^2 ins., protective deck,
3
ins.
Battle
Cruisers or
Armored
Cruisers.
Expected
in line
to do
some
with battle-
full
p.,
speed 27 knots, coal normal 1,000 tons, maximum 3,500 plus 1,000
tons of oil. Has 8 13.5-inch guns, 16 4-inch, 2 submerged torpedo
tubes on broadside and
ends.
For
Monitors.
Had
is
a 6-inch.
Below are descriptions of two light cruisarmor and the other without. Nottingham,
ft.
between perpendiculars, 49
ft.
249
10
ins.
beam,
Yarrow boilers, Curtis turbines 24,000 h. p., speed 26 knots, normal coal 750 tons, 8 6-in. guns, 4 3-pounders, 2 21-in. submerged
torpedo tubes,
Scouts. These
in.
p.,
turbines.
Make good
patrol boats
HULL CONSTRUCTION
250
destroyer
She
9
ft.
is
310
43^
17,500
is
s.
ft.
ins.,
block coefficient
h. p.,
down
.44,
7%
and four 21-in. twin torpedo tubes. Direct drive turbines are installed on many destroyers.
Submarines. The war in Europe (19 14-) has shown the damage
these craft can do. At first they were only experimental affairs, but
now they
running on the surface and 8 or more when submerged. When running on the surface they are driven by Diesel engines, and when
submerged, by storage batteries furnishing current to electric moBesides being armed with submerged torpedo tubes, the
tors.
latest types have guns, some one or two three-inch.
The hull may be either single or double. In the former the main
ballast tanks are located within a strong outer hull, which in section is in the main part circular or nearly so, with elliptical sections
forward and aft. In the double hull there is a more or less complete,
strong, pressure-resisting internal hull, which is surrounded by an
external hull of lighter construction, the greater part of the water
The single hull
ballast being in the space between the two hulls.
is represented by the Holland and Lake types as in the United
States, British, and German navies, and the double hull by the
Laubeuf Horizontal rudders are usually fitted at the bow and stern,
and are sometimes combined with one or more sets of inclining
planes. In submerging the bow is always slightly depressed. The
reserve buoyancy varies from 25 to 40%.
Of the types in the United States Navy are the Holland (built
by the Electric Boat Co.) and the Lake (built by the Lake Sub.
marine Boat Co.). In the former the hull proper is circular in cross
section, on the top of which is built a superstructure, the water
being allowed to enter and leave it of its own accord, and having
nothing to do with the trimming. The superstructure is a con-
SUBMARINES
Submarines
u.
Particulars
Length
Surface displacement, tons
Submerged displacement, tons.
Engines
Horse power, surface
Speed, surface, knots
Speed, submerged, knot.s
Armament, torpedo tubes
Armament, guns
s.
251
HULL CONSTRUCTION
252
also
on both
forming a
There are 4
flat
deck.
fins,
same number
of the propeller.
When
running below the surface, by means of a periscope extending above the water the positions of other vessels are reflected
so they can be seen by the navigator of the submarine. One of the
latest models consists of a tube with lenses and at the bottom a
binocular eye-piece into which the navigator looks. The periscope
is only for daylight navigation, for when dusk comes it is useless.
The passing of the image through the various lenses and prisms reduces the brilliancy to such an extent that even if it is magnified
to above normal the image is so thin it cannot be seen. This forces
the submarine to become vulnerable in making an attack at night,
necessary for the conning tower to be brought a sufficient
distance above the surface of the water for the commanding officer
as
it is
h. p.,
STRUCTURAL DETAILS
253
guaranteed spee'd 26.1 miles per hour, actually made 28, fuel carried
in four 270-gallon tanks, total 1080 gallons, cruising radius at 26
miles an hour 500 to 600 miles, accommodations for 6 men and 2
officers; has 2 rudders, steel deck house forward for pilot, 2 small
The United States authorized the building of several in 1917,
guns.
110
ft.
long.
Auxiliaries.
These
include
colliers,
and tenders for submarines. They do not carry heavy guns, but
may have a few small ones to repel torpedo boat and submarine
attacks.
Many are converted merchant vessels, while others are
specially designed for the service in which they are to be used.
STRUCTURAL DETAILS
Systems
of Construction.
There
are
two systems
for
merchant
and
and
sary.
made
These strong frames are slotted around their outer edges to admit
of continuous longitudinal stiffeners or frames being fitted not only
at the deck but on the sides, bottom, and under the tank top.
The longitudinal stiffeners, being riveted to the deck plating,
prevent the plating from buckling, which has happened to transverse
framed vessels having no fore and aft support to the plating between the beams. In vessels with double bottoms, transverse floor
Bulb
plates are fitted intermediate to those at the sides and decks.
can
be
used as longitudinals under the tank top and on the
angles
f23ecK p/grf/'n,? fa
Sfie/ferDecA^
Q
"
t?~
ftyp erJ)ecA
JD<?cA/>/crr//70:f
Gi=-
dt"
Sfcrnc/i/oosSi
a/Scr.
J /%r/>7 2)ecA
^=B
/
*'
"
/^
Vx 3.3^x33^x^3
or> er/fer/rcrte
pecA: />/c7f//7af
IP
**>-<. r,
77 e>s
S. S. /4/asA<7f7
H-Jj
Sc<?r7f///?^s ^/fse/7
Sra/7c/7/o/7s fff
773-/7
$k
&>!
A fO/o $<?m/rt
fjL
a/shf/a -rea/i/cea/
f/'cr.
//'
errp//7e roosr>
o//er
.,
oo o o
'
&
Figure 39.
Transverse System.
254
a? e/7<?$
6*
FRAMING
255
In the Isherwood system the inner bottom may extend to the skin
of the ship whereas in a transverse framed ship it usually stops just
before the lower turn of the bilge, leaving a space that is of no value for
carrying cargo. Among the advantages claimed by the Isherwood
system are increased longitudinal strength, increased deadweight
The
and number
of the
cargo and
and spacing according to the rules, viz., Lloyd's, American Bureau of Shipping, or other society, to which she is built.
In Lloyd's rules the frames depend on the transverse number,
B -f- D, which is the sum of the molded breadth B and the molded
depth D, which is the depth at mid-length from top of keel to top
of uppermost continuous deck, except in awning and shelter deck
vessels, where it is taken to the deck next below the shelter deck
provided the deck height does not exceed 8 ft., in which case it is
vary in
size
taken to a point 8 ft. below the shelter deck. A second depth d has
also to be considered in getting the size of the frames, this depth
being measured from the top of the floors at the center in a single
bottom ship, and from the margin plate at the side in a double
bottom ship, to the top of the beams of the lowest laid deck or tier
of
l
from 2 34 X 2 /i
angles to 12 X 4 X 4
channels, and in spacing from 20 to 33 ins. from heel to heel, while
in peak tanks 24 ins., and one-fifth of the length forward to the
collision bulkhead the spacing is not to exceed 27 ins.
The framing of a single bottom ship consists of a frame, reverse
frame, and floor plate. The frame in this case usually extends in
one length from the center line to the top deck. In deep framing
size
HULL CONSTRUCTION
256
it is
common
floor plate
this construction is
not
much
in favor
on account
of the interference
The toes of all frames forward of the midship section point aft,
while those aft of the midship section have the heels aft and the
This gives open bevels and thus room for driving
toes forward.
the rivets connecting the frames to the shell plating. The frames
some instances
are in
even
if
ships when they are not more than 10 ins. deep and thus save
the weight of the frame liners. This makes a better job than
is
(see above).
The depth of the floor plates at the center line is governed by the
same transverse number used for the frames. The floor plates are
to be molded not less than one-half their depth at a point threefourths the half-breadth of the vessel from the center line and to
extend up the bilge in a fair curve terminating at a point on the
than twice their midship depth at center line, this
height to be maintained for one-fourth the vessel's length amidships; they may then be gradually lowered forward and aft until
the upper edges are level; depending on the shape of the Vessel
from this point to the ends they may be gradually increased in
depth to give better connection. In the engine room the floors
must be increased .04 in. over the midship thickness and in the
frame not
boiler
less
room
.10 in.
The above
FRAMING
257
Double bottoms are usually built on the cellular system with solid
floors either at every frame or on alternate frames, or other construction followed subject to the approval of the society to whose
See also Double Bottom.
rules the vessel is being built.
Z7 M
Sec
/-/or? 7a/7/cer
Sc/cAr
7/'rfsh//o
4/0 '/>?/* j*\ 5'- 3''6 earn , 3/'-S' c/e/sf/? fo
<
3"Hre6x.40"
tz::
p/afe
&re //?>
Sco-r//-//r?gs g/i/e/y
S0//3 , rfcr'i/ceo' erf erze/s.
/7ec7i//csf cr/77/a/-
x/ot/J>/e<? "x3i
L=m
62-
Figure 40.
z.
o o
It
ifcz
\\
w*~
n eg*
JULTT
-6
Frames usually extend in one piece from the center line to the
margin plate and if floors are on alternate frames heavier scantlings
HULL CONSTRUCTION
258
are required for the intermediate frames. When the vessel's length
exceeds 400 ft. solid floors are required at every frame and also
and additional
girders
are to be fitted under the engine seating.
reduction in the thickness of the shell plating is allowed when
solid floors are on every frame, provided the thickness does not
plate,
exceed .66
in.
Shell Plating.
The
shell plating
may
be worked
as, in
and out
In and
strakes, joggled, clinker, or flush as shown in Fig. 41.
out strakes are largely adopted, the keel, bilge, and sheer strakes
being
When
made
joggled no liners
are necessary, while in the clinker only tapered liners are needed.
Flush plating calls for extensive linering and is chiefly for yachts
for appearance' sake, as the liners materially add to the weight of
If
the plating
is
the hull.
Depth
of Vessel in
Not exceeding 20
Above 20, not exceeding 24
Above 24, not exceeding 28
Above 28
The widths
Feet
Maximum
Breadth
of
54
60
66
72
SHELL PLATING
259
and tapered slightly at the ends above the water line, thus requiring as the stem and stern are approached the working in of stealers
in the lower strakes, one stealer taking the place of two or more
Figure
41.Shell
Plating.
HULL CONSTRUCTION
260
cedure is followed in laying out the plating for a single screw vessel.
In a twin, triple or quadruple screw the forebody is worked the
same as for a single, but in the after body care must be taken in
laying out the plating around the shaft tubes so the plates may be
easily worked, short plates being selected for furnacing.
Coincident with the laying out of the shell plating on the
body
of
the
and
the
of
a
shell
a
model
plan
making
drawing
expansion,
is made.
In large vessels the plates may be 24 to 28 ft. in length,
but care must be taken in selecting a length that can be easily
handled.
loft
it
is
this
The
Bottom and
The
amidships.
and
thickness of
is
should face
aft, so that
no projecting parts
When
when the
will catch;
is
no
resist-
ance offered by them when the ship is moving through the water.
In laying out the shell plating a good shift of butts should be
secured and they must not come in the same frame space as those
of the keel, tank top plating, longitudinals or deck stringers.
Lloyd's rules state: no butts of outside plating in adjoining strakes
to be nearer each other than two frame spaces, and the butts of
alternate strakes must not be under each other, but shifted not
than one frame space. The sheer strake must extend sufficiently above the" upper deck ends to take at least two rows of
rivets vertically in the butts above the upper flange of the gunwale
less
bar.
All shell plates are flush riveted with perhaps the single exception
of the sheer strake in large vessels where there are doubling plates,
BULWARKS
261
may
and frames.
In the garboard strake or the strake next to the keel brass plugs
are sometimes fitted, by unscrewing which when in dry dock the
inner bottom compartments may be drained.
Bulwarks.
These
are
sometimes
fitted
water
off
water to run
off
ment to the frame angle must in no case be less than its breadth
and attachment at the margin plate. At the lower edge of the
margin plate is a continuous angle riveted to the shell, while the
upper part of the plate is flanged over, generally inboard, and riveted
A gusset plate is riveted
to the inner bottom plating (tank top).
over the flange of the margin plate and also to the reverse angle
If the ship
of the vertical frame, depending on the size of the ship.
is large enough to have gussets at every frame it is usual to carry
10
HULL CONSTRUCTION
262
the double bottom plating over on the margin brackets and an angle
is fitted at both the top and bottom of the margin plate.
The
tudinals.
floor
/Voor s/r//7^er I p
Figure 42.
/tee/sos? cr/y^/es
Bar Keel.
the side girders are spaced more than 6 ft. apart the
watertight floors in double bottoms are to be stiffened by vertical
Where
TANK
TOP, ETC.
263
angles of the size of the frame angle on the floor, spaced midway
between the girders. Every floor in the engine space should have
double reverse angles, as also on each floor in way of boiler bearers.
are to extend in all cases from the middle line to beyond
the girder next outside the engine seating.
They
and so
on.
The center
may
aft continuously
more
of
watertight.
Wherever possible they should be arranged so that in the engine
room they form part of the engine foundation. They should not
size
beyond
the;
HULL CONSTRUCTION
264
Instead of running the keelsons continuously through the bulkheads they may be stopped and bracketed to them.
Keels. Figs. 42 and 43 show different types. Flat plate keels for
large vessels, while for tugs, lighters and other small craft, bar keels.
flat plate keels intercostal keelson
plates or vertical center
With
plates
must be
fitted close
down on
<// cr/?g/es
.^a^esjo^/ec/
'
65 Sfearner
Figure
43.Plate
Keel.
by double angles riveted all fore and aft to the keel plate and
Bar keels should be worked in long lengths, connected
together by right and left hand scarphs that are generally nine
it
keelson.
DECK PLATING
265
strake in and the other out, or the plating may be flush or joggled.
When the plating is not to be covered the strakes may be arranged
and out so that water on the deck will flow towards the waterways, and thence through the scuppers and overboard. Flush decks
made by joggling down the beams and fitting joggled plating are
much cheaper than flush decks with planed and fitted edge laps,
equally efficient for trucking, and better from the riveting and
in
shell;
that
is
the
etc.).
The deck
is
the stapling is caulked. Or, as more usually the case, the frames
are cut and bracketed to the watertight deck or flat.
Deck planking
Deck beams
(see
by knees
or brackets
Beams
(a)
(b)
(c)
HULL CONSTRUCTION
266
(d)
(required
of engine
ins.
(Lloyd's requirements).
intended to suspend chilled beef or similar products
from the beams, the beams and the girders under them must be
When
it is
up
to 31
ft.
in depth.
bulb angles not less than 7 ins. in depth or their equivalent. The
athwartship plates may be worked with an incline or pitch, the
highest part being at the center, and they are not given the camber
of the deck beam as the hatch covers will fit better without it.
See Hatch Covers.
HATCH OPENINGS
267
^
Scy#e/7//?? c/ecrfs
/wore
crpcvrf
arnot iv&<&&es
5 trips
I
f/?cr/7
r7ot
'
Sea/77 every
y
frcrrne -$//7f/ec///*
Figure 44.
Height of Coamings.
exposed 24 ins.
On upper,
On
On
On
bar.
On
spaced about 9 ins. from the corners and 2 ft. apart, and at such
a distance from the top that the tarpaulin cover can be easily
HULL CONSTRUCTION
268
fitted
when
position.
On
large hatches
are fitted
heavy portable
(maximum
spacing 4
ft.
fore
ins.)
and
afters
and beams
efficiently.
44 ft. beam, double row from 44 ft. to 50 ft. and three rows above
50 ft., which may support fore and aft girders fastened to the
under side of the deck and to the deck beams. With this arrangement holds are obtained that are free from a number of small
An example of a girder and pillar is shown in Fig. 45.
pillars.
These are continuous angles on the inside of the
Stringers.
frames, and when the frames exceed a certain depth, Lloyd's requires intercostal plates to be fitted, attached to the shell plating
by angles
The
stringer
and shell
the plating have a
common
The
stem to a
The
of watertight bulkheads
Britain
are fixed by the rules (in Great
by the Board of Trade)
under which the vessel will be built. Watertight transverse bulk-
Bulkheads.
fares
BULKHEADS
269
P/afe afheoc/
o/ p/7/crr
1'
L ajD/zea p/afe
or/>//><? c/e/ye^aV/yp
ort
s/2e
K
Spec/a/ sf/tfe/y/'T?
//?o'o</A/e >otfo/T7
i/oc/er
p///arfor
2 frcr/ne sp&ces
-,
4 oca/ cfdvA/er
//7
way o/'p/Z/ar
LZ
"res
!==_
Figure
45. Hold
Pillar.
from spreading, and also prevent water from flowing into other
compartments should one compartment be flooded. Longitudinal
bulkheads are valuable structurally as they form a vertical web,
HULL CONSTRUCTION
270
thus adding greatly to the fore and aft strength of a vessel. Battleships, tankers and large passenger vessels have such bulkheads.
"
Screw steamers are to have a watertight bulkLloyd's states:
head at each end of the engine and boiler space. A watertight
collision
bulkhead
is
in addition to
be
fitted at
after
is
to extend
from the
floor
load
fine.
"In
Vessels
Above
bulkhead
may
extend to the
first
271
line
must have a
forward watertight collision bulkhead extending to the upper and
As to the after collision
to second deck in hurricane deck vessels.
to extend to the upper deck, second deck in hurrithree deck vessels and have a watertight steel flat extend-
bulkhead this
cane and
vessels
is
it
com-
partment
The Bulkhead Committee of the British Board of Trade issued
a report in 1915 requiring that all vessels carrying 12 passengers
or over must be subdivided according to definite standards. The
most important factor regulating the subdivision is the freeboard
ratio or the ratio of freeboard to draft.
The
longitudinal bulkheads is
In transverse,
invariably worked intercostal between the decks.
the plating may be either in vertical or horizontal strakes, or a
plating
of
transverse as
also
shell,
the others
desired.
double angles as called for by the rules, and the upper plates to
the deck by single or double angles. As the holes caused by the
riveting of
shell
weaken the
shell, this is
strength-
HULL CONSTRUCTION
272
the rules, which also give the thickness of the plating and the
Vertical stiffeners are the only ones (except in tankers
riveting.
which also have horizontal stiffeners) 'required by Lloyd's in accord-
ance with the tables issued in May, 1915. In torpedo boats and
in other high speed vessels, instead of vertical stiffeners the plates
are sometimes flanged, thus saving weight.
To secure waterti^htness bulkheads must be caulked, and this
usually done on the after side of bulkheads forward of amidships, and on the forward side of those aft. The stiffeners are
is
ing.
ISee
Stopwaters.
locally.
as in a
These
are fitted
soaked in
One
is
hempfelt sheeting
tar.
Stem and
is
fastened to
(see Keels).
it
In
by a scarph
flat
of the
number
over 16,000 the forward or propeller post should extend sufficiently above the arch of the stern
post to be efficiently connected to the plating on the beams and
In single and triple screw vessels the
to a deep transom plate.
body post is swelled out to take the stern tube. The spur or heel
for connecting to the keel (bar or flat) is usually 2 3^ frame spaces
longitudinal
long.
The
(Lloyd's)
center keelson
is
is
STERN TUBE
To
273
the post
as near as
ft.
is
G ins. to 5
ft.
One
apart.
of the
to*
form
a hard-over stop for the rudder. At the bottom of the stern post
there may be a spur extending aft that takes the lower rudder
*post has a composition bushing with lignum vitae strips, with the
The shaft in the way of
grain set perpendicular to the shaft.
At the
collision
bulkhead
is
a stuffing
maximum
stiffness.
as to conform to the run of the water, so the arms will not cross the
stream lines and interfere with the speed of the vessel.
coefficient
.0G33
"
rru
I
Then area in squara inches
The proportions of
Length = \/ 5.3
Distance
Vk
the pear-shaped
X area
maximum
x PX
arm
are:
length
Maximum
.33
HULL CONSTRUCTION
274
For the
powers and
lesser
wood
or"
and
the
is
ican
Bureau
=
A =
r =
V =
Thend =
Let
diameter of stock in
area of rudder in sq.
ft.
ft.
speed in knots
.26
\/
A V
ins.
which
or the parts
separate from the rudder frame and of a cone shape (see Fig. 46)
and one, called the locking pintle, must have a nut to prevent the
by
is
obtained.
To
nil in
the spaces
7bwaaf
K
f^crsse/ytperg
Cargo Sfearner
S/'&e
Srass ps/?/%
0/7^>//7f/e
Ora'/'/yafp
/=>//7f/e
/?oo/a'er
sBa/f/e Sh/f>
Figure 46.
Rudders.
275
Whee/ Sfearner
HULL CONSTRUCTION
276
between the pintles, plates are riveted to the outside of the frame.
Rudders for sidcwheelers often have a bumpkin at the after part
to which the steering gear is attached.
In this case the rudder is
turned by pulling on the bumpkin, the rudder post serving only as
a pivot.
As to shapes there is a variety as shown in Fig. 45. For tugs,
lighters and side-wheel steamers the maximum width is near the
load water line and the area is large. For ocean-going vessels the
area is smaller in proportion to their length and the maximum
width is about 34 from the load water line. The balanced rudder
is extensively used, particularly on warships.
In this type a portion of the area is forward of the rudder stock.
The rudders of
and
are
broader
shallower
than
of
those
merchant
vessels
warships
so as to keep them and the steering gear well below the water line.
Below are ratios of the areas of rudders to the areas of lateral or
longitudinal planes of different types of vessels.
of Vessel
MACHINERY FOUNDATIONS
277
The
opposite the back connection door, provided that on vessels constructed of iron or steel with metal bulkheads the distance back
of the doors and such metal bulkheads shall not be less than 16 ins."
may
boiler to others
Water tube
boilers should
readily accessible.
In laying
off
all
and
angles.
Deck
Erections.
of a forecastle forward,
bridge
amidships, and poop aft, thus giving what is commonly called
"three islands." The ship's frames may extend through the deck
and serve as the vertical stifTeners for the side plating, and to them
HULL CONSTRUCTION
278
may
and engineers are partly divided with quarters amidships and aft.
Deck houses that are away from the sides of the vessel have
vertical stiffeners with bracket plates riveted to the deck, while
at the top are other brackets which are riveted to the deck house
beams.
light
The
tie plates
over which a
entire
PAINTING
279
sand
is
sufficiently thick to
form a
and
aft flush
with the lower side of the limber holes. From middle line to
bilges the cement must cover all the rivet heads on flange or frames
The outer
two coats
may
HULL CONSTRUCTION
280
paint that also protects the steel plates from galvanic action.
On
name
Tockolith,
is
made by Toch
Bros.,
New
York. After the hull has been scraped and well cleaned,
Tockolith is applied; it strongly resists the corrosive effects of salt
water and abrasion by floating objects which the hull may come in
When
this is
Attention should be called to Bitumastic enamel (American Bitumastic Enamels Co., New York) that is particularly adapted for
interior surfaces as in pontoons of floating docks and of double
ENGINE ROOM
281
l
in. on shell in double bottom,
on vertical surfaces, and /i
and the engine and boiler seatings covered to the height of the platforms with a thickness of Y% to 34 in.
The bottoms of wood vessels are often painted with copper paint.
tanks
}/$ in.
One maker
is
a rehable substitute
for copper sheathing, and for a long time protects the wood against
the ravages of the boring worm, and the surface against the ad-
presents a smooth
When
When
using
tween
tides,
When
although
it is
bottom
is
is
thoroughly
but on bot-
generally sufficient,
pretty well worn off, use two coats.
When using green copper paint, never apply over old coats of
brown or red copper paint. Thoroughly scrape or burn off before
dry.
is
painting, in
of the boiler
room
and the
dirt,
the light.
are
Black
metal parts.
See also Interior Decoration and Painting of Pipes.
HULL CONSTRUCTION
282
WOOD
VESSELS
loft lines
Motor boats and other small craft with rounded bilges have
steam bent frames, while those with V cross sections have a straight
piece to the bilge and another vertical to it.
In tugs, lighters, schooners, and barges the frames are of several
pieces, that are bolted or treenailed together. All butts of timbers
of their molding.
Heads and
must be close and not less than
one piece of oak and the next one of chestnut. For the curved
parts as at the bilge, pieces are selected that can be trimmed, when
is
The keels
The
must be
Salting
is
recommended while
is
The
above
Salt stops
building.
the air strakes and at
a preservative
is
oakum and
made
and
thus
watertight.
cotton,
All vessels over iooo tons whose length exceeds ten times their
depth, must be diagonally strapped with iron plates of suitable
width and thickness on the outside of the frames. The straps
should be placed at an angle of 45 and extend from the coA^ering
to the heads of the floor timbers. Four at least of these diagonals
should cross one another on each side in the body of the vessel.
These straps should be riveted together where crossed and should
be let into the timbers and fastened to every frame by two bolts;
the upper end should be connected to a horizontal strap passing
around the hull.
clamps under
all
decks.
.The planking
is
caulked with
The beams
more rows
as
may
or
pillars,
if
WOOD VESSELS
Figure 47.
Some
283
JbEBB^bgE^BBBEE
The maximum
size of
as a rule
3,000 tons deadweight, for above this the stiffening required to get
HULL CONSTRUCTION
284
is
two butts in the same beam space. When the planks are 6 ins.
or under in width a single through bolt through every beam is sufficient; when they are above 6 ins. and not exceeding 8 ins. there must
be two bolts in every plank one of which may be a short screw bolt,
while planks exceeding 8 ins. must have two or more through bolts.
The bolts must be properly sunk into the wood, and their heads
1,000
Planking
Planks 26
Thick-
ft.
long
285
covered with wood plugs of the same material as the deck planks,
imbedded in white lead. The seams between the planks must be
well caulked with oakum and payed with pitch or marine glue.
The margin plank, that is the one next to the waterway, is 8 to
12 ins. wide,
of planking.
increased in
and into
it
ins.
is
increased in thickness so as to be
286
HULL CONSTRUCTION
Dome /Toof
S/0/>//?j?
/Zoof
SKYLIGHTS
287
The doors
Different
rooms and
may
Writing and dining tables are 2 ft. 5 ins. high. Mess tables
and benches are of white ash.
Interior decoration and painting should be governed by the trade
and climate. If the vessel is to run in the tropics the rooms should
be light and airy and finished off in white; if in cold regions then
dark woods and the reverse of the treatment for the tropics should
be followed.
white enamel paint and
the smoking rooms in oak. If the deck heights
permit, a ceiling may be built under the beams, thus giving a space
in which wires and pipes may be rim and yet be easily accessible by
having a few panels portable.
mahogany and
From
off in
HULL CONSTRUCTION
288
As a
lighting,
of the
room
in
shadow.
New
"Cork paint
partments.
"All piping whether bare or covered shall be painted to match
the compartment in which it runs.
MEASURING SCREWS
"The waterways on the upper deck and
plating way forward shall be painted buff,
289
ered deck forming the top of the deck house. Linoleum shall not
be painted but shall be thoroughly cleaned and heavily waxed.
Cork paint
but
be shellacked. "
not used in holds of merchant ships as
may
If directed it
is
it is
too expen-
is
of the bevel.
Lag Screws
Square heads, cone or gimlet points.
supplied from
/ie hi.
to
Diameter
M*A
of
Screw (Inches)
*y*
\v
\A
2
IX
sa
4
*X
5
?>A
6
A
Size of
Heads
41,
(Inches)
Vy
1A
n
/4
IK
o
CO
w
W
o
GO
O
O
o
o
CO
100
Wood
Drew out
(lb.)
293
HULL CONSTRUCTION
294
STRUCTURAL STRENGTH
As to proportions of vessels for strength, Lloyd's Rules state:
"All vessels exceeding 14 lengths in depths to have special stiffening which must be approved by the Committee, and all exceeding
13H depths must have a bridge extending over the midship half
length of the vessel or such special compensation for extreme pro"
portions as may be required by the Committee.
"Their rules
apply only to steam vessels the length of which does not exceed 11
times their depth and to sailing vessels the length of which does
not exceed ten times their depth. Vessels whose length to depth
exceed these proportions must have their scantlings augmented
and additional strengthening fitted/
For ordinary vessels of standard proportions built according to
'
American Bureau of Shipping, or other recognized society, usually no strength calculations are made, but they are made
for commercial craft of exceptional proportions, and for warships.
Below are outlined strength calculations and the curves that can
Lloyd's, the
line
on
forming a jagged
funnels,
Everything
pumps,
the boilers.
(2)
Engines.
densers,
etc.,
Everything
pumps,
etc., all
The weight
is
and Cons., G.
Nicols.
295
4i
.2
43
+i
3
o
O
o
>!
Xi
i
85
o3
43
c3
O
o
.3
O
O
.3
&e3
o3
Ot
ej
tj
P
e
OS
(3
o>
oj
rt
o
a
44
a
a
|o
"3
o a
4*
s-g
O
03
T3
O
oo
^
* g
SZi/JO/ye
2
5
43
CO
9 $
^so^jp/lft/oy^
9/&9$
a
03
13
0)
a
a
03
ua
o
43
*
T3
Ci
5 v;
*
13
-*
o;
296
HULL CONSTRUCTION
of this
multiplying by 1, as a section is assumed as 1 ft. in length, and dividing the product by 35, to get the buoyancy in tons per foot
of length in salt water. These quantities are laid off at the same
intervals as selected for the curve of weights, and a curve through
By
*if
axis.
Two calculations are necessary, one for the section under a hoga sagging. In each case the posiging moment and the other under
CURVE OF LOADS
tion of the neutral axis
and moment
297
different.
As
draw a horizontal
HULL CONSTRUCTION
298
of inertia
is
Ia =
of inertia,
p = M
y
crest is usually
moment
is
9600
X 350
.
Ann foot-tons.
96000
ft
6o
=
-y-,
taken as Js of the
maximum bending
Jjf
23l8
qfi0m
stress
12314
ships of 300
and
the
full
For sagging the full area above the axis is taken, and
area below the axis to allow for rivet holes.
when making
by the
excess of weight
299
The shearing
vessels of
480
ft.
is
to be treble
This
and
after
obtained from one of shearing stresses by taking the area from the forward end to any given
ordinate and laying this area off perpendicular to the base line.
A curve through the points gives the curve of bending moments.
The bending moment at any point in the length of a vessel may be
sum
is
from
D X L
5=
00
The minimum
maxi mum
moment
of inertia
In
all
is important.
The average vessel may
be assumed to have a rectangular one, and although such a section is
a strong one, yet by adding a center longitudinal web or bulkhead
its strength can be greatly increased, the web taking the strains
to a large extent off the sides or shell plating, and furthermore
Pillars.)
HULL CONSTRUCTION
300
certain
flat
surfaces
SPECIFICATION HEADINGS
In preparing the specifications of a vessel it is often of service
to have a fist of the hull, engine, boiler and miscellaneous equipment that may be required. Below is a list that will serve as
a guide.
.
Introduction
Payments
Insurance
Trial
Builder's guaranty
Classification Society
Hull
Frames,
size of
and spacing
MACHINERY
Machinery
Engines
type,
I.
H. P.
301
HULL CONSTRUCTION
302
Continued
If [a U. S.
vessel, see
U. S. Steamboat Inspection
Rules
Signals.
Pumps
Hose
Navigating instruments
Fresh water
Pumps
Tanks
Tarpaulin covers
Refrigeration system
C0 2 ammonia or dense air
Insulation
Baking
outfit
Galley outfit
Ship machinery
Steering engine
Pantry
Capstan
Windlass
Winches
Glassware
communication
Signal system between
house and engine room
Dishes
Interior
pilot
U.
Steamboat Inspection
S.
outfit
Rules.
Linen
Bedding
Carpenter's stores
Flags
Boatswain's stores
Wireless
Lights
Storm
oil
HULL WEIGHTS
The
Weight of finished
depth
coefficient.
The
length
coefficient varies
breadth
from .0036 to
WEIGHTS
Surface Foot.
bottom
deck.
Let
of the flat
Then
303
surface foot
length
(breadth
2d).
The pounds per square foot vary from 97 to 125 and taking
a mean value of 111, the surface foot found by the formula,
length X (breadth + 2d) multiplied by 111 will give the
weight in lb. of the finished steel in a vessel.
Of the total weight of hull steel, from 70 to 80% is taken up by
The rethe keel, frames, beams, keelsons, deck and shell plating.
laining 30 to 20% represents bulkheads, engine foundations,
lasts, etc.
is
class,
a steamer
but other-
Table of Weights*
Items
reverses
reverses
Connecting angles,
Hatches
etc., in
tank
Side keelsons
Main deck plating
Upper deck plating
Tank top
Tunnel
Bulkheads
Shell.
Erections
*
From A
Class
Book on Naval
Architecture,
Steamer
Steamer
Steamer
Per cent.
Per cent.
Per cent.
7.5
2.1
1.8
1.7
4.4
5.8
6.9
3.3
2.2
2.4
10.4
1.8
4.8
1.6
4.8
26.8
3.3
7.6
2.2
2.0
1.3
6.2
5.8
6.3
2.7
2.2
1.7
10.0
1.7
4.6
2.1
4.2
26.4
3.9
7.2
1.5
1.7
3.2
3.8
6.2
6.3
2.2
1.8
2.4
7.8
1.7
3.5
1.9
3.0
26.6
5.8
W.
J.
Lovett.
HULL CONSTRUCTION
304
long, 46
ft.
ft.
beam, 34
ft.
ins.
rule.
Weight
Part of Hull
in
Tons
275.0
301.0
225.4
142.5
102.7
40.0
25.0
37.7
119.4
lings
Floors and
tail plates
Beams and
3.5
20.0
carlings
Keelsons
Bulkheads (W. T.)
Bunker casings
Engine and boiler seats
Shaft tunnel and stools
Inner bottom plating
Shell plating, including bulkhead
liners
Deck houses
Sundry deck and hold work
Fresh water tanks
Slip iron
From
steel,
weight
'.
Summary
Tons
6.0
Forgings. ...
587.0
Angles
Plates
2063.6
Bulb Tee. ... 168.4
Slips
Moldings
Castings
Rivet heads.
734.2
217.6
305.3
37.5
77.6
140.0
25.0
13.2
57.0
46.5
44.0
Total
57.0
46.5
17.5
44
.
2990.0
2990.0
MACHINERY WEIGHTS
is
per
i.
The
i.
h. p.
in boilers) is
460
i.
ft.
h. p.
5.5
MACHINERY WEIGHTS/
or
305
Main
engines
Condensing equipment
Auxiliary machinery
Piping
60
40
lb.
per
i.
h. p.
lb.
per
i.
h. p.
15
lb.
per
i.
h. p.
20
lb.
per
i.
h. p.
15
lb.
per
i.
h. p.
River (U.
S.)
lb.
per
i.
on Boilers.
on the Mississippi
h. p.
The sum
gives
an
Machinery Weights*
Engine
19
X 30 X 50
306
HULL CONSTRUCTION
MISCELLANEOUS WEIGHTS
Four-furnace single-end Scotch boiler, 11
by 16 ft. dia., without water
Weight of water
ft.
307
long
40 tons
20
60 tons
Total
Four-furnace
long by 16
Weight
of
20
ft.
70 tons
40
water
110 tons
Total
Formula
for Finding
Weight
of
Boiler.
Let
D =
L
P =
C for
C for
Weight
Formula
working pressure
for Finding
Weight
Scotch boilers.
Assume the water to be 7
of
ins.
=
=
725
765
-^
Water (assumed
to be cold) in
chamber
D =
L m
Weight
of water in tons
r^r
Miscellaneous Weights.
Ordinary fire bars, 5 ft. 6 ins. long
ins. long
Ordinary fire bars, 5 ft.
Howden's fire bars, 5 ft. 9 ins. long
Howden's fire bars, 5 ft. 6 ins. long
Weight of fire bricks 140 lb. per cubic foot.
Weight of covering (lagging) about one-half a
per square foot.
Above formulae from Marine
Boilers, J.
Gray.
66 lb.
601b.
47 lb.
45 lb.
pound
HULL CONSTRUCTION
308
3.5
4.94
9.5
12.25
8.48
12.9
21.0
33.4
41.0
39.5
53.75
77.57
52.0
101.0
Grate Surface
Heating Surface
Weight
Sq. Ft.
Sq. Ft.
Lb.
120
222
333
516
307
521
750
1,290
2,170
4,020
6,520
3,550
5,500
8,180
9,670
14,100
16,500
22,680
29,460
17,000
30,000
1,087
1,310
1,649
1,920
2,846
2
1,650
2
3,300
...
by Chas. Seabury & Co., New York. They have a single steam
to two lower or mud drums, one on each side, by two nests of
bent tubes inclosing a large combustion chamber.
1
Boilers built
drum connected
2
Special.
Finished Weight of Machinery, " Steam Up, " cargo steamer 377
ft. bet. perps., 49 ft. 3 ins. beam, 28 ft. 9 ins. deep, draft 23 ft. 6
Two single end
ins., displacement 9750 tons, block coefficient .78.
Scotch boilers 16 ft. dia. X 12 ft. long, 180 lbs. working pressure,
each with three furnaces, Howden's forced draught, total heating
surface 6200 sq.
ft.,
1.
25
ft.,
engine
of
41
jr
4o
68
103^ knots.
Tons
Main
Boilers (bare)
Boiler mountings
Furnace
'.
Smoke boxes
Funnel and
fittings
Ventilators
Water
in
main
boilers
Lagging
Fire bricks
207.20
309
Tons
2.5
3.15
1.75
4.6
107.0
9.5
7.25
45.85
9.0
5.7
11.8
12.0
5.0
4.5
1.0
Furnace fronts
'
Retarders
Air trunks and heater boxes
Main Engines proper
Condenser
Thrust shaft and block
Tunnel and propeller shaft
Pipes, valves
Ballast pipes
and pieces
and chests
room
..
Lagging
Tons
12.00
218.60
Auxiliaries
Weir's
pumps and
3.8
heater
.8
Filter
Evaporator
Ballast
2.5
1.6
'.
pump
Donkey pump
Fresh water donkey
Telegraphs
Ash
.4
.3
pump
.1
.8
hoist
1.4
Auxiliary condenser
Winch Outfit
Donkey boiler
Feed
pump
Winch
11.70
20.0
(complete)
.3
for
5.2
pipes
25.50
475.00
Up"
Merchant Vessels.
ON VESSELS
DATA
Under
heading are included ocean-going
this
vessels for carrying passengers and freight.
M^>00>000
CO O b00 o
(NWCOO^O
T*
OCiOOO
ft
ft
iO
T-tCM
ft
ft
ft
CO
OClcOCiCO
CO
'CO(N^
"tfCOCM
t^
OOOOONOOS
i GO
OOOOCO
CO i
CM
t CO Oi CO iO CO iO
o
CN
COCO,
O^coco
lO-^COCM
CM
CO
ft
ft
ft
CO
ft
rHV^OlO
ft
ft
boXi
OiO'-'CN
CO
>
CO
CO
i-H
T-t
ft
(NQOH
CO J> CM CO
>t>.ft
o
CO
ft
v V V V
*-l
CM
iN-*OOOCOHOOH
CMCOCOCMOCM
O
CN iH t~ CN CO CO
CN
I>
^ CO QQi-l ^
ft
ft
Q
CO
1> IO CN
CO rl
pfr-i
GO
O^C0<N
ft
<*b8COOft
tOjOOOMfflH
Tt<
ft
ft
ft
-l
iO
COCOv GO
CN0iCN
ft
t>. <N
S^HlOft
biO CN
ft
ft
coco
05 CO GO CO
CO
v v v
H
Tt^cOt^CO
CNCOi-iCN
i-Hv
CM
X
oo;
>2"
8 I
oo
ci
^.r-'* fits
25
gp
g-3
-
t.
u
1
ft
Es
!t
o 00
<
ON
CO CO
COCO
52
oii
o &
<M
<N Jg
'cj>c*
8X<
"
82
XX
2*5
ft
>o
5&^3
- X
:*5
'Wo
II
3^
IX
OS
,"S
**
a f
niojjf vyoofloj
em 6
%}
pao'joj s t
sui g %} f\ sjajioq qafjoog jnojj
H 10
..
-d
aurej^
'sin g
%}
'qoiid
-^qSnBjp
'saajiadoag
'
\\ A"q -Bip
-a
CO
*j
i*tp 'sui
.<
ft
^ O D
""*
5 iO >o
c<,
AauBAonq jo aa^uao i^j -bs 088*61 'arnqd aa^BA*. jo bbjb fg6' 'uoi^
-oas diqspira jo ^uaiaujaoo l*fy *bs egg; 'uoipas diqspira bbjb S06Z
'oi^Buisud ig^" Vraaioqjaoa 3j{Joig
'oifpvj 'jaraea^s ^qSiaj^j
'
3uoj ^j gg
qoBa 'qo^oog aDBnjnj 8 fpapna-a[qnop *jg
'sjajiog
"s^jBqs aa^uao oa^ aq ^ SuiAijp 'aa^uaa aq^ ui bjb uja^se
d *j omi pn paq *d q oav^ aiiqM. 'pj^oqa^s ui uaa^SB 'd *q jaq^o
-we puB pBaqe *d q 'raooj aui3ua i^jod ui aa^ aiiiqjn^ uaa^sB *d *q
A*q 'Bip *sui
oo g
'^J
'S
-d -q aq^ s^jBqs f
-ziQ 'Maao logSg l^o^ !pg 866T
!p2 jj9 :sja3uassBd sscp ^bi 819 '08S'II ^qSiaMp^ap j^o^ Io009
'saa^nnq IQ006 'XjauiqaBui :suo^ 091*62 '^qSiaM. |jnjj viuvjmby
puB p^aqB
ec
*0^i *suoiiiqoAai Jqoui \ 'pjoq a^o^s ui ajnssajd jib '-sni ^fgg umn
*suo^ 99 'suopipuoo Sumuiu iapun XaauiqoBin' jo ^qSiaM
-oba
'
-bm Suijooq
T3
.-
Wj
<M
ICO
ssBp
a
o
'oosiauBJ^
^o
1 1
(
006'0T
9 Z\
009 'J
021
801
OOZ'9
d -q -g
*"82
Z'82
00S
002
002
suj
qi
8 "82
59 ZT
S 91
9tT
umnaB^ uiBa^g
r
vxvq iviux
'paadg
jaSuassBd oi^ubjibsub.ij,
cs
^
'Avaios ajSuig
Z8T
Z2T
TIT
Z0ZT
28SI
Z88T
ja^jadojj auiqanjL
suoi^njOAog
o
OOMo
ClOONM
tm
On10
6
m ^^
c3
m a
a>
"S ft
on
"5
A*!
g
rt
vw
-.
ift^
^3
P.
<3
ft ox*<TT
fJ
o>
ea
[]_
jio
o;
'dqg
'Buo^sy q -yed
ujaq^ao^ ^BajQ
OOWO
wi
2j
OOO
V,o -o
JQO
(S
'-ajQ
oijiobj
auiB^
JO
'9SIZ
o
CO
pw
m ^qSia^pBap
uaaq^ao^
uBg uaaM-jaquna
^sx '000'002
-*3
C3^
h3
Q1<>
HARBOR VESSELS
313
ft.
bulb angles with the top of the floor plates flanged over, thus doing
away with reverse frames. In long, shallow draft vessels, the
hull is strengthened by longitudinal trusses from the floors to the
main deck. Above the main deck there may be several uprights
or posts over which pass rods that are connected to the hull at both
ends to prevent it from sagging. The deck beams may be of bulb
angles with one on every frame. The guard beams should be
bracketed to the sheer strake and secured to the lodger plate in-
to outside.
Sponsons are
The machinery of side wheelers varies from the old simple beam
engine to the modern compound and three-cylinder compound
The simple
inclined and four-cy Under compound double inclined.
low
mainteinitial
cost
and
low
beam engine has great durability,
nance. The boilers for this type of engine are of the flue and return
tubular type having a working pressure of around 55 lb., with long
grates, high fire boxes, and simple forced draught, both under and
over the grates. With inclined engines, they have Scotch boilers,
steam 130 to 180 lb., equipped with Howden's forced draught
Stern wheelers have horizontal engines (see section on
system.
Marine Engines).
ocean towing are preferably of steel, while for harbor
Steam yachts of 150 ft. or
service of wood, as also are lighters.
over have steel hulls. Tugs and yachts having steel hulls are
Tugs
for
Motor
Ships.
by Lloyd's
Type
Length
Between
of Vessel
Beam
Depth
Draft
4' 3'
Perpendiculars
Tug.
70' 6"
75' 0" O.A.
18' 8'
7' 6"
Tug,
23' 0"
11' 3*
Tug.
20'
Material Carrying
of Hull Capacity
Wood
Wood
9' 8*
9'0"
Wood
102' 0",
20'
13' 0*
12' 6"
Wood
Tug.
119' 6"
130' 0* O.A.
25' 9"
16' 3*
12' 0"
Steel
Tug.
158' 0"
165' 0* O.A.
29' 4"
19' 0*
Steel
28' 0*
9'0"
Steel
320 tons
Ug .........!
Lighter
tJ,
i ,,.
95' 0"
Lighter ...............
1 10'
30' 0"
11' 6"
Steel
450 tons
Day
130' 0*
28' 0"
12' 0"
Steel
500 pas-
Excursion ^
.
>
sengers
Stern Wheel
135' 0*
156' 0* O.A.
Western River
23' 4'
4' 6*
3' 9'
Steel
5'0
Steel
180' 0"
9'0"
Wheel Excursion
180' 0*
12' 0*
190' 0"
11' 7*
7'0*
Wood
Wheel Excursion.
200' 0"
211' 0" O.A.
9/0"
4'0*
Steel
200' 0*
213' 0* O.A.
17' 3*
12' 0*
Steel
250' 0*
263' 0" O.A.
tire*
Steel
Steam Yacht
153' 0*
185' 0* O.A.
23' 0*
11' o
Wood
Side
.Side
314
1000
Steel
2200
54 1st
48 3d
Engines
Twin screw
8
18
Is
|.?h
^"^
*u9Aup-ou}08[9 3jb uiooj 3ui3u3 sqj ui ssuBqrcnB 3q} puB sssodjnd Supsioq
<1
puB Suuss^s
HKjoom
00 O ION <M
CO CO
"(uiba^
2$>
'
<!
<5H
oomh
o<oo^<m
iH CO N rH
W
!'
'jajioq
[B^oj,
'
oav^ ui pajo^s -qj g/,g o^ 00g J ^V* i0 } Jossajduioo b 'puB ouiBuAp b qoBa
SuiAiip ''SAaj qzZ 1 tl 0Ba d 'R 002 ^noqB jo sauiSua jasaiQ ajoAa-jnoj oav^
IsauBqixny *jnoq jaAvod asjoq jad jio jo punod 6Z9 'uopdransuoa pnj
f'SAaj'g^x '-d'q ggOg'JB s-^ou^ \f\i 'paads '3uoj *^j o^ 'uiooj auiSua I-jjb
*
'
sauiSug
-sauiSug
0001 ^ 0B8 'a^ojqi's *sui
peaiQ
sbjj
"d 'q
*sjnoq fz
a8<J
3S
^a
0001
'l
10
F nJ J
H8
"
'W
-009'T9
sqnq
*^jb sauiSug;
|io A"jjbd o^ ^jmq 'vijpr) 'diqs jo auiB^j
;
j'ad punod og sbav 'sjou^ 'paads 'papBOj Xqnj 'sdui
]io
apnjQ
-3J ^33Jip
o ^0001
*
qo
co
S^
7*
sjspuqog J3puqA*3-jnoj
-d'-q
osg
Suoj uo uopdmnsuoo
saoj egg 'sauiSus 3jqisj3A
^X iq3i3MpB3p
suoij
QS9I
uopduinsuoa jsn^
316
s
* s
0000NOOOONOHOO
t-l(N<Mi-l
Wi-lr-lr-lC^
.3
o
CO
'CCCO-^CO
.potco
0>
03
ft
o
->
fti
'COfOCOCOCCCOCOCOCOCO
'OOOOQOiOOOO
OOOOOOMOOO
>
'OOOC0 00 50 05NON
-*>
CQ
GO
H
o
<}
CQ
o
H
o
*
I
i-ftfCCXNCO-^^O-^CO^OO
I
owjioinoo^o^oooo
H
r-l
CO
(N^COOOOOOrJ4cO
.(NCS(Nr-ie0'^C0COO
'QOCOOOOOCOOOO
,-^'<*00000(NTt<T^OO
_
7
bO
(DO
<NC3t^O<NiOOON.O*OtO
(N<NC^COeOCO^-^iOON.OO
ft
H
.
3
o
I I'll
317
If s'l-s-a
HULL CONSTRUCTION
318
Motor Boats.
For cost
is
the
bottom
for cruisers
As
of up-
to the
the cross sections are Vs, and the ordinary curved or round bottom. Hydroplanes have practically flat bottoms with steps, the
and running on a step when at full speed. Gasohave superseded steam for pleasure craft from 30 to
100 ft., for not only are the former easier to handle, but they take
up less space and a smaller crew is required.
Motor boats over 15 tons come under the supervision of the U. S.
Steamboat-Inspection Service, and are classed as steamboats.
While limited as to carrying capacity motor boats are allowed more
passengers than steamboats of the same size. Their operating
conditions are set forth in their certificates of inspection. In some,
the equipment includes air tanks, under the decks, of sufficient
size to float the boat with her complete complement of passengers
with the hull full of water. Boats over 65 ft. long, carrying freight
for hire are required to have a licensed pilot and engineer.
After January 1, 1915, the U. S. Steamboat-Inspection Service
requires that all ocean steam vessels of over 2,500 gross tons carrying passengers and whose course takes them 200 miles or so offshore shall be equipped with not less than one motor-propelled
hydroplane
lifting
line engines
lifeboat.
in the
countries.
sizes trading
Many
See
Wood
owned by Norwegians.
Vessels.
Length
Breadth
Depth
Deadweight
(tons)
of Engines
Brake h. p. of each
Total brake h. p.
.
Number
Motors
ft
HULL CONSTRUCTION
320
Length
Breadth ....
Depth
100. 1'
11'
Gross tons
115
79
Net tons
Two
4-cycle each
37.5 h.p.
Engines
7l
Speed
Consumption
6^
knots
gals, of gasoline
per hour
103'
24'
11.8'
141
22.7'
9.8'
94
64
93
Two
Two
4-cycle each
37.5 h.p.
9 knots
7 gals, of gasoline
4-cycle each
50 h.p.
8 knots
7M gals,
per hour
of gasoline
per hour
MISCELLANEOUS VESSELS
Oil Carriers.
of it in
many
of oil
oil carriers
must be
machinery space.
When
and
Some
partment has an expansion trunk large enough to keep the compartment always full, but with a small free surface so that the fluidity
The trunks
of the oil will not cause much if any loss of stability.
are arranged so the surface of the oil will not fall below the sides
COFFERDAMS
321
when the
their
vessel
Committee
is
rolling or pitching in
Cofferdams are
fitted at the
oil
space, and when the machinery is amidships they are also fitted
at each end of the machinery space so that the oil cargo will be
the keel to the continuous expansion trunk for the full breadth of
the vessel. The cofferdams are practically additional bulkheads
The caulking
artificial ventilation.
'*
Lloyd's Rules state: "Oil fuel the flash point of which by Abel's
close test does not fall below 150 F. may be carried inordinary
HULL CONSTRUCTION
322
Jc/ct/orrOarelfa/ve
rromfbrrram.
Art ffv/7jnrjr
<Sucfwn6ofei
Plan
Clcvation
Figure 50.
"
when
have
above the load line or 12 ft. above the highest point of^the
compartment, whichever of these is the greatest.
"Each compartment must be fitted with an air pipe to be always
open, discharging above the upper deck. It is recommended
12
ft.
OIL FUEL
COMPARTMENTS
323
all
bottom
"
plating.
Efficient means
must be provided by
wells or gutterways,
and
sparring or lining to prevent any leakage from any of the oil fuel
compartments from coming into contact with cargo or coal, and to
ensure that any such leakage shall have free drainage into the
limbers or wells.
"If double bottoms under holds are used for carrying oil fuel
the ceiling must be laid on transverse battens, leaving at least 2
air space
compartment by the oil fuel pump at the same time as the ballast
donkey pump is being used on any other compartment.
"All oil fuel suction pipes should have valves or cocks fitted
at the bulkheads where they enter the stoke hold, capable of being
worked both from the stoke hold and from the deck. Valves or
cocks similarly worked are to be fitted to all pipes leading from
the settling or service tanks.
"No wood
be
hold
spaces.
oil fuel is
HULL CONSTRUCTION
324
into a tank or
or feed tank."
*
Oil
in tankers is carried to
the skin of the vessel (except those with cylindrical tanks) and in
many cases no Water ballast tanks are below the oil tanks but may
tanks, the tops of the pipes having covers of wire gauze sheets to
prevent sparks or hot cinders from entering the tanks.
usually aft), or
it
below it.
forward of the machinery space and the other amidships;
The oil pumps are kept entirely separate from the pumps which
fill or clear the water ballast spaces of water, and no water ballast
pipe passes through an oil compartment or vice versa. There
are two main lines of suction pipe, one on each side of the center
Each line has a suction to each tank on
longitudinal bulkhead.
its own side of the ship, and may have one passing through the longitudinal bulkhead to the corresponding compartment on the other
side.
Two valves are fitted to each suction and these are operated
by rods on the weather deck. There are thus two sections in each
compartment and four in each tank, an arrangement which permits both sides of the vessel to be dealt with through the same line
simultaneously. In other cases each line has only one suction on
each side of the center line bulkhead with valves worked from the
upper deck, a master valve being in each line at the bulkheads
also controlled from the upper deck.
When oil is carried in the summer tanks, these may have drop
valves which permit the contents of a tank being drained into
the one immediately below and then discharged through the main
lines. This involves carrying the same quality of oil in the 'tweendeck spaces as is carried in the corresponding hold space. On
many vessels the summer tanks have an independent line of about
4
ins.
diameter.
In emptying the tanks of oil, the pumps will clear the whole of
the cargo in the tanks but will leave the pipe lines full. Ordinarily
this is drained into the end compartment and dealt with by a hand
or by buckets.
Steam heating coils
pump
* Abstracts of a
J.
Montgomerie
of Lloyd's.
when heavy
of Oil
Steamers" by
PIPING
viscous oil
is
carried
peratures; in fact a
is
it
ARRANGEMENT
difficult to
handle
temperature of 120
may
325
steam
on deck.
Or, instead, a
system of copper pipes with 13^-in. branches extend to within a foot
In this case the fire extinguishing
of the bottom of the tanks.
line
When
general cargo
is
set of pipes,
2^
of 2 ins. to the
sum-
mer
tanks, with cocks at each tank, the pipes being led to one of
about 3 ins. which runs up one of the masts, or there may be two
such pipes.
In some cases after the oil has been pumped out the heavy
air mixed with the gas from the oil is partially removed by opening
the hatches and fixing up a canvas ventilator the bottom of which
extends nearly to the top of the floors. The fresh air entering the
ventilator forces upward the heavy air out through the hatch
openings. Sometimes a fan assists in the movement of the air.
See also Loading and Stowing of Cargoes.
326
HULL CONSTRUCTION
LUMBER STEAMERS
327
An
reneral Notes.
>age 257.
Lumber Steamers.
deck with a
single
ft.
10
i.
;;
ft.
ins.,
i'
5
*
ion
steam
180
ins.,
h. p. 2,150,
speed
Trawlers. Small
2414
ik
lb.,
ft.,
engine
383^
67
,
90
r.
p.
m.,
11 knots.
common
in the
North Sea
until they
The
fish are
lb.,
hulls, ship-shaped,
having
their
is
and
offshore work.
designed
Many
of
the dredge. When the Jioppers are filled the dredge steams out to
sea and there discharges. An example of this type is the King
George, 170
ft.
long, 34
ft.
beam, 13
ft.
ins.
HULL CONSTRUCTION
328
Each engine
screw, triple expansion engines each of 600 h. p.
can be coupled to the dredging gear.
The dredging buckets have
a- capacity of 9 cu. ft. each and are fastened on an endless chain.
There are 32 buckets, with a cast
steel
iron
deep, has a hopper capacity of 71,600 cu. ft. The hull and
machinery are built to Lloyd's highest class. Propelling machinery
consists of two triple expansion engines.
There are four large single-
ins.
end and horizontal boilers, steam 180 lb. The pumping outfit
placed forward of the hopper in an independent compartment
consists of a triple expansion engine directly connected to a centrifugal sand pump designed to raise and discharge about 5,000
dredged; a grid
silt
is
own
condenser.
These
may
Marine Engines) When handling barges they push the barges ahead,
which is the reverse to ocean towing. They often have three or
four rudders placed forward of the stern wheel. The rudders are
given a large area; in fact the immersed area of three rudders averages from 115 to 150 sq. ft. A typical example is the towboat
Warioto, 141 ft. over all, 120 ft. between perps., 27 ft. beam, depth
at side 5 ft., crown of deck 6 ins., draft with 30 tons of coal on
board 3 ft. 8 ins., displacement about 270 short tons (2,000 lb.),
.
block coefficient
three 6-inch, grate area 48 sq. ft., heating surface 1,365 sq. ft.,
engine developed 304 i. h. p., 26.9 lb. of steam being required per
In another
i. h. p. per hour for the main and auxiliary engines.
a
*Eb
W
0)
HULL CONSTRUCTION
330
towboat 125
engines
compound
24
12 X
-=~
which weighed complete with condensers and pip-
ing 81,345
94,460
etc.,
ft.
lb.,
lb.
18
diameter, buckets 17
weight of wheel 9,380 lb.
ft.
ft.
l^ m
ft.,
3/*
boiler 5
ft.
ins.
diameter by 12
ft.
ins. long,
steam 140
lb.
of Fittings per
Cementing on deck
Total woodwork
Head
of Cattle Carried.
J^ ins. thick
including bolts
1
Castings and
Gnawing
must be provided
lb.
400.00
lb.
strips
Hollow stanchions
185.00
139 62
11 43
37 19
6 00
9 74
1 1 02
.
fittings
PRICES, COSTS
Weight
of Fittings per
AND ESTIMATES
331
Horse Carried
185.00
273 55
34 1 1
200 34
lb.
lb.
558.00
lb.
lb.
that the average expense for food for horses and attendants for a
voyage from New York to Liverpool is about $5 a head.
PRICES, COSTS
AND ESTIMATES
sold in
May,
1915,
to the
Drumlanrig
Rhodesia
Dongola
Whindyke
St. Fillans
Kalypso
Winnfield
Woolstan
Denaby
Amphitrite
Leafield
Hartburn
Gledhow
Lula
D.W.
Built
7,600
7,350
7,300
7,200
7,100
6,500
6,400
6,000
5,800
5,400
5,100
4,400
4,340
3,820
3,800
3,600
1900
1901
1906
1900
1898
1901
1900
1904
1901
1900
1900
1897
1905
1900
1891
1890
Price
52,000
51,500
73,000
49,000
48,500
45,000
45,000
60,000
40,000
40,000
38,000
28,000
36,000
28,000
20,000
19,250
6 16
7
10
6 16
6 16
6 18
7
10
6 17
7
6
8
7
5
8
9
7
5
6
5
6
HULL CONSTRUCTION
332
Girda Ambatiellos
Axminster
Citrine
Karmo
Carmelina
Allan
Rign
Arena
Roar
Netta
D.W.
Built
3,450
3,100
2,755
2,750
2,750
2,300
2,300
1,900
1,900
1,400
1899
1888
1888
1891
1899
1882
1904
1907
1897
1883
1904
1909
1902
950
480
180
Jessie
Continued
Rate per ton
8 13
Price
30,000
5 15
5 8
6 1
9 1
6 19
10 8
13 13
l0
18,000
15,000
16,500
25,000
16,000
24,000
26,000
19,000
12,000
12,000
9,000
3,000
11
12 12
18 15
15 9
Crown
River Forth
King
Orkedal
Calimeris
Llansannor
Woodbridge
Navarchus Coundouritos.
Agenoria
Huldavore
Zulina
Astarloa
New
New
Steamer
Steamer
Antonios Embiricos
Sirte
Bizcaya
Harpalys
John
Alfred Kreglinger
Alfred Dumois
Artigas
Allerton
D.W.
Built
7,700
7,500
7,450
7,335
7,300
7,300
6,650
6,250
6,250
6,060
5,550
5,200
5,000
5,000
4,500
3,500
3,300
3,100
2,900
2,300
2,200
1,600
1,500
1,300
1,100
1907
1916
1909
1906
1907
1906
1906
1905
1900
1900
1898
1902
1889
1899
1896
1916
1916
1891
1887
1878
1895
1881
1909
1890
1911
1914
1905
1884
Price
150,000
19
180,000
135,000
115,000
110,000
125,000
178,000
140,000
175,000
90,000
155,000
70,000
100;000
140,000
101,000
70,000
85,800
62,000
45,000
41,000
33,000
36,250
37,000
13,000
20,000
31,000
17,500
6,500
24
18
2
15 13
15 .1
17 2
26 15
22 8
28
14 16
27 19
13 9
20
28
22 8
20
26
20
15 10
17 16
15
22 13
24 13
10
18 3
37 9
30 14
830
570
27 1
240
Portaferry
The following are miscellaneous quotations made in the United
St.
Katharine
ft.
deep,
new
hull,
to build $35,000.
200
ft.
long,
32
ft.
beam, by
PRICES ASKED IN
333
1916
scow 120 ft. by 35 ft. by 13 ft., 800 cu. yd., wood, good
condition, but second-hand $4,500.
Deck scow 90 ft. by 27 ft. by 9 ft., good condition, second-hand
Dump
$1,000.
The
are as follows:
Built
165
195
196
211
218
ft
ft
ft
ft
ft
1883
1901
1891
1890
1894
$25,000
50,000
50,000
50,000
55,000
round bottom work boat 40 ft. long, 9 ft. beam, having good
lines, with no pilot house, the boat being open with short decks
forward and aft, oak keel, stem, and frames, white cedar planking,
galvanized iron fastenings, cost $1,950. The same size but with
a V bottom cost $1,650, and one 50 ft. by 12 ft. round bottom
cost $3,000 and with a V bottom $2,400.
The above prices do
not include motor, fuel tank, or auto top; neither do they include
the installation of the motor, other than a properly constructed
foundation.
HULL CONSTRUCTION
334
225' 0"
Breadth
42' 6"
Depth.
18' 0"
1,250
Lumber
1,125
7
capacity
Machinery, two
oil
1,500,000
ft.
B.
M.
320
Machinery
$85,000
installation
19,000
18,000
Cost complete
$122,000
Crew
5%
$6,100
Cost of Operating
Captain
mate
Second mate
Cook
Cabin boy. .....
First
$775
Food, at 68c per man, 15
men
12
for 1 year.
$9,300
3,723
$13,023
$35.67
p.
95c per bbl
at
bbl.
J4
Lubricating
oil
at 41c
$0,237
.060
.297
$7.13
Taxes at
$14.26
5,204.80
200.00
$5,404.80
600.00
/%
l
335
5%
7%
Depreciation,
6,100.00
Insurance,
8,540.00
1,830.00
5,000 00
Liability,
1}4%
Upkeep and
repairs
$40,497 80
110.95
.
14 26
.
$96 69
Wash.
15 day&
Food
Fixed charges per day
Seattle,
$12 00
2.72
60 47
.
$75.19
board feet of lumber
15 days
$1,107.85
1,275 00
1,350.00
22 00
.
$256.68
36 days ship
Unloading N. Y., 15 days
Unloading, stevedores
3,480.84
96.69
M board feet
$3,737.52
1,450.35
1,275 00
.
$10,217.72
$6.81
24,300
Cost of fuel
$325 13
oil for
season
15,000
.
HULL CONSTRUCTION
336
Tug 70
hours
$1 76
.
l^c
beam, 10
Name Chickamauga.
engine.
Hours towing
Hours running light
ft.
long, 18
12^
ft.
ft.
draft,
240
Nlseco Diesel
h. p.
662
188
Cannery tender 75
long, 18
ft.
Name
ft.
850
7725
$167.79
9.1
19^c
beam, 8
ft.
1489 hrs.
8664
5.8
95c
Cost
Name
h. p.
Chomly.
Total fuel
120
draft,
bill for
season
13 lc
.
$195.97
of repairs $2.00.
of ship.
90 in 3 years
Very
pairs
Deadweight capacity
Horse power
Fuel consumption per
.
geogr. mile
little
time
300 tons
200
Myer
02 tons
0.16
liter
The
i.
h. p. for
an
oil-fired
steamer.
complete,
including apparatus
stalling:
Type
of Vessel
337
and
in-
HULL CONSTRUCTION
338,
The equipment items for a 33-foot raised deck cruiser are as follows
Main power plant, 20 h. p., 4-cycle motor, magneto, fuel tanks,
piping, etc.
Electrical equipment, running lights, switches, storage battery,
dynamo, and
fixtures.
Miscellaneous
equipment,
charts,
marine
navigating
glasses,
instruments.
and cockpit
ports,
mahogany
interior
signal
life
preservers,
anchors,
moorings,
etc.
rugs, stove,
and
is
'
339
The
ESTIMATE SHEET.
Estimate No.
For
-HULL CONSTRUCTION
340
Pound
in
Cents *
'J3
Items.
aa
steel in hull
Plating, outer and inner
Ordinary
1.
bottoms
Framing
Bulkheads
Decks
1,
1
3,
hammock
9
5,
15.
7.
10.
Inclosures
16.
11,
Rivets
Steel castings and forgings forming structural parts of hull
Deck pillars or stanchions
Deck planking and wood in docking and bilge keels
Linoleum, tiling, etc
.
Joiner work
Carpenter work
Wood
Wood
Metal ladders
Paint, cement, etc
Turret turning machinery, roller tracks and rollers
Fixed ammunition hoist machinery and gear
Rudder and
steering gear
of
2.1
1.1
1.0
.7
1.1
.6
3
12.11 11.0
25
1
1.2
30.9 30
11.
12.0
8.0
5.0
1.1
15.4
16.5 38.0
13.
11.
9.
19.
25.
5.
11.
10.
13.
10.
15
W.
1.5
2.2
1.4
3.3
(I
21,
03
Ott
1.1
15
10
15
16
12
6.
8
1.4 8
7,
4
7
8
6
15
Constructor, U. S. N.
5,
Manhole
39.
24.
ladders
13.
3.8
4.9
4.0
2.5
3.4
8.3
10.9
3.0
20.
40
25
51
13
15
7
17
4.1
1.3
30.0 17.1
25.0 8.7
44.2 16.8
18.1 17.2
30.0 2.6
25.0 13
2.3
0.9
0.8
B. Ferguson, Naval
SECTION VI
MACHINERY
STEAM, FUELS, OIL, BOILERS, MARINE STEAM ENGINES,
STEAM TURBINES, STEAM PLANT AUXILIARIES,
INTERNAL COMBUSTION ENGINES, PIPING,
TUBING, VALVES AND FITTINGS
STEAM
One
British
Thermal Unit
(B.
t.
u.)
is
Heat unit
(B.
t.
1055 watt-seconds
778 foot-pounds
000293 kw. hour
.000393 h. p. hour
u.) equals
3065
ft. lb.
.0015 h. p. hour.
One
B.
t.
u.
.^52 calorie.
is
B.
foot-pound
t.
u.
778 foot-pounds
==r:
B.
t.
u.
7 o
to that
required
to
raise
of its
=
=
48
77
MACHINERY
342
Total Heat of
Then
temperature of steam
= 1082
.305 times
Latent Heat of Steam (L) is the quantity of heat required to transform one pound of water into steam at a given pressure, together
with an amount of heat required to produce the external work
of the water.
external heat
Then L
1114
.7
times
t,
where
heat.
Efficiency of the
Steam
an engine
in
is
Type
of
i.
h. p. in
Engine
KINDS OF STEAM
343
Marine Engines.)
steam of the temperature
due to
pressure not superheated.
is
its
Superheated steam
of the
same
V
pressure.
.5962
is
T - V
(1
.0014 p)
wKere p
_
.0833)
square inch,
The table on page 344 from Peabody's Steam Tables gives the
mean specific heat of superheated steam from the temperature of
saturation to various temperatures at several, pressures.
Thus the mean specific heat of steam at 142.2 lb. pressure
superheated to 572 F.
pound
of
steam from
when
The heat
.53.
rated steam.
Wet steam
is
344
Kilograms
MACHINERY
Continued
Abs.
Pressure
Concluded
COAL CONSUMPTION
349
150
260 difference
857
lbs.
t.
To
i
u.
8960.
Hence pounds
convert 8.03
lb. of
of
S. gallons
divide
of
steam evaporated
water into U.
lb.
boiler)
=-
1117.
by
8.33, as
14,000
8.03.
one U.
S. gallon
Thus |^ =
o oo
.96 gallon
to
One Pound
Evaporate
or
One Gallon
T = steam
Then
The steam pressure in a Scotch boiler is 160 lb. and the temperaThe feed water temperature is 140. Find the units of heat required
to evaporate one pound of water into steam, and the number of pounds of water
evaporated by one pound of coal.
Units of heat required per pound of coal = 1115 4- .3 (370 140) = 1086.
Assume that one pound of coal gives out 9,000 units of heat (B. t. u.)
Example.
ture 370.
Then
9000
8.28
lb. of
coal.
C = pounds
H = h. p.
C X H = pounds
= ^ nS ^
Let
of coal per
i.
of coal per
hour
h. p. per
hour
i.
224n
Then tons
of coal per
day
J
coa * P er nour
of 24 hours
24
^
2240
J.
W. M.
- C
*5
93.3
Sothern,
MACHINERY
350
As a quick estimate
it
may
How many
Example.
making a 7-day
being of 2,400
i.
trip,
h.
'
=7 X
45.77
24
XC X
- 320
//
""
9240
1.78
2400
~'
28(1
^5.77 tons
tons
=32
Margin 10%
The
is
In genof fuel consumed per square foot of grate surface per hour.
eral practice the rate for natural draft for anthracite coal is from
7 to 16 lb., for bituminous from 10 to 25 lb., and with artificial
or forced draft as
rate
may
lb.
be said to vary approximately as the horse power developed. The horse power varies
as the cube (within certain limits) of the speed, hence it follows
that the fuel consumption will vary approximately as the cube of
Fuel (Coal or Oil) Consumption*
the speed.
Let
may
rru
Then c
XC and
s*
A s
at speed
at speed s
*
= a/ c X~ S
Example. A steamer consumes 100 tons of coal per day a^ a speed of 10 knots.
should be her speed if the coal consumption were cut down to 50 tons a day.
What
tt
1L
*
,
Using the formula s
X 103 =
VoTS*
= A//50 r^rr
= A/
p;
7.9 knots
pound
From
of coal
by the
Mariner's Handbook.
is
combustible.
351
The average
4 barrels of
3JH2 to
occasionally
it is
only
5%.
B.
Coal
Anthracite, Pennsylvania,
of 21 samples ....
average
Bituminous, Pennsylvania
of 28 samples
Pocahontas (West Virginia
average
From
Volatile
Carbon
Matter
per
B. t. u.
per
Pound
of
Combustible
Coal
of
5.62%
14113
12685
17%
65%
34.04%
18.30%
14948
15682
13634
14419
C, //,
14600
O and S
its
Chemical Analysis.
62000 ( H
4.39%,
Then
B.
t.
O =
u.
per
4000
3.94%,
lb.
.006
~ +
J
t.
u.
per
S
by weight
of
S = 0.62%.
14600
B.
4000
u.
84.25%
51
73
of coal
Where
t.
Pound
Oil Fuel.
Calorific
pound
Fixed
.854 4- 62000
(.0439- -^jp*)
14910.
Anthracite coal
MACHINERY
352
Chestnut
over
Pea
over
Buckwheat over
mesh
mesh
mesh
mesh
6-inch
3^-inch
2-inch
IJ^-inch
3-inch
2-inch
1 34-inch
%-inch
3 -inch
2-inch
134-inch
Mine Run.
Heat Values
is
8,500 B.
and
t.
u.
of
Wood.
The
Lump and
B.
t.
u.
40%
moisture 4,600.
One Cord Air Dried Hickory or Hard Maple weighs about 4,500
lb. and is equal to about 2,000 lb. coal.
One Cord Air Dried White Oak weighs about 3,850 lb., and is
for
lb.,
and
is
lb.,
and
is
2,000
lb. coal.
lb.,
and
is
same weight of
a pound of hickory
of the
different
is,
is
OIL
The
Temperature
will
353
Fire.
fire:
Temp.
Appearance
just visible
dull
cherry dull
Red,
Red,
Red,
Red,
Red,
full
Temp.
Appearance
997
1290
1470
1650
1830
cherry
cherry clear,
.
F.
Orange, deep
Orange, clear
White heat
1830
2156
2010
2550
2910
White bright
White dazzling
.
F.
Air per
Cubic Feet
Coke
Coal (anthracite)
Coal (bituminous)
Charcoal
Lignite
Peat, dry
Cubic Meter
162.06
144.60
143.40
133.90
112.43
92.36
73.36
172.86
11.56
Wood, dry
Petroleum
Producer gas
10.09
9.01
8.93
8.53
7.02
5.75
4.57
10.76
.72
OIL
Crude petroleum as it comes from the well varies in physical
and chemical properties in different districts and countries and at
different depths in the same district.
It is nearly always lighter
than water. The diagram below shows how by refinement the
various
oils
are obtained.
Crude Petroleum
Products of Distillation
Benzine
(Commercial)
Spirit
Lamp
Oils
Residua
Heavy Petroleum
(Olefiant
Gas
Gasoline
(Motor
Oils
Oils)
Oils)
Lubricating Oils
Paraffin
Asphaltum
Pitch
354
MACHINERY
OIL BARRELS
355
To
Oil barrels are usually 21 ins. in diameter at the top and bottom,
24 at the middle, 35 ins. high, and contain approximately 51 gallons.
weight of a gallon of oil
Weight of a barrel of oil = 51 gallons
which at 30 Beaume
7.29
is
lb.
lb.
(see table)
making a
total of
=
443
373
lb.
lb.
plus the
by
To
1.2.
Heavy
25
of
temperature,
perature'
is
above
corrections being
60, subtract,
and
made
1%
to 60 F.
for every
If
tem-
below, add.
if
an oil is specified in degrees Beaume at a temperature of 60 F. For indicating the density an instrument called
a hydrometer (having an arbitrary scale the readings of which are
The density
in
degrees)
value
of
is
is
Specific gravity
an equal volume
is
of
and below
Beaume
is
Specific gravity
Example.
scale.
Find
An
oil
130
degrees
-f-
Beaume
its specific
gravity.
Specific gravity
140
22
13Q
.
-922
on the Beaume"
MACHINERY
356
Specific
Oil
Vegetable oils
Mineral lubricating
Gravity
91 .94
oils
.90 .93
79 .82
73 .75
66 .69
Petroleum
.87
Benzine
Gasoline
58
57
54
.50
46
42
The
fire
point
is
about 50 above
The
an example of a non-viscous
and 212
if it is
suitable for
any
Gasoline
oil.
show
F.
oil,
neither does
it
particular service.
is
should not be too heavy to be easily vaporized by a jet of steam or to cause trouble in cold weather, and
not so light and volatile as to be flashy.
suitable for boilers.
It
With
of
FUEL OILS
357
one horse power will be developed with 2.3 lb. of oil. The heat
value of mineral oils and their products may be closely determined
from their Beaume gravity by the formula: B. t. u. per lb. =
18650 + 40 (Beaume gravity - 10).
MACHINERY
358
A
is
practical test
in observing:
1.
The
2.
3.
The
distilling
temperatures.
final boiling point.
(in
England
called petrol
ations.
is
(1)
the
oil
(4) it
quality
is
oil
that
is
best suited
359
and heavy exhaust smoke usually indicates that the oil is too light.
The consumption of a light oil is much greater than a heavy. Under
ordinary conditions the oil used for the bearings and for the cylinl
/2 gallons per 1,000 i. h. p. in 24 hours.
The viscosity of an oil may be increased by a thickener as oleate
of alumina, but although a thickener brings up the viscosity it does
when a particular
an
oil is
at which they
readily.
Kind
of Oil
and Use
MACHINERY
360
The most
remain
surfaces
fine
and the
mineral
and lard
oil
oils
are
first,
sperm
own
oil
second, neatsfoot
oil
third,
fourth.
Consequently the finest mineral oils are best for light bearings
and high velocities.
The best animal oil to give body to fine mineral oils is sperm
oil.
oil
may
replace sperm
oil
when
greater
is
tenacity
required.
The best mineral oils should have the following properties:
at 60 F.
Evaporating
Temperature
Degrees F.
Temperature
Degrees F.
.893
.880
550
443
680
518
.871
424
505
Specific
Where Used
Gravity
Steam cylinders
Heavy machinery
Flashing
Mineral oils alone are not suited for the heaviest machinery on
account of want of body and high degree of inflammability.
Olive oil is foremost among vegetable oils as it can be purified
without the use of mineral acids. The other vegetable oils admissible but far inferior, stated in their order of merit, are gingelly,
groundnut, colza and cotton seed oils.
No oil is admissible which has been purified by means of mineral
acids.
high flash oil is carried the fuel pumps for pumping the oil into
the settling tanks and boilers are usually placed in the stokehold.
When low flash, a special pump room is built in the boiler space abaft
the cofferdam. This pump room is a watertight compartment, is
tested by being filled with water to the top, and has no direct
361
MACHINERY
362
which oil circulates all the time through the heater and burner pipes and back
to the pump suction, is often preferable for marine installations
to the dead end system in which the oil simply goes to the burners.
The piping must be carefully erected, with no rubber gaskets or
of piping to the oil burners, in
packings.
For the U. S. Naval Service the
oil
piping
is
seamless drawn
News
Below are
lines
100
ft.
and Kermode
of air
The
and
oil
oil.
combustion
with the
oil,
is
BOILERS
the
oil
along a
number
363
of flutes or passages
out retarding
velocity impinging
its
orifice in
New
In the
York.
Kermode system
oil is
(1)
this
the
type
is
it
heated and
is
filtered.
The use
of
com-
BOILERS
boilers, one where the fire goes through
tube
boiler) and the other where the water does
(fire
(water tube boiler). Of the former the most common is the Scotch
Their usual proportions are as follows:
boiler shown in Fig. 53.
the tubes
Volume
of
ft.
grate surface.
Steam volume
.3
to
.4 cu. ft.
Coal burned 15 to 35
per
i.
h. p.
MACHINERY
364
Scotch Boilers
Diameter,
mean
16' 4"
Working pressure, lb
Rules on which designed
Number
of furnaces
Number
of tubes
Diameter of tubes
Length of tubes
Surface of tubes, sq. ft
Total heating surface, sq.
Grate area, sq. ft
Thickness of shell, ins
.
Diameter
ft
of shell rivets
%
ft
^ ^
&3*
<J
<:
x \ x
T)
&
^
X
-%
is
*
*
1
J;
<C
I*
fr
Si
V i
s?
<$
v*
o
o
>
ooo
ooooooo
ooooocx>ooo
ooooooooooo
oo ooooooo oo
ooooooooooo
ooooooooooo
ooooooooooo
ooooooooooo
ooo oooooooo
ooooooooooo
ooooooooooo
ooqooqoqoooj
QjjlXIL
/'000000000000000
OOOOOOOOOOOOOOQ
OOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOO
OOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOO
OOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOO
OOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOO
V oooooooooooopoooooo
"*
_a! a
r ~A~7J
3(5
""
~?f
366
MACHINERY
Particulars of Single
Ended Scotch
Natural Draft
Mean
Internal
Boilers
31)7
MACHINERY
368
y-^r
ft
"
uu
ii"
"
"
IDE
" "
"
nil
ji
I
"
an
'
" "
in
'
"
mi
^
Figure 55.Leg Boiler.
Prac. Marine Engineering.
From
Water-Tube
Here
The
by
Boilers.
radiation.
feed water enters the upper drum, then flows down certain
drums from which the water enters the
360
vessels.
MACHINERY
370
is
by the products
The weight
built for
about 25
is
about 16
of
mud
The
ft.
of
371
Water- tube boilers can stand forcing, are suitable for high steam
Their disadvantages are:
pressures, and can raise steam quickly.
a more rigid restriction of the feed to fresh water; the necessity
of a greater regularity of feed; greater difficulty in dealing with
leaky tubes; general sensitiveness to variation in the conditions
of use; and perhaps they are not so durable or so efficient as Scotch
boilers
Their
maximum
size
is
about
The
1,000 h. p., while Scotch have been built to about 2,000.
small
water-tube boilers. Large-tube,
above applies particularly to
Babcock and Wilcox, have many
advantages of Scotch
boilers, with the additional advantage of being able to raise steam
much quicker, which is of the greatest importance in warships.
Boiler Horse Power. The evaporation of 34.5 lb. of water per
hour from a feed water temperature of 212 F. into steam at the
same temperature is a standard commercial boiler horse power
and is considered as equivalent to the evaporation of 30 lb. of
water per hour from a feed water temperature of 100 F. into steam
at 70 lb. pressure.
For finding the approximate boiler horse power in water-tube
boilers divide the total heating surface in square feet by 10.
In
ordinary Scotch or leg boilers, multiply the area of the grate suras the
of the
Let
=
=
=
i.
h. p.
B. H. P.
Then B. H. P. =
Example.
From
h. p.
34.5
compound condensing
are
i.
and
consumed per
i.
h. p.
engine.
h. p.
lb. of
steam
MACHINERY
372
D
__
if. ti.
= i.h.p.XsXc
=
...
f.
600
X 108 =
OQ1
^ol.
another example
is
following
15
The
34A 5
34 5
Example. Find the size of boiler required for a fore and aft compound engine
with cylinders 10 and 20 ins. diameter by 14 ins. stroke, cutting off at 10K-inch
stroke, working pressure of boiler, 160 to 165 lb., piston speed, 600 ft. per minute.
First determine the probable indicated horse power of the engine.
formula for mean effective pressure (MEP) (theoretical) is:
'
Sf-eom
fio
Sv/>er6eofer
from
^>1
'
'
'" "
Figure 57.
^ * * V
The
general
FACTOR OF EVAPORATION
MEP
px
where
+ log. en) pi
(1
pi
boiler pressure
n = number
*
=
Pi
if
pi
then
The
of expansions
back pressure
160
lb.
10
n "
in. (boiler
per sq.
10
5X5Xr
14
"
X10.5
pi
MEP
160
X r4=
o.o6
160
Xj^d
80.2
and
373
pressure)
5 33
lb.
(1
log. 5.33)
+1.6734)- 4
76.2
lb.
ratio of theoretical
pressure
is
about
i.h.p.
MEP X
piston speed
mean
effective
33,000
41.9
600
X314^ ^
23g
33,000
for this
and at 212
lb.
6,000
Boiler horse
per
-=
6,000
reasonable
lb.
per hour
is
857
6,000
1 150
power
1,196
6000
25
is
is
give
hour
'
6,200
lb.
approximately
180.
34.5
sq.
ft.,
lb. of
and allowing 35
857
is -rr-
sq. ft. of
24.5 sq.
heating surface
ft.
Therefore,
a Scotch boiler for the given conditions should have about 860 sq.
ft. of heating surface and 24.5 sq. ft. of grate area.
If forced draft
is used it is probable that the horse power per square foot of grate
area would be about 15, which would give a much smaller boiler.
In designing large boiler plants it is generally considered sufficient to provide boiler horse
horse power of the engine.
MACHINERY
374
and
heat in one pound of the feed water above 32, by the latent heat
steam at 212 which is 970.4 B. t. u.
of
Then the
factor of evaporation
'
177
lb. of feed water per hour multiplied by 1 177 = 5,885 lb. of water which
would have been evaporated into steam with the same heat used to evaporate
5,000 lb. from 77 into steam at 91.3 lb. if the feed water temperature had been
212 and the boiler pressure
lb.
The equivalent evaporation from and at 212 is
divided
5
lb.
and
34
5,885 lb.,
by
gives 170 6 as the b. h. p. (From Oil Fuel).
5,000
bustion of the
fuel.
This
boiler,
is
amount
and temperature
of feed water.
Example. In a boiler, 864 lb. of coal were burned per hour, the feed water
entering the boiler 8,350 lb. per hour, temperature of feed water 100 F., and the
steam was blown into the atmosphere at 275 lb. per square inch. Find the efficiency
of the boiler.
The
'
The following is another example. Find the efficiency of a boiler when the
evaporation from and at 212 is 7 lb. of water per 1 lb. of coal containing 12,000
B. t. u. per pound.
7 X 970.4 (latent heat of steam) = 6,793 B. t. u. imparted to the water per
one pound of coal.
JL
Then 6,793
_J
56 or
enm
56%
efficiency.
58%
70%
80%
63 to
68 to
BOILER WEIGHTS
375
68%
24
2
6
in ashes
100%
Total
feed water,
viz.,
MACHINERY
376
Fitting
Drain cock
On
top
STOP VALVE
Figure 58.
377
Stop Valve.
This
valve
is
from the
boiler
main steam .line to the engines, and thus controls the supply
In warships and often in merchant ships
of steam from the boiler.
the stop-valve is a non-return valve, and is self-closing, for should
the boiler be ruptured, the valve by closing would stop a sudden
rush of steam from the other boilers.
Feed Water Connections for a Scotch Boiler. Feed water heaters
are installed in all first class vessels, and the feed water enters
to the
The customary
practice
is
to discharge
MACHINERY
378
the water above the tubes just below the water level in the boiler,
through two or more branches led over the tubes with the ends closed
and the
hammer
also air
hammer
it
all
through the feed pipe, and at the boiler passes through the feed
check valve, which is a screw-down, non-return valve, and enters
the internal feed pipe (see above). A stop valve is always placed
between the check valve and the boiler, so if necessary for examination or repair the check valve may be shut off from communiIn water tube boilers the feed water enters
cation with the boiler.
drum.
the upper
Surface and Bottom Blows. Cocks or valves and connecting
pipes leading overboard are fitted for blowing the grease scum and
mud sediment out of the boiler. The cross-sectional area of the
bottom blow may be so proportioned as to give one square inch
for every 5 tons of water contained in the boiler, with a larger
area for small boilers. The area for the surface blow is the same as
boiler
Steam Gauges.
boiler, or rather
Steam does not enter the gauge nor does it come in contact
with any of the working parts. The tube from the boiler is bent
in a loop or U, which serves as a trap for the water condensed
beyond this point. Thus the Bourdon tube and part of the connecting pipe are kept filled with water, which in turn is acted on
tube.
FUSIBLE PLUGS
by the steam, and the pressure
is
379
is
shown by
a vertical glass tube, the upper end being connected to the steam
space and the lower to the water. The glass should be adjusted
so that when the water is at the bottom, the water in the boiler is
Besides
still 3 or 4 ins. above the level of the highest heating surface.
the gauge glass, small cocks are provided which, on opening, indicate the water level in the boiler.
To
as heat
The
is
Eckliff circulator
formed and
of
It consists of specially
quite different.
constructed tubes bent to conform to the curved surfaces
the furnaces.
is
except for one foot at each end, where the tube is bent upward at
an angle which causes the water to discharge directly against the
tube sheet just above the furnace. The playing of the water against
the plates prevents the cracking of the furnace flange or the combustion chamber plate at the point where the two are riveted
together.
MACHINERY
380
TO BOILER
IMTT* SUPPLY*
Figure 59.
An
work
and a small
The
An
the boiler.
will
lift, it
of
lb.
maximum
lb. of
injector in
power
is
With
and a moderate
lift,
HYDROMETER
Hydrometer.
The
381
by an
kngtrument known
part in 32 of solid matter, and hydrometers are usually graduated relative to this as a unit. That is, 2 on the scale indicates
om
twice as
much
much and
solid
so on; while
3,
three times
The
density of
the water depends on its temperature so that the scale on the hyIrometer can only be used with the temperature that it is graded
as
which
is
be
main
boilers;
(2)
The above
first.
may be
and to receive heat from gases flowing through tubes which pass
through the steam chamber.
An example of Class 2 as applied to a Babcock and Wilcox watertube boiler is shown in Fig. 57. Here the superheater is placed
in a box that is arranged to form a continuation of the first and
second passes of the gases of combustion as they pass around the
tubes of the boiler. In order that the steam as it passes through the
superheater may be thoroughly exposed to the hot gases, removable
ha lies or division plates are put in the headers of the superheater,
two in the upper header at one-quarter of the length from each end
and one in the lower header at mid-length. The result of this
I
is
MACHINERY
382
Figure 60.
Foster Superheater.
60
is
TESTS OF STEAMERS
383
Of Class 3
is
when applied
to Scotch boilers
and located
in the
leading in
in
Name
of
Steamer
J.C. Wallace....
U.
S. S.
U.
S. S. Carolina
Michigan
Engine
I.h.p.
Quad-
1,589
Draft
Induced
Economy
in
Per
Per cent
I.h.p.
6.7
Superheat in
Degrees
F.
88
1.646
Type
of
Boiler
Babcock Babcock
& Wilcox
Port Lincoln*
Port Augusta.
Dryden
Move
Ferrona\
*
f
...
Wilcox
16,016
Forced
1.51
85.7
Babcock Babcock
Triple
17,651
Forced
1.395
47.5
Babcock Babcock
Triple
900
Natural
Quad.
4,027
2,005
2,600
1,600
1,925
1.303
1.29
1.454
1.322
1.10
1.20
&
Odin
Superheater
ruple exp
Triple
<fc
.
of
Type
Triple
Triple
Triple
Triple
lb.,
Howden
Howden 12.8-15
Natural
16.5
Howden
Natural
lb.,
2ii
200"
Wilcox
Wilcox
Scotch
Scotch
Scotch
Scotch
Scotch
Scotch
<fe
&
Wilcox
&
Wilcox
Schmidt
Schmidt
Schmidt
Schmidt
Schmidt
Schmidt
Babcock
& Wilcox
Co.
MACHINERY
384
Feed Pumps,
see
Pumps.
the side of the vessel above the water line. To the hopper is a
water connection from a pump, and by turning on the water the
ashes are discharged overboard. The gallons of water required
to operate ash ejectors are about as follows:
Size of discharge pipe
Inches
4H
6
Figure 61.
Ash Ejector.
OPERATING
385
only into the discharge pipe when the ejector is in operation and
closes automatically when the discharge is stopped.
Instead of the above, on large steamers the ashes are raised in
When
uniform as possible.
boiler through an opening and a fitting which are entirely independent of the fitting and opening for the main feed."
Should any difficulty be experienced in feeding a boiler, the
combustion should be checked at once by closing the dampers and,
Should the water get below the lowest
if necessary, ash pit doors.
try cock and out of sight, the fires should be extinguished and then
hauled.
Always deaden
ing on wet ashes.
before hauling, which can be done by throwFire extinguishers should be handy, which could
fires
The
intervals
MACHINERY
386
be cleaned one after another, with a regular interval of time between. It is bad practice to clean several fires at practically the
same
time.
no longer required,
fires
in the furnaces,
When
first
be resorted
to.
the boiler
When
is
lime and introduced through the manholes into the upper and lower
parts of the boiler. The boiler must then be closed airtight and
special precautions taken to prevent
interior.
Clean
fireside
fling,
and
and overhaul
all
furnace
fittings,
brickwork, baf-
fire parts.
Empty, open, and wash out the water spaces with fire hose.
Clean and inspect the water side and overhaul zincs (if installed)
and internal fittings.
Rinse out with fresh water and close the boiler.
Overhaul all valves, gauges, cocks, and other fittings.
Examine and repair all parts of the lagging, casing, and seating.
Apply hydrostatic
CLEANING TUBES
387
valves.
and
Close
casings.
all
is
pure.
Owing
light.
Washing Out
at least 50 lb.
Boilers.
Use
is,
Cleaning Tubes.
left in
Clean
40
lb.
Catechu
lb.
lb.
Sal
ammoniac
MACHINERY
388
boiling
tinued.
scale
is still
Trouble
Incrustation
Sediment, mud, clay, etc.
Incrustation
Readily soluble salts
Bicarbonates of lime, mag.
Incrustation
nesia, iron
Remedy
or Palliation
Blowing
off
Heating feed.
Addition
Incrustation
Sulphate of lime
magnesia, etc.
Addition of carbonate of
soda,
barium
chloride,
etc.
and sulphate
manganesium
Chloride
of
Corrosion
Addition of carbonate of
soda, etc.
Priming
Addition
of
chloride, etc.
barium
Corrosion
oxygen
Heating feed.
Addition
Grease
(from
steam)
condensed
Corrosion
Corrosion
U.
and filter
DRAFT
caused by the difference of weight in the heated
To obtain
air of the uptake and the cold air entering the furnace.
a good draft the funnel and uptake temperatures must be between
600 and 700 F., this temperature being necessary to bring about
Natural draft
is
air.
DRAFT
Heat Absorbed
389
about
.23,
The
specific
heat
raise
one
pound
is
by the generation
of natural draft.
Cold air temperature 62, uptake temperature 700 F., and allowing
per pound of coal: calculate the heat units per pound of coal used in
producing the draft.
;
700 G2 = 638 increase of air temperature
B. t. u. required = 638 X (24 4- 1) X .23 - 3,668.5
1 lb. of coal = 25 lb. of gases in
The quantity (24 +1) =24 lb. of air
Example.
24
lb. of air
Thus 25%
pound
up
known type
them
of this
of
combustion
reach the fan at 550 F., a capacity of 9.33 cu. ft. of gases per
minute per pound of coal burned per hour should be allowed, this
MACHINERY
390
may
Velocity Created
Pressure in
Inches
Water
Gauge
When
BLOWERS
391
The
actual
amount
of air passing
is
usually
less
of air
weighs
1 lb.) this
from 225 (18 times 12.5 cu. ft.) to 250 cu. ft. See
table Quantity of Air Required for Combustion of Fuel.
Blowers. There are a number of types on the market having a
pound
of coal
driven
by
and mounted
electric motors,
at 250 to 700
r.
p. m., or
are
by steam
Figure
On
The blowers
turbines.
See Ventilation.
62.Fan Rotor.
all
is
parts be
to run
is
air pressure
MACHINERY
392
to be maintained.
The engines
require a periodical adjustment of the working parts, and they should be tried at least once
a month if the vessel does not ordinarily run on forced draft. Care
that
is
must be taken that the doors of the casings, oil service, etc., are
absolutely dust tight, and that no dust or dirt can get on the
bearings.
When two
same
may
Cubic
Hyde
Park, Mass.)
393
will
hour."
Miscellaneous Notes
The
size of coal
is
as the
30%
One square
consume on an average 12
lb.
of coal
Temperatures.
Furnace temperature about
2G00 F.
Combustion chamber
Uptake
Funnel
1500 F.
750 F.
600 F.
will
fire-
compound engines
is
about 120
lb.,
180, and slightly higher for quadruple. With a main steam pipe
of ample size and the throttle valve wide open, the initial pressure
should not be much lower than 5 lb. below the boiler pressure.
The mechanical
efficiency of
an engine
is
When
their length
work done
MACHINERY
394
Cylinder Supported
By
EXPANSION
Figure 63.
395
Piston Valve.
the horse power of an engine, it is considered more economical to cut off earlier in the high-pressure cylinder than to lower
the initial pressure by throttling.
(See table of Steam Used Excut
down
Type
of
Engine
MACHINERY
396
The order
is
The
of an inch at the
usually about J4 of an inch or so at the top and
more
at
the
the
clearance
bottom to allow
always being
bottom,
for the
Figure 64.
Slide Valve.
PADDLE-WHEEL ENGINES
397
is
essential, engines
the
is
filters,
and
customary
types'.
398
MACHINERY
Figure 65.
VALVES
399
its
Figure 66.
Allan's Valve.
MACHINERY
400
steam on the outside the steam is led to the chest at one end only,
and then passes to the other end through the inside of the valve.
In such cases the body of the valve is hollow, and as large as possible.
Fig.
of
ports.
cured.
selected
when
it is
Valve
Cylinder
High
pressure
Size of Port
Openings
Low
Double-ported
pressure
Intermediate
pressure
slide
valve
VALVE TRAVEL
Figure 67.
In Fig. 67,
In Fig. 68,
AB
steam lap
CD
exhaust lap
AB
steam lead
CD
exhaust lead
=
=
Valve Travel.
The
401
Lap.
Expansion
MACHINERY
402
Expansion
Valve
Travel
SLIDE VALVES
403
on the engine shaft, so that by varying the position of the link the
valve stem may be put in direct connection with either eccentric
or may be given a movement controlled partly by one eccentric
and partly by the other. When the link is moved by suitable levers
into a position such that the block to which the valve stem is attached is at either end of the link, the valve receives its maximum
travel and when the link is in mid-position the travel is the least
and the cut-off takes place early in the stroke.
The expression "open and crossed eccentric rods" is understood to mean the position of the eccentric rods when the crank
is on the bottom center, as in running the rods open and cross each
other alternately. For slide valves or outside steam piston valves
the rods are usually arranged as open, but with inside steam piston
valves the rods are fitted so that they are crossed when the crank
is on the bottom center.
This is to obtain the full benefit of link
expansion, for if the rods were arranged the reverse way the lead
would be diminished when linked up, and the range of expansion
more limited.
Effects of
MACHINERY
404
engines are supplied with steel laths marked with the setting of the
valves and these are used to verify the position of the valves.
To measure
valve
is
set
opening as far as
it
To Find
Stroke.
the
Steam Pressure
Boyle's
P =
V =
Let
C =
Then
lb.
PXV
= C)P
=y,V
is
185
of the
stroke.
P =
185
15 (atmospheric pressure)
200 X .6 = 120 lb.
C = P X V =
Then the absolute
pressure Pi
105
lb.
200
120
C =
=
=
V'i
pheric pressure)
gauge pressure.
lb.
120
lb.,
and 120
15
lb.
(atmos-
STEAM CONSUMPTION
Table of Steam Used Expansively
Initial
Pressure
405
MACHINERY
406
may
be approximated as
Example.
cut-off
6.
RS
AB
The
BC
as
line
is
shown by CD.
For the return or upstroke,
the beginning,
the point of
exhaust closure or beginning of compression above the piston, ancj
F the point of steam opening just before the beginning of the next
is
downstroke.
CD is the exhaust line and shows the nearly constant pressure
during the exhaust period. EF, the compression line, shows the
increasing pressure on the return stroke after the closing of the exhaust valve. FA, the admission line, shows the sharp jump upward
as the steam valve is opened, just before the beginning of the next
downstroke.
The
is
is
PQ
is
sents the pressure of the atmosphere, viz., 14.7 lb. per square inch.
Thus for the downstroke the varying pressures on the top of the
piston are
*
From
RS
to
ABCD,
DIFFERENT CARDS
407
/c/ea/ Care/
Figure 69.
Indicator Cards.
while for the upstroke the pressures on the same side of the piston
are shown by the distance from RS to DEFA.
MACHINERY
408
Results.
and
closure early.
i.
e.,
Cut-off too late, steam lead small or negative, compression small, steam opening late, exhaust opening and closure
late.
Whole cycle of events behind time.
Results.
(3)
Steam
Results.
small.
Results.
opening early.
The pressure in the cylinder may
(7) Excessive compression.
be carried above that in the valve chest before the steam valve
opens, thus forming a loop as in Fig. 1. This may be due to either
(1)
or
(5).
as in Fig.
7.
Leaky piston
INDICATOR CARDS
Figure 70.
Indicator Cards.
409
MACHINERY
410
Results.
Expansion
may
pression line
line will
Com-
To
Mean
Calculate the
Horse Power.
Divide
multiply
result will
Let
L =
A =
N
Then
(i.
h. p.)
oTrwk
oo,UUU
In estimating the mean effective pressure for any multiple expansion engine, it is customary to calculate the pressure that would
be required if the work were all done in the low-pressure cylinder.
This is called the mean effective pressure referred to the low pressure cylinder, and the calculation for horse power then becomes
identical with the calculation for a single-cylinder engine.
a compound engine the referred mean effective pressure is
M. E. P. (referred) = low-pressure M. E. P.
high-pressure M. E. P.
ratio low pressure to high pressure
and for a triple expansion engine
For
E. P. (referred)
E. P.
low-pressure
E. P.
intermediate pressure
.
high-pre ssure
ratio
Below
M.
E. P.
ENGINE FORMULAE
411
MACHINERY
412
D X Vp X S X R
2
This formula
stress as
bending
bending
stress,
10.2.
Lloyd's
Rules state:
Diameter
of crankshaft
and
of thrust
21
shaft (see table below); thrust shaft may be tapered down at each
end to same diameter as intermediate shaft. Diameter of screw
(tail)
shaft
to
but
+
(03P\
.63
'
FfT~
in
no case to.be
Let
A =
B =
C =
less
X
is
S =
P =
stroke of pistons
boiler pressure
above atmosphere
in
inch
of
Engine
CYLINDERS
The number
of collars
to 5 ins. diameter of
or
number
of collars
'
'
for
H
1
merchant
vessels
dia. shaft
-j
j.
To
413
D =
dia. of collar
d m dia. of shaft
N = number of collars
P = allowable pressure
~X
allowable pressure
N(D*
d*)
XP
r
*
*
V' px xN +
ThenD = f/
Thickness of collars
.4
(D-d)
For
ratio
of
diameters
see page 294.
Cylinders.
are to be steam jacketed then liners are necessary.
without a liner the following formula may be used.
the cylinders
For a cylinder
If
(P
25)
6000
When
will
D=
40
'
100
+D
is
L =
J = width
which is
Connecting Rod. Length 43^ to 5 times the length of the crank.
Diameter at upper end same as diameter of the piston rod, area of
section at lower end 1.2 to 1.3 that of the piston rod.
D = dia. at middle of rod in ins.
L = length from center to center in ins.
for merchant vessels = .028\/effective load on piston in lb.
= .022veffective load on piston in lb.
for war vessels
of jacket space,
K
K
Then
=^IZ1
MACHINERY
414
Piston
Rod
p =
a coefficient
naval engines
50
45
42
41
Another formula
5,
Dia. of cylinder
X \/v
is:
P. of one cylinder
2
rev. per min.
length of stroke
Often of cast steel dished or conical in form
Pistons.
and of a
of
thickness
metal.
The
of
single
pistons
compound and triple
should
as
a
rule
have
the
same
total depth, thus
expansion engines
giving a steep angle to the high pressure and a
latter being
not
less
than about
flat to
5.
Crank pin
Main bearings
Using
Slipper guides
Crosshead pins
Link block pin
Link block gibs
Eccentric rod pins
Thrust
collars
Maximum
Loads:
in. of
pro-
BUTTERFLY VALVES
415
is
difficult
to keep tight.
operated by hand.
Figure 71.
Throttle Valve.
[Schutte
&
Koerting, Phila.]
Of the power type, this consists of a separate power unit operated by steam and connected by links to the throttle valve which
is controlled entirely by the power unit.
The former
common
sive pressure
be discharged.
to
MACHINERY
416
a valve and pipe are provided for admitting steam direct from the
steam pipe or high-pressure valve chest to the first receiver or
intermediate valve chest. This will give sufficient load on the piston of the intermediate cylinder to start the engine. Either cocks
or small slide valves are used, that can be opened wide by a single
stroke of the lever.
Reversing Engine.
all
around type,
is,
The operating
Engine
Below
is
lever
is
LUBRICATING SYSTEM
/.
oil,
In
417
many
filtered,
engines there is
the main engine,
No
is
a film of
oil
is
quantity of graphite from time to time as the cylinders give indications of becoming dry is advisable, but when they have once
obtained a good surface there is no need of further lubrication.
Usually crank pins and eccentric straps should be oiled by hand
once every 20 minutes; main bearings, link gear, etc., once every
half hour.
An inspection of the thrust bearing, spring bearings,
and stern tube gland should be made every half hour, and the piston
rods swabbed perhaps every 45 minutes.
For a
triple
equipment was
specified:
"A
i.
18,
29 and 47
ins.
each cylinder provided with wicks and brass tubes leading to prinCrank pins to be oiled by cups and tubes carried on
cipal journals.
Cross head
connecting rods and taking oil from drip overhead.
manifolds.
Each
from
eccentric
tubes
oiled
guides
leading
by
strap
to be oiled by cup and tube carried on the eccentric rod.
Reverse
A swab
shaft bearings to be fitted with compression grease cups.
cup shall be fitted to each housing for swabbing the piston rods
All fixed bearings shall have drip cups.
All
parts shall have drip cups made of sheet brass, cast brass,
moving
* Abstracts
from Care
of
Naval Machinery.
H. C. Dinger.
MACHINERY
418
"Two %-inch
"One
joints.
"Two %-inch
"Each
these branches.
"There
Bearing. Directly
the sanitary
pump
circulating in the
thrust
i.
bottom
h. p.
of the bearing.
217
t~.
hour
The
'
ot>
OPERATING
419
are smooth.
about 8
is
lb.
Operating *
"About an hour before the time set for getting under way, start
to warm up the engine.
The length of time depends on the size
of the engine, for large engines more than an hour may be required
and for small less.
"See that all tools, material, etc., are clear of the engine.
"Start circulating pump, making sure that the injection and
discharge valves are open.
"See that all parts of the engine are in place and properly secured.
Disconnect jacking gear.
if
valves to con-
From Care
of
little
Naval Machinery.
H. C. Dinger.
MACHINERY
420
"Make an
"The
following causes
may
satisfactorily:
"Water
in Cylinders.
full travel.
and moving the piston back and forth by the reversing gear
the water
is
until
out.
"Engine on Center.
is
oil,
should be worked up to
The
full
power gradually.
under
throttle
should
first
ordinary conditions.
"On
TRIALS
"Pounding may be caused by:
(1)
421
Too much
clearance in a
down
"
Use heavier
oil.
Trials
Noronic, passenger steamer, 362
molded o2
ft.,
depth molded 28
4 boilers each 15
ft.
ins.
ft.
ft.
ins.,
engine
diameter by 11
ft.
long.
Displacement
tons
5,412
776 .5
21,800.
Draft, forward
Draft, aft
Draft, mean
Speed, miles per hour, average
Slip of propeller
Steam pressure
First receiver pressure
Second receiver pressure
sq. ft
sq. ft.
11 ft. 3
18 ft. 1
14 ft. 8
17 43
ins.
in.
ins.
11.6%
Vacuum
192
73
15.5
23 93
106
1,169.6
.
lb.
lb.
lb.
ins.
inder
.
1,505.7
Indicated horse power, low-pressure cylinder aft.
711.5
Indicated horse power, low-pressure cylinder forward
771 .2
Total indicated horse power
4,158.
Mean effective pressure referred to low-pressure
.
34.2
13.5
cylinder
I.
h. p.
of grate
per sq.
of heating surface per i. h.
Temperature of injection water
Temperature of hotwell
Temperature of feed from heater
Draft ins. of water at fans
Trial lasted 6 hours.
Sq.
ft.
ft.
3. 16
40
110
200
3 73
ft.
lb.
all,
Built 1914.
on keel 416
ft.,
MACHINERY
422
,,jj o 9n
k
nrn
beam 56
ft., molded depth 30
Scotch boilers each 14
Trial draft 18
ft.
ft.
r,
ft.,
engine
19^X28^X41X60
9 ins. diameter by 12
ft. 6 ins.
ft.
two
long.
aft,
208
Vacuum
R. p.
Piston speed,
Mean
Mean
Mean
ft.
per min
lb.
lb.
37 5
9.1
21 2
84.9
594 3
81.7
36
.
lb.
ins.
lb.
inder
Mean
Mean
86.
14 97
10 38
.
34
cylinder
Indicated horse
Indicated horse
Indicated horse
Indicated horse
Total indicated
440.
406.
lb.
lb.
Co.,
Wyandotte, Mich.
Built 1914.
Torpedo Boat Destroyer Cushing, 300 ft. between perpendiculars, 31 ft. 1 in. beam, 17 ft. 1 in. molded depth, twin-screw
Curtis turbines, 4 oil-burning Yarrow boilers, closed fireroom,
U.
S.
forced draft.
Displacement
Draft
Speed
Main
tons
5 ins.
29. 183 knots
1,048
ft.
CATTLE STEAMER
heating surface, 15.61
lb.
423
lb.
oil.
s.
h. p.
hi
h.
I.
4-
2,600
R. p.
53.7
Steam pressure
Steam first receiver
183
67 5
Vacuum
Speed
I. h. p. per 100 sq. ft. wetted surface at 10 knots.
Coal burned per hour
Coal per i. h. p. main engine per hour
Coal per sq. ft. grate per hour
lb.
lb.
24
ins.
11.4 knots
4.87
lb.
4,390
1
68
17. 1
lb.
lb.
ins.,
I.
h.
engine
is
23^ X 38^ X
67
jr
R. p.
Speed
ft.
1,795
75
10.78 knots
Vacuum
27
ins.
1.3
162 5
496
.
ins.
lb.
Vacuum
Pounds
B.
t.
u.
power hour
per horse power hour
of oil per horse
28
ins.
.
16,420.
875
MACHINERY
424
City of St. Louis, passenger and freight, 397 ft. between perpendiculars, 49 ft. 6 ins. beam, gross tonnage, 6,200, engine
1'4 Scotch boilers, steam allowed 180
is
48
r.
p. m.,
steam 130
lb.,
i.
h. p.
15,276
4 12
12.5
16 82 tons
.
Propeller thrust
At 80
At 61.8
lb.
p. m.,
ins., revs, of
engine 67.3,
i.
h. p. 1,386.51.
New
trip
from Norfolk
York.
Definitions.* A
PROPELLERS
propeller
is
right- or left-handed
as
it
turns
with or against the hands of a watch when looked at when standing aft and the ship is being driven forward.
The face or driving face of a blade is at the rear. It is the
face that acts on the water and so receives* the forward thrust.
The back of a blade is the forward side.
Leading and following edges of a blade are the forward and
after edges respectively
The
The diameter
is
by the
tips of
the blades.
is
For high speed vessels the blades are elliptical in shape, with the
For towing the
greatest breadth 'about one third from the tip.
blades are very broad at the tips.
* Abstracts from Practical Marine
Engineering.
PROJECTED AREA
The developed area
425
is
the actual
Disk area
The area
panded
Let
R =
D =
is
S =
C =
The
Below
coefficient of .30
= C
10,000
4/
In the table on page 426 the calculated D A R (disk area ratio) was
calculated with a coefficient of .30, and it will be noted that the
results obtained are very close to the actual disk area.
Number
Blades.
merchant.
wheel are the same,
number
Three
of
it
will
take 25 to
for the
same
Two
caused by them.
This
is
falls off in
The
screw.
apparent
slip
is
^-
J3
eu cu
cu
cu
cu
cu
cu
cu
cu cu
>-i
**
P C
.S.H.a
OOpppppppppppg^
PPcucjoooooooooS
s-a
oooooooooo o.p
rD r^
p p p a a p a g a 2 p p p p
2 13 ^ -P
-g
l^
(_
l_
(~<
ft
Uc
(-
ft ft
t-,
>-,
t-,
>-
|k,
ft ft ft ft
ft,
o o o
58
g g ,ft,ft
ft,
t- p p p p p
O o'o'u'u'S'o'o'u'3'o'o'o C3
+3 p.
+3
p p -M
p OOCUCUCUJUCUCUCUCUCUCUCUbC
I- k k k h 1h
ti k (h
te ~ " te* & te~ te fe fe~ te" te" te fiT > bT t* te" fe i* t> >
o
o o o o ^
o o o o 8
co cc co as co
OaococncoaQ. cowgooocqcooqcoo
OOOOOOMCOCO
H
(-1
-l
>-l
p p
3 p p p p P P43
p^+5+S^+S-S
P
*-,
j_
t-
-J -J
-t-3
-t-J
"2 PPPPPPPPPC C -= ~ ~
US .9
ft.p.P.p.p.ti.P.P.P.P.P.P
w
3'
ft_ft.P
'C 'C 'C 'E 'C > "P*C p:p?pt^pt&:pt^^^^PPP
VC $ c ft'u^E'E.S .P_ft
HHEHHHH HhhHHHh
T3 "O T3 T3 T3 -g
ccS
c3 c3
cc?
c*3
p p p p
i~
-l-i -t-3
<u
cu
cu
cu
fl
>_
h-'TT*
ft ft
CU
CU
t>c
he
"^S
ft
CD
bij.P
p^
NiOiOOS^NNCSOOCSOOJNOOiOINWiHN^N
II
"
MMCOCOiOOiOSQOOOQONiHQCtOiOTHa
OiniOiOWcDtOl>CD^NONNO^^NiOiOTj(QQTttT^^Tl<T(<mMWCOmMiOrOCOCOCOM
rt<cx>cx)G^i^^^ooooe^i^aoooaoioao^t>-t^i^i>3t^o
lOifliOtOUJtOlOtOcOtDtOOtOtOOtOOtOC^COiOiOrHiOiOMTti COT*
TjH'^OO-rti-rriCCrt'tOCOCOCOC'O'^*
'WJOiOONCOOO^^OCKOiOOClO^
5
OCX>CX)CX)000OOTtieOOO-*Tt*iC->!jHCOcOTt<TjlTt<OT^CX)
ft
o3
OOOHtOOMWINniONOMlNNiCININNNO^inOOCCOINOiOOiOiOKJNOlNOCNM
M00010)OiO!OiON05'05^'>nN(Oi(5iOiOiOO000>00000(N05'HOT)<iHtON'*t-0>
Let
P^ =
v
slip of
427
screw
Then
100
percentage of slip
Example. A propeller having a pitch of 15 ft. and making 100 revolutions per
minute would advance 1,500 ft. per minute without slip. If the actual speed of
ft
the ship
parent
is
The
1,215 =
is
285
rjofl
-^r-
1,215
ft.
per minute.
285
ft.
somewhat
different
The ap-
19 or 19
slip, in that the passage of the ship through the water causes
some of the water astern to follow the ship. This current of water
is called the wake, and its speed is dependent upon the shape of
water were
The
slip
= -27 or 27%.
l,oUU
difference between real and apparent slip
minute, or t-?t^
The
thus
Where Sr =
i-s
= wake
.9
.729.
a-sja-w)
slip
Therefore
Sr =
- ST =
of revolutions
(1
.19)
.27 or
10.
be expressed
real slip
$ a = apparent
may
(1
.10)
.81
27%.
to 30%, the average being about
must be run at a higher number
MACHINERY
428
Example.
minute.
The apparent
Pitch
slip is
r.
pitch
15
=
V =
=
s
To
r.
p.
in
ft.
per min.
m.
= .134
78
or about 13*^%.
Slip,
Pitch of
Where p =
(1)
6,08060X 10
78
15
Propellers.
speed
m.
p.
is,
and speed
in knots.
S
N-
= p
101.3
p
(2)
To
ry
and
slip.
pN
(1-8)
101.3
(3)
To
slip.
N
(4)
To
101.3 V
= rz
r
p (1 - s)
slip,
and revo-
lutions.
101.3
V =
(1-s)
direction.
is
At
is
From
Practical
be
r.
Then the
very nearly.
Marine Engineering.
TURBINE SHIPS
To Find the
429
Stretch
by the trapezoidal
or
by Simpson's
rule.
If
by the former and one breadth is located at the extreme tip, the
area is the sum of half the tip and hub breadths plus all the others,
multiplied by the distance radially between successive 'breadths.
The projected area may be determined from the developed area
with a reasonable amount of accuracy by either of two formulae, the
first proposed by S. Barnaby and the second by D. W. Taylor, chief
constructor, U. S. N.
Projected area
(1)
Developed area
V
Projected area
(2)
The
eter),
Pitrh
.0425
= Developed
Diameter
area
1.067
-=r:
first is
ratios
efficiency
ot vessel in feet
X33000
per minute
120
h. p., internal
What
collars.
Assume the
propeller efficiency
is
about
60% and
formula,
120
.6
20
33,000
5,280
2,376,000
1,350
lb.
which
is
1,760
60
Wheels
for
R =
V =
S. h. p.
Turbine Ships.
revolutions of the screw per minute
speed of the vessel in knots per hour
shaft horse power developed in the shaft
ered to the screw
and
deliv-
MACHINERY
430
E. T. P.
S. h. p. on one shaft
V X
Diameter of propeller
For value of
33,000
.52 or .55
101.3
\/
in feet
effective thrust in
pounds
12.
Apparent slip of propeller per cent. = .0206
Pitch.
Suppose it is required to find the pitch of a propeller to
R +
minute.
.0206
520
23
The apparent
Pitch
slip
28 22
'
5^
10L3 =
5.49
ft.,
22.7
100
23
say 5
ft.
12
Type
of Vessel
28.22 knots.
ins.
.00563
-f-
7.5
Propellers.
431
table have three
MACHINERY
432
The
areas of
are as follows:
Diameter, Ins.
all
SPEED TABLE
Dia., Ins.
Two Bb
433
GO
8
o
a
i
ja
i
.9
o
o
Ao
*
I
OTt<00
NHtDO
0 O
-tf
00
0<M
OOOMifl
CD to t^l>-
OO
CM CO
OS OO
CO
r-t
Tt<
t^ (M
t>-
iC CO
OO t CO
OCONOO
NHtfO
coco
OO CO -^ (M
t^-
OO
*<
CO
if?
H00ION
NK5M-H
OOCO-*f<M
ONiOCO
io^n-h
Nmmci
oo
**<
ONOO
8
CO
*<
<M ~H
-*
cm
N"5WN
CO CO
OOCO-<*<CM
Ot^iCM
CO CO 00 i
CM *0
COOJ
oo>
tO-fCMr-1
HO
COCMOOS
COC10>0
t-tU3(M
i-Ht
CM-<00
OOt^.
CO
-*<CO
NWCOrH
COt^-O ^
0
UStMNO
00 CO
*<
CM
lONcm
NWO-h
iOCO>-i
tCN^O)
-HO100N
"-i00
t>J'-i00
OOCOlO CO
00t
00t>-
OCO<M
niccch
oo b o co
>OM<NO
NiO
CM 0
CO CM
<M iO
t CO
OOicm
co
COO)
CO
!>
'-'b-
CM lO
tMO00
CO CM
*W5iOCD
CM
t>-t>.o
OO CO
r- CO CO
CO-l0
oo r^ co co
oo t>-
00t~
oo
C5 05
OOb- O0 b- 00 00 t
t>-
COCO'-IOO
CM
- 00
CO CM
CO
sPvPkP
SkPkOkO
SkOkOkO
S^g^
SfcS^
S^gS
C^c^
o
o
o
oo fc\fc$fc$
o 9^4^
o S^c^
oc
ICMCO
^iHCNCO giHCNCO $^ CM CO ^ CM CO ^iHNW
^iHCNW ^
-<
Cm
435
T-t
436
MACHINERY
"None"
peller.
and
the theoretical speed of the proa 20-inch diameter by 30-inch pitch wheel at 500
indicates
Thus
no
slip.
slip
is
10.61 miles
is
20% and
for 9.28 is
30%;
25%.
of the engine
and the
desired speed in miles per hour, to find the pitch of the propeller,
first estimate the percentage of slip according to the type of boat
known
r.
p.
line to the
PADDLE WHEELS
In the old type of harbor and bay steamers the wheels consisted
The
of iron frames with boards fastened transversely to them.
the
bottom
is
to
have
of
the
feathering paddles,
present practice
The breadth of each
floats being about one-third of the draft.
paddle in side wheelers is about one-third the breadth of the steamer,
while in stern wheelers the paddles are nearly the entire breadth.
Formulae for Finding Slip, Speed, Revolutions, and Pitch of
Paddle Wheels.*
Where
x =3.1416
=
V =
N =
D =
s
slip ratio
(2)
V =
(3)
DN -88 V
x
irDN
D N (1 88
V
D (1 88
*)
s)
STEAM TURBINES
(4)
Immersion
V
N (1 -
437
88
s)
than
J/g
their breadth
and
be J^.
with the diameter. With fixed radi.'i
the usual proportion is one for each foot of diameter, and ii
00
Diameter -f- 2
Number
floats
feathering,
of floats .varies
number
of floats
or
V revolutions
Breadth
Length
of float
of float
/ai
=
=
Paddle Wheels
Speed,
Knots
is
4 to 5 with fixed
MACHINERY
438
is
utilized.
vanes so that each row takes out a certain fraction of the velocity
of the jet, as, for example, if a pressure drop of 150 lb. gives a
NOZZLE
aauc<
MOVING
-^
VANES
NOZZLE
<
<
(
movTng
VANES
NOZZLES
MOVING
VANES
Pressure
MOVING
VANES
Arrangement of Vanes.
PARSONS TYPE
439
this,
or 425
ft.
per second.
same
Thus
The
Int.
readily obtained.
pressure of 150 lb.
and a condenser vacuum of 29 ins. or back pressure of say 1 lb., the steam would expand about 150 times.
Thus
more work can be got out of the steam by the increased number of
expansions, and hence the importance of having a high vacuum
in the condensers.
MACHINERY
440
NOZZLE.
<<<<<(<<
MOVING
VANES
)))))))))))
FIXED~GUI 0E VANES
nMSffl
tiitiiUiU
V
^MOVING
~Z_^ VANES
GUIDE VANES
MOVING
VANES
G. (Small),
Electra
and Terry)
Figure 73.
ft.
ARRANGEMENT OF VANES
turbines run in a
four shafts
and
vacuum.
The
turbines.
six
transatlantic liner
441
Maureiania has
shafts are
160
lb.,
lb.,
low-pressure
NOZZLES
TTT
jggxnuxnn
MOVING
VANES.
(lOT
irniT)
(an
MOVING
VANES.
MOVING
VANES.
FIXED CUIOE
VANES.
MOVING
VANES.
Pressure
(Curtis
^^^
JJJJJJJJJJJ?
MOVING VANES.
JJJJJJJJIU&
VlllliMAJAfcJX>JJJJJJJJ}
lllllllllU^F
MOVING
MOVING VANES.
Reaction (Parsons)
Figure 74.
VANES.
Arrangement of Vanes.
MACHINERY
442
i
turbine port 20
tried in
By means
vessels.
of gearing,
more
when running
at a high speed
geared turbines.
Below
is
data
first
cost
is
on a
Turbine Ships.
9 ins. beam, 21
Cargo
draft 19
vessel,
ft.
on starboard
and
on
latter
port.
to the axis.
steel,
5 ins. diameter of
Ratio of gear to
GEARED TURBINES
Propeller wheel 14
70
ft.
diameter, 16.35
ft.
443
pitch,
expanded area
sq. ft.
10 .22 knots
70 .6
140
lb.
Ill
lb.
28 4
29 .88
Speed by log
Revolutions per minute
Boiler pressure
High-pressure turbine, initial pressure
Vacuum in inches
Barometer, inches
Water consumed
in
pounds per
15 1
h. p.
s.
Steamer 370
24X40X66
45
ft.
Geared
Turbines
Mean
H.
p.
Steam
Temp,
Temp,
Temp,
Temp,
of sea water F
of discharge from condenser.
of hot well
of feed water
Vacuum in condenser
Coal consumed per 24 hours, tons.
.
i.
h. p.
hour, lb.
Water consumed
Water consumed per i. h. p. hour, lb.
Ash from coal as measured, per cent.
MACHINERY
444
and the water turbine to the propeller shaft, both being in one
casing so designed that frictional and eddy losses are reduced to
a minimum. The transmission efficiency of this transformer is
about 90%, and it has the advantage of being able to employ a
non-reversible turbine.
and
this
periodic strains.
'
TURBO-ELECTRIC PROPULSION
at low speeds is secured,
increased radius of action.
economy
In the U.
which
in
war
445
vessels
means an
S.
generator) is
the generator being a three-phase, 2,300-volt, 5,000 kw., furnishing
current to two electric motors one on each shaft, there being two pro-
The motors
and have 36 poles. Each
peller shafts.
cannot easily be filled by sea water. The windings are waterproof and not at all sensitive to moisture. When prompt
coaming, so that
reversal
is
required
This
circuit.
it
is
it is
motor
Rever-
tune
is
engines.
Displacement
I. h. p. at 14 knots
Engine or turbine speed at 14 knots.
Propeller, r. p. m., at 14 knots
Weight driving machinery in tons
Character of driving machinery
Cyclops
Jupiter
Neptune
20,000
5,600
20,000
20,000
88
88
280
r.
p.
m.
2 triple ex-
2,000
110
1
r.
p.
m.
156
turbo-gen-
pansion
erator and
engines
2 motors
1,250
r.
p.m.
135
2
turbines
with
gearing
each
11.2
13.9 knots
One
Due
7,000 h. p.
is
required.
MACHINERY
446
Name
HORSE POWER
447
Losses Given in
Power Developed
MACHINERY
448
thus
power =
lbs,
heat drop
778
turbine efficiency
33000
The
power
is
usually taken as
.9
of the
indicated.
Then
To Find
:
s.
the Quantity of
h. p.
axsxp
or
11. oo
Steam used
in
Power.
Q =
A =
power
pound
P
which
of
steam within
in
ft. lbs,
purpose of which
the
is
and draw
off
main condenser.
On
oiling
system
is
essential.
The
oil is
supplied
by
efficient
forced lubrication
Atmospheric Pressure. At sea level the pressure of the atmosphere varies from 14.5 to 15 lb. per square inch, a fair average being
14.7.
Atmospheric pressure is measured by the barometer.
GAUGE PRESSURE
449
pressure measured above that of the atmossteam* gauges indicate pressures above the
Gauge Pressure
is
Ordinary
atmosphere.
Gross or Absolute Pressure
phere.
is
mospheric.
of
.vacuum referred to a
30-in. barometer,
heat
is
trans-
will
be required -^-
Ok)
34.7
lb. of
water
and
52
of water
lb.
which
will
, nno
temperature of 90
.
!*,...
is
.,
10,000X15X1040
must contain a
that
is,
the condenser.
certain
It
is
450
MACHINERY
whose absorbed
increased temperature
in
the
condenser.
(Notes from C.
H.
451
MACHINERY
452
thus condensing the steam into water which is pumped to the hot
--well by an air pump.
The coldest water usually enters at the bot-
tom, meeting the steam at the lowest temperature, and the warmest
water at the top comes in contact with the tubes which are surrounded by the hottest steam. The cooling water often flows
Sizes of Surface
Size of
Engine
17
27
43
in
an oppo-
the steam.
OPERATING
453
is
The shells are made of cast iron, sheet brass, or steel plates.
to ${ inch outside diameter.
The tubes are of thin brass, usually
They are fastened to tube sheets by ferrules which by screwing
down compress a packing, thereby making a watertight joint.
Main
air
pump
suction
Suction from some fresh water pump, as hot well pump, for keeping condenser clear when main engines are stopped
Drain cocks
for
both
salt
and
A connection for
A vacuum gauge
Hand
holes.
Head
pump
broken;
away;
To
vacuum
both ends
valves are broken
feel
of the condenser.
or there
is
is
most
likely carried
16
H. Dinger.
away.
MACHINERY
454
C'**J>*f
***e*0 4**40
/**jmw
/>,**
af
Sssuc4r,/Y<r
mum
Figure 76.
Piping
of
with
a Radojet air
pump
installed.
To
vacuum gauge
or Bourdon's
455
In reciprocating engines only a slight gain is obtained thermodynamically in a vacuum above 26 ins., owing to increased cylinder
condensation caused by the difference in the inlet and outlet temperatures of the steam. If the condenser is tight and the air pump
(see table
below)
is
.980 lb.
per square inch; thus the greatest vacuum possible would be 14.7
.9S0 = 13.72 lb. per square inch below the atmosphere, equivalent to 27.5 ins. on the vacuum gauge.
Vacuum
456
MACHINERY
in
Condenser
457
is
Hence Q (T 2
Q=
To)
1114 -f
.3
T2 -
(7\
T - T
l
L)
T*
To
Q =
1114.
_i_
ioo
s*?
with
Also
temtem-
lb. is 183.
90
fif>
26\22; that
is,
is
26.22
H14
n
Q =
X 183 100 - 75
-3
The quantity
'
120
water
__
^
= 4195
times
will
of
A
*
LAt
<Sucr/ON
Figure 77.
OUTBOARD CONDENSERS
459
pound
of
surface condensers.
Air
or, instead,
The function of an
Pump.
air
the air
pump
is
pump may
to
air
and water from a condenser and by the vacuum formed reduce the
back pressure on the low-pressure piston. The air pump is often
driven direct from the main engine, or it may be separate, having
its own steam cylinder.
There are two types, viz., single- and double-acting. The former
In the single-acting there is
is vertical and is usually selected.
a reciprocating bucket or piston with orifices covered by non-return
valves which move in a cylindrical barrel at each end of which
are covers with orifices and non-return valves. These three sets
of valves lift vertically and allow the passage of water or air in
only one direction. The suction pipe of the air pump communicates with the bottom of the condenser, the pump being placed
lower than the condenser to get the most satisfactory results. The
valves at the lower end are called foot or suction valves, those in
the moving bucket, bucket valves, while those in the top are the
air
pump when
is
34 to
300 ft.
275 ft.
Edward's
its
pump
is
MACHINERY
460
efficiency ranging
Blanc, states that for turbines with a 29-inch vacuum the air pump
of feed water, and for a reciprocating engine with a 26-inch vacuum the pump must handle 12 times
EDWARDS
AIR
PUMP
Figure 78.
461
Steam
Cylinders,
ft.
or less
at 100
is
ft.
recommended.
MACHINERY
462
The ordinary
same
when
Vacuum,
FILTERING MATERIALS
463
As
is
are
refilled
it
accomplished by pipes leading to traps where the water is collected and from which the water goes to the filter tank for use over
is
than
will pass
connections.
is
to
know
its
by the
figure
MACHINERY
464
number
of linear feet.
lb.
is
70,080
25
The toweling
is
over a bronze
[465
circular frame, the filtering surface being from 150 to 1000 times
the area of the feed pipe according to the service required. When
is
filter.
Open
(surface).
is
series of trays
first
These
delivered
by a pump.
In this chamber
it
in
overflows
the same
water cannot be above about 180, as a higher temperacause vapor to form and the feed pump would not
would
ture
have a proper suction.
of the feed
through which the water from the hot well is forced by the boiler
The space around the tubes
feed pump on its way to the boiler.
is filled with exhaust steam (from the main units or the auxiliaries),
the water entering the tubes either cold or at hot well temperature.
When there is an excess of exhaust steam, the water goes to the
boiler within a few degrees of the exhaust steam temperature.
When the exhaust steam supply is limited, practically all is condensed
in the heater, and its latent heat transferred to the water, thereby
determining the resultant temperature of the water. Two systems
are in use, one where the heater is on the suction side of the feed
pump and the other where it is on the discharge side. With the
heater on the suction side of the pump a hot well pump is needed.
To
which
is
about
rise of 10 in
1
.09
That
is,
an approximate
rwi
Figure 80.
EVAPORATORS
H*
Then per cent saved =
H
Temperature of feed water entering heater
38 B. t. u. per lb.
Temperature of feed water leaving heater
49 B.
t.
u.
per
80
is
-Hi
Hi
70
and contains 70
32
81
and contains 81
32
lb.
467
= Hi - Hx
H Hi
- 38
= .96%
1,189 - 38
49
by Schutte
&
Koerting,
This construction
Phila., Pa., of concentric spiral corrugated tubes.
besides agitating the water and so preventing the formation of cold
keeps the water in a thin film between two heated copper
This gives an exceedingly high rate of heat transmission,
surfaces.
and yet at the same time a light and efficient heater. The heater
cores,
may
Temp.
lb.
Boiler Pressure
MACHINERY
468
evaporator feed and the pressure of the steam in the coils. Neglecting radiation, there is always a loss in heating an evaporator, due
to blowing down, but under ordinary working conditions this loss is
only about 5%.
used by feed
Boiler
pump
Steam Pressure
or circulating
pump.
DIMENSIONS OF EVAPORATORS
Dimensions of Evaporators*
469
MACHINERY
470
is,
down and
radiation.
is
not so economical
is
The
PUMPS
There are two types, reciprocating and centrifugal, each being
particularly adapted for certain conditions; the former where the
water has to be lifted by suction say a distance of 20 ft. and the
latter for delivering a large volume under a small head as in supplying the cooling water to a marine surface condenser.
In reciprocating pumps the pressure or head depends directly
on the steam pressure in the cylinder (omitting loss of head by
friction and turns), and in centrifugal the theoretical head against
represented by the pressure in the water
leaving the impeller plus the pressure due to converting the velocity
energy of the water leaving the impeller into pressure.
A pump should be located as near the water to be pumped as
which a
possible,
pump
can deliver
is
it
SUCTION HEAD
471
the water line so that the water may flow to it by gravity. All
suction pipes from the sea must be fitted with a cock or valve and
a strainer placed over the outboard opening. The cock or valve
pump
can be removed
When pumps
are
it,
is
line,
check
a foot valve
line,
the hull.
Its
purpose
is
pump.
Suction
Head
is
Discharge Head
is
pump
The
pump
shaft
up to
vrr
r^rn
.hmciency
horse power
= ^Water
Brake horse
-.
r-
.__
.
Efficiency
head
To
in feet
of
reciprocating
*
power
pumps varies from 60 to 70% and of centrifugal pumps 30 to 50.
For estimating size of boiler feed pumps, the formula Gallons per
Boiler horse power
...
,
minute =
could be used.
in .
Reciprocating Pumps.
for
boiler
feed,
drainage systems,
fire
purposes, etc.
Duplex pumps are practically two single pumps placed side by side,
the valve movement of one pump being actuated by connections
with the piston rod of the other.
The height to which a pump will
MACHINERY
472
the pressure per square inch, obtained from the barometer reading,
by
2.309.
At sea level the barometer stands, say, at 30 ins., and the correspond14.72 lb. Thus the theoretical lift of a pump would be 14.72 X
= 34 ft. But in actual practice it requires a good pump to draw to a
Example.
ing pressure
2.309
ft.
is
height of 28
To
ft.
pump
To
per minute
The area
of foot-pounds of
Weight
of coal
burned
lift
in
work actually
in ft.
pounds
To
To
pump
cylinder to
water per minute (assume piston speed of 100 ft. per minute), divide the number of gallons by 4, then extract the square
root, and the result will be the diameter in inches.
tity of
473
474
MACHINERY
may
CENTRIFUGAL PUMPS
engines
driven
475
the small space occupied and light weight, turbine driven pumps
have become popular. Besides handling the intake water for condensers, they have also worked satisfactorily for boiler feeding
and for fire purposes.
One
of the chief
Centrifugal Pumps
(Worthington Steam
Dia.
Pump
Co.,
New
York)
476
MACHINERY
Centrifugal Dredging Pumps
(Worthington Steam Pump Co.)
No. Pump
(Diameter
AIR
PUMP
477
Pump,
Pumps Installed
For particulars
page 312.
1
1 Circulating,
1
Main
of
Pumps
Main air,
feed,
1 Auxiliary,
1 Fire and bilge,
in a Freight
Steamer
(geared
turbine),
see
10 l ins., 12 ins.
1 Trimming,
ins., 7 ins., 10 ins.
%
1 Sanitary,
7J^ ins., 5 ins., 6 ins.
1 Fresh water,
7J^ ins., 5 ins., 6 ins.
z
1 Evaporator,
4}^ ins., 2 /i ins., 4 ins.
1 Engine room bilge, 6 ins., b% ins., 6 ins.
2 Fuel oil,
6 ins., 4 ins., 6 ins.
1
Ballast,
12
10
ins.,
strainer
on the end
Do
not place the pump more than 25 ft. above the water.
Where hot water is pumped, the supply must be above the pump.
Make
it
all joints in
Keep the stuffing boxes well and evenly filled with packing.
Oil the pump before starting it, and keep the oil wiped off where
is not needed.
In cold weather drain the steam and water cylinders to prevent
freezing.
MACHINERY
478
more than 50
boilers
ft.
pump
cylinder,
This
which
is
on
its
discharge
name
Kerosene
is
for gasoline.
See
Oil.
so powerful.
those on gasoline,
easily.
it
With
runs better
than at any other; consequently this fuel is suitable only for boats
running for long periods at a constant speed. It is doubtful whether
an engine using kerosene has any advantages over one using gasoline, when considering the adaptability to changes of speed of the
engine and freedom of carbonization that is obtained with gasoline,
even
if it
costs more.
GAS ENGINES
479
The
500
h. p.,
is
down and
In the four-cycle the piston draws into the cylinder on the downstroke the explosive mixture of air and oil vapor, which is compressed on the upstroke and then ignited, the resulting explosion
driving the piston
down and
burnt gases.
Two-Cycle
Downstroke:
Ignition
stroke
Lower
Four-Cycle
Downstroke:
Suction of
Upstroke: Compression of
Second revolution Downstroke: Ignition and
First revolution
expansion
power
stroke.
Upstroke
The compression
Exhaust.
MACHINERY
480
in the cylinders ranges
engines where
F.,
except in Diesel
it is
closer
together;
their
piston
down and
the cylinder. This mingling with the highly heated air charge
in the cylinder immediately ignites the fuel.
for
Formula.
Let P = mean effective pressure, in slow speed engines about 80 lb.
A = area of piston in square inches
S = piston speed in feet per minute (obtained by multiplying
the revolutions per minute by two times the stroke in
inches
and dividing by
12)
= number of cylinders
E = mechanical efficiency taken
C = 2.5 for two-cycle engines
4.0 for four-cycle engines
R
*'
PXAXSXNX E
at .75
"
33,000
X C
ELECTRIC IGNITION
Internal Combustion Engines (Electric Ignition)
481
MACHINERY
482
C =
lor
cruisers
h. p.
9,000
9,600
6,000
-^
h. p.
and vaporizing
it.
around
is
circulated
it.
Before installing be sure that the gasoline tank and piping are
clean and contain no particles of dirt or scale.
Connect the carburetor to the intake pipe so it is about 6 ins. below the bottom
of the gasoline tank; for the best results it should be as close to
the cylinder as possible, and in case of multicylinder engines equiThe carburetor should be adjusted
distant from each if practicable.
to the normal running temperature of the motor.
The ordinary
the cylinders a few drops of water are mixed with it, the water,
being drawn with the mixture into the cylinders, forms steam at the
REVERSE GEARS
air or
by an
running
is
it
electric
motor.
stored in a tank.
From
483
is
is,
running the
turned into
ca
Figure 82.
Reverse Gears.
Reverse Gear.
New
Haven,
Conn. The engine sleeve carries one of the central gears, into
which meshes a short pinion, which meshes with a long pinion, that
meshes with another central gear that is attached to the propeller
sleeve.
Whichever way the engine runs the propeller will be
turned in the opposite direction. With this gear four revolutions
MACHINERY
484
of the engine
direction.
make
Lubricating Systems.
different
Some
system.
splash system, which consists of partly filling the bottom of the crank
case with oil, and as the cranks revolve, the oil is splashed over the
bearings and connecting rods. Care must be taken that the dippers
much
oil,
for
if
there
is
too
when
the piston
Some
of the
oil
The consumption
is
The
pump
is
driven by
used.
the crank case through a check valve which closes on the downIn the three-port, the check valve is not required.
stroke.
The
latter
arrangement
is
is
WIRING DIAGRAM
4 s:,
fc.2
CO
XT*
17
^^
O
XI
MACHINERY
486
When
only one. Another type has the valves inverted and seated
directly on the top of the cylinder, but in this arrangement either
is
opened.
The
Ignition.
explosive
An
idea of the
number
of sparks required can be obtained from the fact that in a fourcycle engine running at 800 r. p. m. about 400 sparks are needed
Ignition.
Electric
ignition
is
either of the
is
combustion
chamber of the cylinder. There is required a battery or a magneto
for generating the current, a coil, and an igniter (one for each
in the
The
by
gears.
The contact
is
driven
by the main
shaft
points.
of the advantages of the make and break system is that
it is not easily affected by dampness and is consequently largely
adopted for engines installed in open boats. Its disadvantages
One
rent
is
C3dinder,
and
it is
only
SPARK COILS
487
by a spark
coil,
The
is
Spark coils for high tension ignition are different from those
of low tension ignition in that they are covered with another winding
they consist of a core of soft
iron wire around which is wound a few layers of coarse copper
wire called the primary coil, on top of which is wound a great many
layers of fine insulated copper wire called the secondary coil but not
connected with the primary. When a low voltage current is broken
in the primary coil, a high voltage one is induced in the secondary,
of fine insulated copper wire; that
and
is,
quired.
coil for
is
the
Kent
(A.
Kent
488
MACHINERY
489
current consumed, a set of ordinary dry cells will last several weeks.
Timing the Ignition. The timing of the ignition of a single-
outlined below, but the same procedure is followed irrespective of the number of cylinders.
Open the priming cup or take off one of the spark plugs and put
cylinder
is
a piece of stiff wire in the cylinder so that one end rests on the top
Then by noting the rise and fall of the wire as the
of the piston.
crank shaft is turned, the position of the piston at any part of the
stroke can be determined.
(1) Turn the engine so that the piston
on
Now
Electricity).
viz.,
spark or
spark.
The low
is
for either
jump
for
jump spark
ignition
and
nor a timer is
In the high tension there are two windings, a high
necessary.
and a low, and a circuit breaker that breaks the circuit in the high
differ radically
coil
490
MACHINERY
No coil or timer is
distributor binding post to the spark plug.
necessary, as these magnetos have a complete ignition system
within themselves, having their own windings and a circuit breaker
that takes the place of a timer.
The advantage
magneto
is
erally necessary.
Spark plugs are for igniting the explosive mixture in the combustion chamber. Preferably the spark between the points should
be in the form of a flat sheet rather than a ball, for a spark with an
extensive surface or area will ignite a greater number of mixture
The
particles in a given time than will a thin threadlike spark.
plug should be located near the intake valve in such a manner that
it will be surrounded by the fresh gas that enters during the inlet
stroke.
If on the exhaust side, dead gas is liable to collect around
the points and cause missing.
Clean off the
If the engine misses, examine the spark plugs.
mica or porcelain and see that the points are about -^ of an inch
To test the plug, unscrew it and lay it on the cylinder
apart.
much
or too poor cylinder oil, and too rich a mixture, will cause
the plug to foul and become sooted.
BATTERIES
491
Batteries.
Motor
to two-
If after
or five times
and four-cycle
it
is
nothing caught in
Should the compression be weak, see if any of the spark plugs are
loose, or perhaps the valves leak, or there may be a broken piston
This is done by
If the valves leak they should be reground.
ring.
taking out the valve, putting a grinding compound on the seat,
replacing the valve and turning it to the right and left until a clean
smooth surface is on the valve face. Care should be taken in grinding that none of the compound gets into the cylinder; if it does it
should be removed.
the engine will not start, begin a systematic search for trouble,
beginning with the carburetor and then going over the ignition sysIf
tem.
Trouble
Part
Carburetor
Ignition
System
Water
in gasoline or in carburetor.
Weak
batteries.
Timer
dirty.
See
Engine pounds
Cylinders get
very hot
if
Valves leak.
Batteries weak.
Wrong spark plug gap.
Connections loose.
Engine not bolted firmly to
Piston ring broken.
Shaft bearing loose.
Connecting rod loose.
Water
its
foundation.
circulation stopped.
See if sea cock is
open, pump working, and the pipes not
clogged up.
Cylinder getting no oil.
MACHINERY
492
circuit
being
cago.
215
350
lb.
per square inch, and the pressure from the explosion 260 to
lb.
Engines of this type have proved very satisfactory for medium size
seagoing vessels and have been installed in many sailing vessels
(see page 318).
They are reliable, their fuel consumption is low and
a cheap grade can be used. They are built in sizes up to about
500 h.p. A well-known make is the Bolinder (built by J. and C. G.
Bolinder, New York) which is of the two-cycle type with a working
pressure of about one-third that of a Diesel engine. Complete combustion is obtained by mixing the fuel with air before injecting it
into the cylinder.
For this purpose a special nozzle has been constructed in which the fuel oil is automatically mixed with air. No
water injection in the cylinders is necessary at normal load or 10%
overload. The engine can run on cheap and heavy oils.
All Bolinder engines having more than one cylinder are started
by compressed air. The ignition balls are heated (from 7 to 15
minutes being necessary, depending on the size of the engine), and
when ready to start, open the cylinder cocks to avoid compression
in the cylinders and turn the flywheel until the mark on it is on top,
in which position the piston has just commenced its downward
Next close the cylinder cocks. The stop valve on the air
stroke.
receiver is now opened and the hand wheel of the starting valve is
opened 2 or 3 turns, after which by means of a hand lever the valve
is opened for a moment, allowing air to enter the cylinder, and is
quickly closed, the engine readily starting.
This engine is also direct reversible, the reversing being accomplished as follows:
1.
2.
The
The
clutch
is
reversing lever
is
pulled aft
of a
(for
hand
lever.
going astern).
This
REVERSIBLE ENGINES
493
movement
is
is
The
astern
New York).]
inches
80
425
8,700
42
MACHINERY
494
is
is
pump
will
smokeless.
All engines of 25 h.p. and over are supplied with a starting device
consisting of a starting valve and steel air tank connected by copper
piping.
started
by a
pull
starting valve.
DIESEL ENGINES
495
Diesel Engines
due to cheap fuel and the small number of men required, they have
proved very satisfactory on certain routes. Submarines are driven
by them when running on the surface.
Care must be exercised in the selection of fuel, because one which
is suitable for one make of engine may not be for another having a
It is an object to
different compression or system of atomization.
use the cheapest fuel possible but in a general way Diesel engines
cannot use crude oils. The fuels which they do require are easily
Most Diesel
obtainable and cost very little more than crude oil.
to
run.
on
crude
oil
of
a
certain
are
guaranteed
engines
gravity, but
this gravity is so high that there are few crude oils that will comply
with it. When an engine runs well on an oil of a given viscosity, it
advisable to get oil as near this viscosity as possible, otherwise the
entire adjustment of the injection valves must be altered.
Howinstalled
the
heater
be
warm
a
from
the
utilizing
ever,
may
gases
is
oil.
hour for large engines and .46 for small. On this basis, considering
that oil weighs 7.5 lb. per gallon, the fuel consumption per 100 b.
h. p. hours would be about 6 gallons.
k The table on page 496 gives a comparison of Diesel engines,
ordinary reciprocating marine engines, and geared turbines. Allowance has been made for the difference in tonnage measurement
and deadweight capacity which the systems involve. The vessel
chosen is 400 ft. long between perpendiculars, 52 ft. beam, 29 ft.
9 ins. deep, and 26 ft. 1 in. draft. Total deadweight carrying capacity in tons, 8,640 (steam), 8,775 (Diesel), 8,805 (geared turbines).
Speed 10 J/2 knots, radius of action 3,500 miles, fuel consumption 1 .6
MACHINERY
496
lb.
per
i.
h. p.
per
i.
h. p.
1 .2 lb.
per
i.
h. p.
per hour
TWO-CYCLE ENGINE
497
the bottom, to allow for the expansion due to heat. Six to eight
rings are fitted having lapped joints, so that there is no leakage past
the piston.
In the two-cycle
Diesel engines are either two- or four-cycle.
or
is
one
stroke
with every revolution.
working
power
engine there
This type of engine has a scavenger pump operated directly from the
main engine, or scavenger pistons which are extensions of the power
pistons that furnish the air required for clearing the working cylinder
of its burnt gases and for filling it with fresh air which is then compressed on the return of the piston. When the exhaust valves are
open, air from the scavenger
Figure 86.
pump
is
MACHINERY
498
operated valves at the piston end of the cylinder, and sweeps before
it the products of combustion, leaving the cylinder filled with fresh
which
is
injection
The
burned and
gasified.
are expelled through the discharge or outlet valve into the exhaust
The piston sweeps all the gases before it and acts as an effipipe.
cient scavenger.
The
built
to the
minimum
cut-off.
Two-Cycle
First Revolution Downstroke
Injection of charge and ignition
by heated air.
Lower portion of Exhausting gases and taking in
downstroke
pure air for cleaning cylinders.
Compression of
Upstroke
air to 1,000 F.
Four-Cycle
First Revolution
Second Revolution
Downstroke
Upstroke
Downstroke
Suction of pure
air.
Compression to 1,000 F.
Injection of fuel charge, ignition
by contact with heated air,
Upstroke
The
Exhaust
of gases.
pumped by a
twin
INJECTION VALVE
499
plunger, one plunger doing most of the work and discharging the
excess through an escape valve back into the suction.
The second
The
is
most
the valves,
and
this is
sleeves.
Suction valves open about 5 below top center and close on the
bottom center. Exhaust valves open 10 or 12 below the bottom
center
and
MACHINERY
500
Figure 87a.
Section
of
motor
Int.
Mar. Eng'g,
than
New
ship, 401.5
ft.
York.)
by
oil,
full speed,
this
may be
TYPES
(2)
(3)
There
(1)
If the fuel
too high.
is
an excess
of fuel.
501
may
but some of the heavier residual fuel oils are so viscous and have
such surface tension that it is impossible to atomize them into the
If the engine has not
fine mist necessary for clean combustion.
sufficient compression use a ligher fuel that is more easily ignited.
Types. Tables 1 and 2 are of engines built by the New London
the upstroke, a spray valve opens and fuel oil is delivered, for a short
time at the beginning of the downstroke, into the cylinder, and begins
This downstroke is the real working stroke. At the end
to burn.
of this stroke the
scavenged and
filled
charge of pure air in the cylinder when the piston is at the end of
its outward stroke; (3) the piston then compresses the charge of
pure air into such a small space that it becomes very hot; and (4)
the atomizer spindle is lifted by the cam shaft, opening the passage
MACHINERY
502
Table
Number
Data
DIESEL ENGINES
5o;j
step piston type; that is, the piston of the scavenging pump is an
enlarged extension of the main piston, working in its own cylinder
time during
The
its travel.
MACHINERY
504
and are cooled with sea water like the cylinders. One of the
largest built (1916) was a 6-cylinder, 4-cycle with cylinders 29.6 ins.
diameter by 44 ins. stroke, giving 340 h. p. per cylinder at 100 r. p. m.,
rings
and are
is
fitted
reversible
2134
h. p.
by
cam
Each
shaft
his.
diameter by 28 J^
and substituting a
special
deck house above with branches to the masts, the masts being hollow and of steel.
Figure 87.
Another make
One
is
its
accessibility,
it
being of the open type with the cylinders mounted on steel columns
on both sides, and at the back are cast iron frames on which are
the crosshead guides.
The
cylinder design
(see
Fig.
87) differs
CRAIG ENGINES
505
is
self-contained
The exhaust
large
gases are
amount of
led in some
i.
h. p.
per hour.
MACHINERY
506
air
and
for
and
shaft to
move
Fuel
is
PIPING
AND TUBING
507
may
or electricity.
See table of Motor Ships
air,
and
Fig. 87a.
AND FITTINGS
is
is
dimension; this
is
The
is
acid,
1.84
sp. gr.,
If
if
8
3
iiM
I>-0OQO-*<tJ<i-1i-h-(^-iOO0O0OO0QOO0O0OOO0 0OO00OQO0OCOO0O0O0O0OC
X)
.SP
'*'*NOOOON(NMW50!OOON^'*'OT)(NrHOMNm(Nt0
T)<M<DiOMNNrHiON003MiHNTt(0>iOOO'*QO"5NOiONt>
OS
N^iOQO'HCDlNNtOh.iOiHNiOtDaiWtOiOCifNN'^inNKJiniO^
jg
rHiHM(NP3iONO)0(N'<J<OOM'<fOOMrH'<t(0>OWO'<J'00
bO
NQOOOPO'HNM'HNNO'HMOiOO'HiHNOStOQOlNiHiON'tiOa
+i NNCOO>0<0(NNOiO't'OMO'-lC3t^-OOOOC^I>-I>-00f5C^CN|005l>
u rtCO'trtOtO<OOlNOCi'J(rHO>NTtiCONNNi
r
'
o^
lOMN^lNi-l
111
oseot^-'t0'-it^c<i>.t^f5cooot>.coo5ecieoooi^--rf<cOiinwjooooqoc
ft
lictONOiJiMNNHHHH
ti-i
[ju
<1
rHC000NN'fiHO00Q0iHTl(MC00<DO<NMiOO0>OOlCi(N'<H0l
<(HOQONO'l '*Ci'Cl'0>0(M0505NiOC<
PCONW5^WOO'HQlMOiO
CliOiO'*Tt*MC<5CCimcON<N<N(NC'
0^00: OC>COO<OC<:005QON
,
Qi
ir-itOiOOiTHOONOOrHOOlNOOl
_>00(N5DO)NNNOONN10C
ijOHiHNW"*tOt>-ON<N!OiHtDeOiOOJINW05HOi'*OOiOON'<;
i-dHNNMco'^:<ot>coai050'-icoc<i'<*Na
t^T(<TH'<*e0'*i5<0>O00e00ON'-i00i-tN0K:i-iiCMOt^<OK3r
S"50OCOiOCOiC(OQOCOT)(OOM:0OlN000005OeOOOit)OOOW
^OrHTHWiOOO^OMNMOONffiOOONiHONiOtOOOOOOOOO^a
CQ
^
0)0500'<J<tOa)'i)<iOOlN'HTj(iOCOC1'*OOWMMTtttOcOOOiOC>
2(N(NiOCOiOCOMfOCi(NtOOCOOt~-!0<NM<OiOtOCONt^MrHt:
rHrHHNM^iOiONOiOlOOWPIiCNC
THlHHHiHC
SoOH005iO(NMO'<l<NiOH<0>-iOOOOCOOOOOO'*>OCi3NO
2
2
p
2
H
J3
rHrHtHNM-*OtONa>-ilN'ttiOailMiOiOOOIM'HrHTtlNNr-(T)*h
rHrHr1r-lrHIN(NIN(NMeOCCMCOCO *'*Tl
,
m MrHO>OHi001rHNOtONOONTOiOcDiOOOINNIM^lO"3C<l' *f
SNOINC<:C5COHCD<Dmai3COONrHiOaiac<5NNNiHOiO((M(
^(NOn(0(N'-iiNa')<Oi3i>OH|>^(OONNNN05000>HO
,
2T-(rHMiNCO'*iOON050<N'*iONOWNNOe5COCO
w
.2
^coccoiO'^ccTt<'*iicO'tc<icO'rt<OQOot~--c^Tt<t^.o<c>i>-cot^t>.r^-i^
* o
S3
sis*
r-r-
COOCONC
*'!ttTjtT}<ir
SoOOO'-i05iC<50'0->*cO ONNCiOOi-"NC<JiM05NiCM50iO5>Cif
"**!
THl-(l-(rtrH(M(NM(NMCDmWCC
J3
m '*n(N'*0lOONO)Q0 00(0N>CMHHHN0OOOOOOC
gcD005<N(M-*<X)iHCDcOtO^(^0'*0(MNQOT}iaiCO<NOffiOiC>Oif:
^NM^COOOMCO^OiOOiOOOOOaiOHHOOOONNC
HrtH(NNCOCO'*^K5<ONOONOOOOO'HM(NCi3T)K
a
(1
0 0"*00000>0OOOOOCO0>0OiOiOOOOOOOOOC
SO^NntiOH!OONNOOOONNMNNiOiOil5iOiOiOOOC
r
^TfiOtOOOOmtOOlCOOOWOiCOiOtDtOOtDtDNNNNNNOOC
M
HtHrHiHiMNMTtlTjH0irjN0000aiOOO'HIMNT)(iOCC
HHHNlNMM^'^iOiONOOCOOiOOOi-tNMW'^i';
508
&
*z
-*
8> ^a-W
tt<
2o
1-JCL.rt
k-Uh
o ci mc- co
eo tM
MACHINERY
510
5%
is
Outside Diameter,
BOILER TUBES
511
CD
ift
CO iO
t-H
r*<
CO CO 00
10(0000(00000000066
t^t>00CO
05HT)t(DOHNOCC05(N(O^HiOHOcDNOO'000(CMOOOOOOO
HnnHMWCOMM^^iOtONOHCOOHiOCOCSCDOiOMiOOOCOHaiS
HHHHO^NNCOCO^IIlOONClOOH
3
CO
CO
CD
CP
OMOQOO^^QOMOHOO^NNMWQONOOiMOiOM^NaiNOl^HOO
fHO^^i^O^O^OI>.<X)cNO-il>-t>-05->^020COOGOcO'^-iOit^cOiO-^CO
N(005'*H00(0OM(NHOO0i00c0>0't^MC0WN(N01W(MHHHHHH
* CO CN CN CM
+->
w
3
CO
'
C550SC50iOOOO35M>OHQO>OO^NONT)f(NNC75T)<CO'^C7lC10WONOlN
^iO^C005(NQOt>.t>.Oi^iO^COCO^I>cNQO^i--iC5l>OeOi-tCil>iO'i*COcN
OOOiOHaiiOOWCNHOOffiCONcOiCi^^cOCOCOcNlNCNINlNHHHHHH
COCOCNOI'
ft
c3
O
O
'-ir>.co<o<Noot~C5'-i
0'<*iC5'^OOCOOO >^00'^OI>COCO>0-^'-iQ005'-i
,
c3
X
O
X
N^HOXO^HOCOMNOINCO'OCIrfOOO'fiON'^IMOiOHOCOMO^O
CNCOT^T^iOOOOO^Oi^CNCOCOXcNO'OOOCNJ^TtHi-Ot^aiCOOOCOCOCOr-iiOO
fHT-trHi-liH(MC0C0'*xtiC01>G0a)O'-tC00OC0t^O^rH
HHHHHCNMCOCOCO
CCH0 00C5OOOONN05N
lOCNNHWlNO^QOiOtOOOOOOH^OHCl
H00rt*>HNC0iX)MNHTl*NC0CDN'>t'*O(NQG0C0OWiMrHC0CiOCDTj*HC0
-^>
OQOCCaOWOOOHM(OOJOWCNONCO(N'OCOHiMNNOCOOiOI>CIC5
rHi-HC^CO^^COt-COTt<t^O^COGOC^^^COCOTt<t^GO^COTt<OCOi-l
i-Hr^i-HC^CO^OI>CX)OCN"'tfCOaOCCC5OCNOOOt"~
03
HnnHHCNCNCO^iOiOO
rt*CNi-tCOCOi-<t>.COCO00i-t
ior>-t>-io>-tcoooo5ooiOi-iocO'^iOTj*kooi>.oco
Q0(N(0O'*NOM(0OCN'<tOOC0N00(0iH<fWOW'*HC0NOW0JC0>0D
NNNT)tHaai050N(00'OC5<0(N' tiM(0OOHN03NO^HHroNOO
l
M
W
Hi-tHHCNCOLOONOHCOiCNO'CHCOiOMHO
Hi-(iliICN<NCOC0 't lOCDI>
-
o
K50>'5H(D(NO'*0(0(NN->l'"OOOCO^ X)WOLOOK5<!)iOO-*C10iN"OOOCl
^NHOOONCO^'^iO'*(N(NONr-iiOOTj(T)*NCOTj<C-lOCOONcO'^(NOO
iOCOH03(D'*HCit>iTf*cNONClNOCC30HHHCNMTt*'*ONOOa>OW(COO
<NCO^rJiiOCO^t*0000^'-HCO^t^0^t>-OCOCOOcN>000-^OcOCOOOiTH
l
i-ii-ii-iT-Hi-tr-tCNcNCMCOCOCOCO'H^Tj<0)tOcOtl>Q0C5
s
H
MN(NOOWO-<t O>>00(DHiONCOOHCO'*CO(Z)OH(M-*iOOlMCCOHiOCC
l
^CNH0500(0OCCC)THOiOO(OWOiOOCONr-(iOG-*00(NCOrt*MH05(ZKDi(
h
O
i^Cit^Tf(NOOOCO^cNOit^U^i-Hl>COii-HC^Tt<iOcDcOOi^cMOOOrH(^cOC5CN|
MWTj*iO(DNNQ00500H(NTt*iOiXlrHiOGOHr}*NOo:NO(D(MCHOHNrt<
i-HT-(i-lr-(i-(i-trHCN|CNJCNCCCOCOTfH^^lOlOCOCOI> CO GO
co
53
\N
rX
\C*
r\
COCOCOCOCOCOCNCMCN
OOOO
\<N
rX
HOOOiOOOOOONCOiO^TjlcOCOcNNHOOOOO
Q
55
<1
to
O
1
1
co
o
a
OlOJOiaOWOOOINMfNCOCCi^OcDcDOOOtMCNirOTtdOSOOHTttNNNN
OOOOOOHHHHHHHHHHHnH(N(NM(NINO)(N(NCCCOCClWCOCO
fc
"d
OQOOOOlNININOOOlNINTfOOOO^OIN^^lNOINtO^
THOHCDHCDOOMQOr-KOHCOMONNN^OiC^cNOOOcDCONHiniOiOO
Q0OMi000ON>ONO(NiONNN(CO(0(DiOi0i00iO^^rt*c0C0(M(NiNcN
HriNCNcNCNCOMCO'<}''*'OCONCOOHNCO-*ONOHMLONC
HHr-lHHr-lHH(NIN(N(NCN
CO
T3
HHHH(N(N(NINCOMCOW'*'*iOONOCOH(Nm^iO(OQOON'*(DOOO
HHr-ii 1lili-(t-KNCNCNCNCNOO
1
512
bjObfibOhCfaCbCbCbObCbOfaOhO
bC
cicicici'^iCicioiTiTi'TiTi
ooooooooooco
d
""trj
*cc
~cro
en
4-3
-4-3
4-3
-*->
4~J
-W
02 "V>
to
4->
-4-3
-4-5
3 3 3
333333333
rac3^c3^c^^d^c303c3
OOOOOOOOOOOG
TOro-./jTOTOOTTOcr;TOTOTO
33333 3 333333
faC
bC bO b
fc
b bC bC bC bC
bfi
-*->
-1-3 -4~>
-*-5
-4-3
4-3 4-3
-|-3
-1-3 -_3
^3
s,
4-3
4J
EOC/2CZ}e/2C/2GGtCCtCG!GO&G&G
o
NMOOOt)ICONOCCO
i
o o cd
o
o
t-h y-i
^
o
OOiOCOiHffiOONiOTtlM<N
1>
'
<M i i i i
I
OS
s*
^0fNOOib->OTj(M
i i i i
C^l
OOiJi^HNlOiJ<COrtOOO
ihhih
OO
00*hCiNi0tiHmhOOO
O CD
OO^HOJNiO^MHOOO
o
OS
us
a
o
<r;
o
.3
J2
03
-3
OimMOOOtOiO^NHOO
i
t i
o
I
i(
iHrtrHrt
(OOOOtO'J'MHHOffiOOOO
q
6
0!5(NOOO!OiO'*M(Nr-0
rtHlHH
Ci
S.
T3
00
0(DCC^01N<OiOMCqiHO
(NlHlHTH
J
bO
a
3
O
e,
i-'Nt)<(MOXN'*Mim
MlHlHl-ll-l
S
fc
o
rHN^NOOONOTjlTOIN
OlHlHHlH
0)
*->
ti
<"
-3
b 3T3
S fl is
13!
ioooooooocooo
(N"ONO(N>ONO(N5NO
THiHiHrHNNlNOieO
-.3
a>
\3
WO'OOiOO'OQiOOi'JO
HrtiiiHMMNNM
co Sc
n
513
Birmingham Gauge
Add
in
Outside Diameters.
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
.072
.065
.058
.049
.042
.035
.032
.028
.025
Gauge No.
24
26
25
27
Thickness of each
No.
in
Decimal
016
Parts of Inch
Frac. of Inch, Cor-
responding Closely
to Gauge Nos.
/64
/C4
A-
.096
.148
.200
.252
.304
.366
.408
.400
j-
A...
...
11-
/l6.
.511
.563
.645
/l6.
.667
.719
lB
13
l5
:77
.87
.98
...
ty%...
1H...
1H...
1H...
lfc...
1.08
1.19
1.29
1.39
IK..,
2
..
2 1/s..
2' 4-.
:,
s..
2H...
2H...
3K-.
2%...
3
..
IK-.
Z%..
PA-.
ix..
3K-.
1.71
1.81
1.91
2.02
2.12
2.23
2.33
2.43
2.54
2.64
2.74
2.85
95
3.06
3.16
Inside Diameter,
.045
.092
.139
.186
.233
.279
.326
.37
.420
.467
.514
.561
.608
.655
.70
.79
.89
.98
1.08
1.17
1.26
1.36
1.45
1.55
1.64
1.73
1.83
1.92
2.01
2.11
2.20
2.30
2.39
2.48
2.58
2.67
2.76
2.86
.25.'
.290
252
.32ii
!283
.313
.343
.373
.404
.434
.46
.52
.59
.65
.361
.396
.432
.467
.5021
.54
.61
.68
.75
.82
.89
.96
.71
.80
.88
.96
1.05
1.13
1.22
1.30
1.38
1.47
1.55
1.63
1.72
1.80
1.89
1.97
2.05
2.14
2 22
2.30
2.39
2.47
2.56
.040
.070
.101
.131
.161
.192
.222
.043
.078
.114
.149
.184
.220
.045
.087
.129
.170
.212
.254
.296
.338
.380
.421
.463
.505
.547
.589
.63
1.03
1.10
1.17
1.24
1.32
1.39
1.46
1.53
1.60
1.67
1.74
1.81
1.88
1.95
2.02
2.09
2.16
.17::
.196
.219
242
^265
.288
.311
.334
.358
.404
.450
.496
.542
.588
.635
.591
.611
.71
.77
.83
.89
.95
1.01
.692
.742
.681
.793 .727
.843 .773
.894 .819
.866
.944
.995 .912
1.045 .958
1.096 1.004
1.07
1.13
1.146
1.197
1.247
1.298
1.348
1.399
1.449
1.50
1.55
1.37
1.43
1.49
1.55
1.62
1.68
1.74
1.80
1.86
add to weights
.034
.057
.080
.104
.127
.150
.036
.062
.087
.112
.137
.163
.188
.213
.238
.264
.289
.314
.339
.365
.389
.439
.490
.540
1.050
1.091
1.143
1.189
1.235
1.281
1.327
1.373
1.42
in
above
19
20
list
.031
.051
.072
.092
.112
.132
.152
.173
.193
.213
.233
.25
.274
.294
.314
.351
.395
.435
.476
.516
.556
.59
.637
.678
.718
.758
.799
.839
.880
.920
.960
1.001
1.041
1.082
1.122
1.162
1.203
1.243
.029
.047
.065
.083
.101
.119
.137
.155
.173
.191
.209
.227
.245
.263
.281
.317
.354
026
012
058
074
.090
.106
121
.137
153
.169
.185
.
.201
.217
.232
.248
.280
.312
.343
.375
.407
.439
.470
.502
.534
.566
.597
629
.661
.390
.426
.462
.498
.534
.570
.606
.642
.678
.714
.750
.786 693
.822 .724
.859 756
.895 .788
.
.020
.032
.043
.055
.066
.078
.089
.101
.112
.124
.136
.148
17- .159
.024
.039
.053
.067
.082
.096
.111
.125
.140
.154
.169
.183
107
.022
.035
.048
.061
.074
.087
.100
.113
.126
.139
.152
.165
.2\\
.191
171
.931 .820
.967 ,851
1.003 ,883
1.039 .915
1.075 .916
1.111 .978
the
15
16
17
18
21
22
26
21
27
Increase in
From Catalogue
Hungerford Co.
515
0144
Oil"
.IHI-..2
.0075 .0059
MACHINERY
516
Birmingham Gauge.
of Seamless
Gauge No.
Thickness of each
No. in decimal
Parts of Inch
238
.259
.220
.203
180
165
10
11
134
120
12
.109
\4,
Vc4
/64
>/<*
148
Copper Tubing
4^
4M
Vi
VA
iH
....:
4*4
V/s
5
V4
5%
5V2
bYi
5H:
5Vs
6
6K
m
m
7
7H-.
7V2
1%
8
m
s%
814
11.19
11.57
11.94
12.32
12.69
13.06
13.44
13.81
14.18
14.56
14.93
15.31
15.68
16.05
16.43
16.80
17.17
17.92
18.67
19.42
20.16
20.91
21.66
22.41
23.07
23.82
24.56
25.30
10.33
10.68
11.02
11.36
11.71
12.05
12.39
12.74
13.08
13.42
13.77
14.11
14.45
14.80
15.14
15.48
15.83
16.51
17.20
17.89
18.57
19.26
19.95
20.64
21.27
21.95
22.62
23.30
To
9.60
9.91
10.23
10.55
10.87
11.18
11.50
11.82
12.14
12.45
12.77
13.09
13.41
13.72
14.04
14.36
14.67
15.31
15.94
16.58
17.21
17.85
18.48
19.12
19.69
20.32
20.96
21.60
8.90
9.19
9.48
9.77
10.07
10.36
10.65
10.95
11.24
11.53
11.82
12.12
12.41
12.70
13.00
13.29
13.58
14.17
14.75
15.34
15.92
16.51
17.10
17.68
18.20
18.80
19.37
19.97
7.94
8.20
8.46
8.72
8.98
9.24
9.50
9.76
10.02
10.28
10.53
10.79
11.05
11.31
11.57
11.83
12.09
12.61
13.13
13.65
14.17
14.69
15.21
15.73
16.33
16.87
17.38
17.90
7.31
7.54
7.78
8.02
8.26
8.50
8.73
8.97
9.21
9.45
9.69
9.92
10.16
10.40
10.01
10.88
11.12
11.59
12.07
12.54
13.02
13.50
13.97
14.45
15.03
15.51
15.99
16.47
6.58
6.79
7.01
7.22
7.43
7.65
7.86
8.07
8.29
8.50
8.71
8.93
9.14
9.35
9.57
9.7S
9.00
10.42
10.85
11.28
11.70
12.13
12.56
12.98
13.49
13.91
14.35
14.47
5.98
6.17
6.37
6.56
6.75
6.94
7.14
7.33
7.53
7.72
7.91
8.11
8.3)
8.49
8.69
8.88
9.07
9.40
9.85
10.23
10.62
11.01
11.39
11.78
12.22
12.62
13.01
13.40
5.37
o.55
5.72
5.89
6.06
6.24
6.41
6.58
6.76
6.93
7.10
7.28
7.45
7.62
7.80
7.97
8.14
8.49
8.84
9.18
9.53
9.87
10.22
10.57
10.96
11.32
11.66
12.00
4.89
5.05
5.21
5.37
5.52
5.68
5.84
6.00
6.15
6.31
6.47
6.62
6.78
6.94
7.10
7.25
7.41
7.72
8.04
8.35
8.67
8.98
9.30
9.61
9.97
10.30
10.61
10.92
Gauge No.
BRASS TUBING
Per Foot of Seamless Brass Tubing
Measured
Add
in Outside Diameters.
Gauge No.
517
518
MACHINERY
Copper pipes over 5 ins. diameter are usually of sheet copper with
the edges brazed together.
Iron
Pipe Sizes
Made to Correspond with Iron Pipe and to Fit Iron Pipe Size Fittings
Hard Drawn,
Stubs'
Gauge
in 12-Foot Lengths
519
MACHINERY
520
or divide
by
eter of pipe
.7851
4.95
a/
of the quotient.
Or diam-
Flow
Sizes, for
Varying
MACHINERY
522
over 3
ins. in
The U.
may be
brazed on.
open hearth
S.
steel castings
and
shall
Size
TENSILE STRENGTH
523
make
LB.
Flanges of cast iron, ferro-steel, cast steel, and malleable iron, for
wrought iron and steel pipe
Size
MACHINERY
524
Screw Threads
for Bolts
and Nuts.
In
standard
of thread
is
.649
pitch.
degs.,
is
the
S.
dia. at root
and
tests see
page 93.
SCREW THREADS
Screw Threads
The standard
525
United States is
the Briggs. The thread has an angle of 60 degs., is rounded at
=
top and bottom, so that the depth of the thread
for Pipe.
in the
number
The thread
.8 dia.
is
of pipe
+ 4.8
then there
threads per inch
are two threads flat at the top but perfect at the bottom, and then
four threads imperfect at the top and bottom. The taper of the
on each side. In Great
P er -> that w
pipe at the end is re
number
ot
Am
is
Standard U.
Nominal
Size of
Pipe, Ins.
S.
Pipe Threads
MACHINERY
526
Packing and Gaskets for Pipe Flanges. The flanges are first
covered with plumbago or lamp black, and then the gasket put
Packon; after which the nuts on the flange bolts are tightened up.
ing comes in rolls from which the gaskets are cut, or the gaskets
can bo purchased already cut to size. For high-pressure superheated steam, a packing composed of long fiber asbestos and rubber
with a brass wire insertion has given satisfactory results. For lowIn some
pressure steam and cold water, rubber packings are used.
cases metal packing is required, and here corrugated copper has
given good service.
Make
is
a Tight Joint
PIPING SYSTEMS
527
copper
brass
Boiler feed
copper
copper or steel
copper or wrought iron
Steam
Exhaust steam
Main
drain
Steam heating
Ammonia and brine
wrought iron
wrought iron
wrought iron or mild
steel
is
fittings in
and
makes
it
The
for.
Figure 88.
MACHINERY
528
is
equivalent to
Valves, Cocks and Fittings are of cast iron, malleable iron, comThey may be
position, and of cast steel either screwed or flanged.
classified as follows:
1.
Low
3.
Medium
up
up to 125-175
lb.
per
square inch.
for working pressures up to 175-250 lb. per
inch.
square
5. Hydraulic for water pressure up to 800 lb.
4.
High pressure
sizes
up
hand wheel
rise
Valves of 6
ins.
and over
not be opened
if
An
CHECK VALVES
529
angle valve is a form of globe valve with the inlet at the bottom and
outlet at the side.
Check Valves.
When
always in
one direction check valves are installed, the valves closing themselves
should the direction of flow be changed. There are several forms on
the market, some with a swing valve, others spring controlled.
is
Gate Valves.
is less
Figure 89.
Reducing Valves.
To
Sometimes a valve of
Butterfly valves have the valve pivoted.
this type is placed near the engine throttle valve.
Is, however,
MACHINERY
530
they are
fitted.
and hence
it is
essential to select
SECTION
VII
ELECTRICITY
Ohm
14.452
grammes
ft.
given.
No. 20 B. and
124.4
19
150
18
239
16
380
605
961
1529
S.
ft.
No. 14 B. and
S.
12
10
Amperes
by
ohm,
will
Coulomb
quantity of electricity
a
current
of
one
in
one
second.
ampere
by
Farad, the unit of capacity, is the capacity of a conductor charged
to a potential of one volt by one coulomb of electricity.
transferred
per second.
Henry, the unit of induction, is the induction in the circuit
when the electromotive force induced in the circuit is one volt
531
ELECTRICITY
532
while the inducing current varies at the rate of one ampere per
second.
Let
C =
E =
R
Then C =
Amperes
current in amperes
electromotive force in volts
resistance in
E
y>
ohms
(often called
volts
746 watts
Ohm's Law)
watts
horse power
1 h. p.
One watt
746
one kilowatt (kw.)
1.34 h. p.
1,000 watts
2,654,200
ft.-lb.
44,240
ft.-lb.
737.3
ft.-lb.
One kilowatt =
per hour
per minute
per second
One megohm =
Voltage.This
1,000,000
is
ohms
either 100-110 or
and the
size of brushes
is
approximately halved.
The
better off low owing to the lamps being stronger and cheaper.
Small motors up to say Y2 h. p. are better suited for low voltage
owing to the
high.
difficulties in insulating
and construction
details for
ELECTRIC INSTALLATIONS
The
Ship
533
ELECTRICITY
534
"The
mersed.'
not
less
'
Sizes of
Wires
Number
of
Wires and
Gauge
in S. W. G.
or in Inches
is still
im-
535
The
B.
&
S.
Gauge Number
ELECTRICITY
536
The
volt loss
is
B.
&
S.
Wire
Gauge
COPPER WIRE
Copper Wire Table
Resistance per Mil-Foot 10.4
Ohms
at 75 F. (24 C.).
.0021 per degree F.
Temperature coefficient
Weight per cubic inch 0.321 lb.
Specific Gravity 8.9.
537
ELECTRICITY
538
Diameters in Mils.
Gauge Number
1 Mil.
0.001 Inch
WIRING SYSTEMS
How
Examples.
15 volts?
far will a
The constant
539
No.
the quotient
is
93G
Assume
is
ft.,
10.4
feet
is
10.4,
which
amperes
volts lost
Volts lost
AmpereS
10.4
feet
amperes
circular mils
X volts
X 2 X 10.4
circular mils
feet
lost
"
is
In the above, feet refers to the actual length of the circuit and
multiplied by 2 to obtain the total length of wire.
Size of wire for motor circuits.
Let
D =
E =
L =
Then
Wiring Systems.
three-wire system
h. p.
X 746 X D X
E XLX K
21.6
90), the
common
ELECTRICITY
540
Siv/fz/? Aoara*
f^arrcr/Ze/
lV/r//7j?
S tr/ftA /xrara*
o
oo
6
9r~P
o
Ser/es
Large
Mofor
<?
Sma//
L
f/earer)P\
IV/r/'r?^
Smcy//
Motor,
//eafer
1
7Y?ree lV/r&
Figure 90.
System
Wiring Diagrams.
Z-C//77/0
CONDUITS
than the
541
the load on each outer and keep low the out-of-balance current;
this also applies to small heaters.
Large motors are supplied from
voltage
is
and the center one, to balance each other and divide the current.
If the same number of lamps are run on each side, the middle wire
will carry no current, but should more lamps be switched in on one
side than on the other, the difference of current resulting will then
be carried by the central wire. All three wires are of the same size.
In the three-wire system the main switches and cut-outs are of the
three-pole type.
The
conductors on
and
all
ELECTRICITY
542
Electrical
Con-
United States.
Conduit
sizes
Number
Size
B.
Capacity
&S.
Amperes
One Wire in a
Conduit. Size
Conduit, Ins.
Inter'l
14
12
10
8
6
5
4
3
2
1
00
000
0000
15
20
25
35
50
55
70
80
90
100
125
150
175
CM.
250000
300000
400000
500000
600000
700000
800000
900000
1000000
1250000
1500000
1750000
2000000
237
275
325
400
450
500
550
600
650
750
850
950
1050
of
^2
H
H
H
l
l
m
Vi
iH
v/2
VA
2
2
2
2
V/2
VA
3
3
Exter'l
.84
.84
.84
.84
.84
1.05
1.05
05
05
1.05
1.31
1.31
1.31
1.66
1.66
1.66
1.66
1.9
1.9
2.37
2.37
2.37
2.37
2.87
2.87
3.5
3.5
Wires
in
Two
Inter'l
X
l
l
vx
VX
VX
VX
VA
VA
2
2
2
VA
Exter'l
Inter'l
.84
.84
1.05
1.05
1.31
1.66
1.66
1.66
1.66
1.9
1.9
IX
IX
IX
IX
VA
VA
2
2
2
VA
VA
VA
3
3
3
2.87
2.87
3.5
3.5
3.5
VA
VA
VA
4.
4.
4.
4.5
4.5
4A
5.
5.56
5.56
5
6
Exter'l
1.05
1.05
1.31
1.31
1.66
1.66
1.66
1.66
1.9
1.9
2.37
2.37
2.37
Duplex Wire
14
System
2.37
2.37
2.37
2.87
2 87
2 87
3 5
3
3
3 5
VA
VA
4.
4.
4
4
4
4.5
4.5
4.5
VA
5.
5.56
5.56
6.62
Inter'l
1
1
VA
Vi
1<2
VA
VA
2
2
Exter'l
1.05
1.05
1.31
1.31
1 66
1.66
1.9
1.9
1.9
.
V/2
2V2
V/2
2.37
2.37
2.87
2.87
2.87
3
3
3.5
3.5
VA
VA
4.
4.
SWITCHBOARDS
543
Switchboards
can be had to the back of the board. The size depends on the electric equipment of the vessel, and as to location the main switchboard should be in the same compartment as the generators. The
following
boards
is
list
of instruments
Main
switch,
in amperes.
magnetic
field,
ruptured at a
be easily renewed.
is
ELECTRICITY
544
Although engine sets cost less and have a slightly less steam
consumption when new than turbo sets, there are many advantages
in favor of the latter, as less space is required, and the foundations
for them need not be so heavy as the weight is less.
As to the rating of turbogenerators: The most economical
output of the turbine (i. e., the output at which it attains its maximum steam economy) should not correspond with the generator
In general,
rating in kilowatts except under special circumstances.
it will be found preferable, when ordering a combined set, to specify
that the most economical output of the turbine shall be equal to
80%
80%
something between
of the alternator
is
usu-
and the
rated output and the average output of the combined set should
It
clearly be the most economical output for the prime mover.
should further be stated that for mechanical reasons the steam inlets
should be capable of by-pass or otherwise of dealing continuously
with outputs of
12%
output which
is
40%
economical output as defined above. (From Report No. 72, Engineering Standards Committee, British.)
in excess of the
electrical
appliances
New York
or
compound.
WIRES
545
"Wires.
a.
Except at
fixtures,
and as provided in the preceding paragraph, splices and taps shall be made by means of approved
connection blocks enclosed in approved fittings. Those
fittings shall be located in readily accessible places and will
d.
Except at
fixtures,
Must be
where passing
work on the
Pull boxes
vessel has been, as far as possible, completed.
shall be installed at sufficient intervals to permit of the draw-
undue
strain.
Must when
injury.
Where
metallic
Must
Portable Conductors.
ELECTRICITY
546
manently and
effectually grounded.
It is strongly
ground detector.
Must be
living spaces, be enclosed in moisture proof cases.
arranged to break all poles of the circuit and must not be
located in bunkers or other inaccessible places.
b. Must be so arranged that each freight compartment
may
c.
Must be
else-
MOTORS
b. Signal circuits shall in
547
lights.
outlet
is
3%.
Feeders
are led direct from the main switchboard to a double-pole switch and cut-out placed in the line to
protect the starting box and motor. The cut-out switch and
double-pole switch are not necessary for motors of 34 h. p. or less.
There is briefly outlined, below, the circuits a steamer of about
400 ft. long might be divided into. Directly following this section
is one on Motor Boat Circuits and abstracts from Lloyd's Rules.
Motor
Circuits.
marked
and painted
red, while
(1)
ship
is
Forward
circuit,
etc.
usually
ELECTRICITY
548
(9)
Miscellaneous
machinery.
It is not necessary for
all
and laundry
by sepa-
that
is,
and
It is impossible to give
required, owing to the variation in the sizes and shapes of machinery spaces on different ships, but on an average a fairly good
light
ft.
apart.
light,
When
or one or
(4)
alike,
FORWARD CIRCUIT
549
ing board on the starboard side and to another board on the port
side.
Forward Circuit. Here the cables from the main board run
From the latter is the circuit for lighting the
to a board forward.
(6)
various compartments.
be installed
From
board will be
Invariably small motors will
light and power.
for running laundry machinery, and other machinery
Amidship
circuits for both
(7)
Circuit.
the distribution
in the galley.
(8) After Circuit.
(9)
General
is
on
large vessels
electric motors, and there
re-
quiring motors.
depends on the
For incandescent lamps and
"The main
cuits.
If
the switchboard
19
is
ELECTRICITY
550
be incombustible.
"All fuses should be of easily fusible and non-oxidizable metal,,
and be so proportioned as to melt with a current 100% in excess
in watertight boxes
The
An
by means
would be used
of suitable connections at
the switchboard,
Where
should be in conduits.
The
be one of 6
As a
45-ft.
electric
motors, except perhaps small ventilating fans that could be attached to lamp sockets, there would be only one distributing circuit
from the switchboard and that would be for lighting. The parallel
system would be adopted, on which would be the running lights and
GASOLINE ENGINES
551
c.
p.
Mazda lamps
anchor light
2
c.
p.
(see
c. p.,
p.
The
cutting out the batteries, and the current generated by the magneto (driven by the engine) would go to the spark coil, thence to
the spark plug as before with a return wire connection from the enIf the engine has two cylinders there would
gine to the magneto.
be two spark coils, one for each, making two connections to the
timer, one for each cylinder; otherwise the wiring is the same.
A make and break system for a single-cylinder motor is as fol-
Starting from the battery, then the switch, coil, and wire
to make-and-break connection on the side of the cylinder, with a
lows:
neto.
If
coil.
ELECTRICITY
552
Common
volts.
sizes of incan-
16
c.
p. of
110
The
Incandescent Lamps
(Direct Current)
Carbon
Volta
SEARCHLIGHTS
553
The lower
power
it
gives.
miles, the 19-inch 13^ to 2 miles, the 24-inch 3 miles, the 32- inch
4 miles, and the 38-inch 5 miles. Under the most favorable condi-
may
preferred) by
means of hand wheels, gears and shafting; and (3) the distant electric,
where the searchlight is moved by electric motors, the controller
if
Both
554
ELECTRICITY
Searchlights
Diameter of
Shell
Inches
NORMAL CAPACITY
555
when
is
battery
is
fully
The
voltage
is
from
2.
to 2.5 volts,
in
down
to the limiting voltage specified by the battery manuIn lead cells this limiting voltage may be taken at 1.75
facturer.
The watt-hour capacity of a battery is equal to the
volts per cell.
70 F.,
To
avoid
this,
ordinarily experienced.
Quite different from the lead storage battery is the one manufactured by the Edison Storage Battery Company. Here the
positive plate is a steel grid with steel tubes containing nickel hydrate and metallic nickel, and the negative plate a steel grid with
steel
The
electrolyte
is
an alkaline
solution in water.
ELECTRICITY
556
out of commission there
first
in 7 hours at
is
normal
may
rate.
BATTERY CELLS
557
from which
it
was drawn.
run down or discharged, below 1,200 but above 1,150 less than half
charged, and above 1,200 more than half charged.
A battery charge is complete when, with charging current flowing
at the rate given on the instruction sheet on the battery, all cells
are gassing (bubbling) freely and evenly and the gravity of all
The gravity
cells has shown no further rise during one hour.
of the solution in cells fully charged as just
mentioned
is
1,275 to
1,300.
The
Grouping
battery which
of Battery Cells,
(1)
is
Series.
When
it
is
first
desired to
number
of cells required to
are connected.
Multiple.
If it is desired to
ELECTRICITY
558
speed type, particulars of which are given in the table on page 559.
On the same page are sizes of turbogenerator sets, and it should
be noted that they are much lighter in weight. In large U. S. steam-
is
an emergency."
is seldom obtainable, so
units
the gasoline
invariably charge storage batteries which furnish the current direct to the lamps.
To
find the
Let
=
=
=
V
G
M
Then h p
-
voltage
efficiency of the generator taken as .9 to .95
efficiency of the engine taken as .85 to .90
=
746
Kilowatts (kw.)
X M
X v
XG
1,000
h. p.
kw.
746
1,000
XG
SIZES
Sizes.
The
559
on
gasoline,
steam engine,
Gasoline
Kw.
560
ELECTRICITY
Turbines
VIOLENT SPARKING
at high speeds, be sure that the lubrication
oil cups filled before starting.
561
is
reliable,
and the
Keep
all
small tools
oil
cans.
generator.
Violent sparking of the commutator may be caused by a broken
armature coil or a broken armature and commutator connection.
If the pressure
the sparking may be due to a dirty commutator.
of the brushes on the commutator is too light, they may jump
and run irregularly, thus causing sparking.
is
up.
if
is,
To remedy
this fails to
turn them
this, either
tap
commutator
In starting
it
is
all
power.
speed
being
proportional
to
the
load.
They
are
suitable
for
ELECTRICITY
562
elevators
to be constantly started
and
stopped.
Motors
sizes
for ship
having starting
The type
of
frame
selected, viz.,
The primary
object of the interpoles is to assist in the commutation so that all sparking may be avoided.
Where the duty is ex-
tremely
light, or
where the
series
is suffi-
To
Power
of Motors.
Direct current
'
volts
amperes
motor
efficiency
746
Alternating current
Average motor
Weight
of
efficiency
Motors.
85%.
The following
table, furnished
by the B.
F.
SHIP MOTORS
Sizes
Speed
563
ELECTRICITY
564
Current Taken by
Horse Power
110- Volt
ELECTRIC CAPSTAN
Gun
Elevating Motors.
565
Shunt wound.
Motor
a circuit
and Controlling Devices.* A rheostat is an inreducing the amount of current passing through
Starting
by interposing
resistance in
it.
a device for making the proper electrical connections between the main supply lines and a motor, so as to control
the direction and speed of rotation. They are for the control of
heavy currents in motors of above 10 h. p., as in such equipments
as boat cranes, deck winches, turret turning motors, ammunition
hoists, and in general where there are continuous starting and
controller
is
New York
The
and are
B and P
types.
method of operation,
and controlling the speed
They are particularly adapted for motors that carry
of motors.
ture or load,
and
in this
way
reduces
its
speed or stops
is,
the
arma-
itself.
On
ELECTRICITY
566
be signaled.
Electric Heaters and Cooking Devices, see page 573.
Electric Turbine Propulsion, see Turbines.
Electric Steering Gear, Capstans, etc., see Ship Machinery.
Heating by Electricity, see Heating.
SECTION
VIII
Calculate the
Bulkhead. Assume
30 for the sea and 40 for the air outside the staterooms, as the
air in the passageways is about 10 above that of the outside atmosphere.
t.
u.
ship.
From
B.
t.
u.
is
fitted
and that
567
HEATING
568
40
.5
B.
t.
u.
remaining 556
96
sq. ft.
1,920 B.
t.
u.
'
13.5.
for the
heater
must
'
deliver
total B.
1.7 (temp, of
13,040
1.7 (210
(The above
is
~
30)
u. lost
p
4Z,b
Sq
'
u
tX"
t.
by steam, hot
of Ships, C. B. Walker.)
air
(thermotanks), and by
inch seamless
drawn brass
RADIATORS
569
size,
Pilot
Captain's
cabin,
bath
staterooms,
closet
Cubic Feet
50
and water
60
60
80
80
Storerooms
100
80
Dispensary
Berth and main decks forward of barbettes, crew's
100
lavatory
Main deck inside armor
100
125
Steering engine room
Berth deck and inside redoubt
125
Radiators and heaters will be arranged in circuits, each circuit
being so connected that it can be operated independently of the
other.
all
the heaters.
This trap shall be connected up and provided with a suitable byA branch shall be led outboard.
pass.
"AH heater pipes shall be of wrought iron, and so led that there
will be no pockets where water can collect.
"The area of the radiators shall be apportioned as follows:
Chart room,
square foot to 30
square foot to 60
1 square foot to 60
1 square foot to 50
one small heater in
one small heater in
1
Captain's cabin,
Wardroom,
Crew's quarters,
Officers' rooms,
Petty officers' rooms,
cubic
cubic
cubic
cubic
feet
feet
feet
feet
each
each room
HEATING
570
paratively
gives off heat at the rate of 1.7 B. t. u. (1.6 to
1.8 or 1.7 average) per square foot per degree difference between
the temperature of the surrounding air and the average temperastill air
medium per
hour.
This
is
To
find the square feet of radiation for any room, divide the
calculated heat loss in British thermal units per hour by the quantity 1.7 times the difference in temperature between the inside
of the radiator.
Thus
One square
is
often estimated
hour.
t =
1.67 B.
This factor
radiator
and
t.
is
difference in temperature.
THERMOTANKS
571
Type
of
Radiator
1-column
2-column
3-column
4-column
22 Ins.
26 Ins.
32 Ins.
.90
1.86
1.75
1.65
1.55
1.83
1.71
1.60
1.50
1.80
1 .70
1
60
Window
radiator
Wall radiator, horizontal.
38
Ins.
1.80
1.67
1.54
1.45
1.85
1.95
1.90
2.00
of Pipe, Ins.
572
HEATING
z
o
I
UJ
-I
UJ
HEATING BY ELECTRICITY
573
=
R =
C =
E =
Let
Then
current in amperes
the difference of pressure in volts at the terminals of
the conductor or heater
Hence C2
X R X
E
= C2 X ~
Xt =
= C X R X
2
= E
= E
-5- and R
7T
E V
CxEXt= ^-^
2
As
Suppose
it is
For electric heating there are two kinds of radiators, viz., luminous and non-luminous. The former are practically several large
incandescent lamps, the light from which is of secondary importance to the heat given
service, as removing the
it
is
chill
Device
Frying pan
Toaster
Tea samovar
380
500
800
500
500
3,000
300
500
500
HEATING
574
principle
On page
stoves, coffee percolators, and other domestic appliances.
573 is a table showing the current, which should be 110 volts, required
for various devices.
Special Systems.
Among
for
heating
is
the Nuvacuumette
the outlet of the radiator. This method causes the vacuum carried
in the return pipes to extend into the radiator itself, making it
possible completely to fill the radiator with water vapor at a temperature of 180 F. In large installations a vacuum pump is provided which may be dispensed with in small. The pump is placed
Figure 92.
Coils.
VENTILATION
575
end of the return condensed vapor main into which all the
returns from the heating units are directly connected without the
A further development of the above
interposition of any valve.
is the fitting, on the inlet to the radiator, of a device which automatically shuts off the supply of steam when the temperature has
reached a predetermined point, and should it fall below, the valve
opens allowing steam to enter.
Another system sold under the trade name Highlow (A. Low &
Sons, Glasgow) has been installed on many steamers. The pressure in the steam mains may be from 5 to 50 lb., and the supply
may be taken at the same pressure as other auxiliaries, or a connection may be taken from the exhaust main and the vessel
heated by exhaust steam. The advantage of having steam at a
high pressure instead of a pound or two is that smaller mains may
be fitted. Each radiator is fitted with an exhaust valve. The steam
mains are usually carried overhead and the exhaust mains below.
The steam enters the radiator through a stop valve and then a
at the
possible
breakdown
of this
pump
a connection
is
made
to the con-
lator
is
the desired
vacuum
is
overboard.
is
discharged directly
This arrangement saves weight, that is, the weight of
its fittings.
VENTILATION
Sea air, which is taken as the purest form of air, contains about
3 volumes of carbonic acid gas in 10,000 volumes of air. The limit
on shore is from 8 to 10 volumes in 10,000 of air.
For perfect ventilation the air should circulate at a velocity of
HEATING
576
from 4 to 6
ft.
per second.
making apparatus
is
air.
An
1,800 cu.
ft.
from
air
different
of air
is
compartments
the
of
Minutes
10 to 12
4 to 6
8 to 12
6 to 8
Staterooms
Magazines
Engine room
Ice machine room
2
3
Dynamo rooms
The
shut
off.
Air Pressure.
This
is
liner,
measured by a
the bent portion, one end of the tube being open to the air and the
other connected to the duct whose pressure is to be measured.
The readings are inches and fractions; thus a reading of 1 in. water
gauge
ume
is
delivered.
certain pressure
is
resistance
PRESSURE IN OUNCES
577
Pressure in Ounces per Square Inch, Corresponding to Various Heads of Water in Inches
HEATING
578
is
about 212 F. To maintain the purity of the air in the various compartments, exhaust fans draw out the vitiated air. In hot climates
the air heaters are transformed into coolers by passing through them
a cooling mixture.
Ventilation of Oil Steamers. Upon emptying an oil tank quantities of gas are given off from the oily bulkheads, and as this gas
is about three times as heavy as air it accumulates and lies at the
bottom. This may be removed by using as conduits the large oil
oil is
To
rfl^Hi
Figure 93.
Arrangement
for Ventilating
Engine Room.
'
VENTILATORS
579
may
Engine
Room
Ventilation.
Here,
if
natural ventilation
is
relied
on, the ventilators should extend as far down in the engine room
as practical without interfering with the machinery, with branches,
if feasible, to both sides of the ship.
In large vessels there may be
On
liners
(Aquilania
open fans as shown in Fig. 93. When desired the air may
be changed 120 times an hour without uncomfortable drafts. The
air is drawn, not forced, down from the upper deck and is delivered
latterly by an open fan which is placed as low down in the engine
room as practical so as to flood the entire engine room with air,
the cool incoming air falling towards the floor displacing the heated
air and expelling it up the main hatch or hatches or other exits,
no exhaust fans being required. The impellers for these open fans
are scooped on the inlet side and are of such shape that they slice
into the incoming air and divert it gently from the axial into the
Outfits as just outlined are built by J. Keith
radial direction.
& Blackman, London.
Ventilators.
These may consist of cylindrical steel plates extending to just below the deck, with an upper part that can be
turned by hand so the mouth of the ventilator can face any direcThis type is for holds, engine and boiler rooms. Instead of
tion.
the large mouth there may be vertical flues, which type is used for
galleys, while for staterooms those with a mushroom top that can be
raised and lowered by a screw are often installed.
The ventilators
to the firerooms of some torpedo boat destroyers have a cylindrical
part of steel plates riveted to the deck and a hinged top. In bad
weather the top can be brought down so that it is horizontal, and
air may enter between the top and the cylindrical sides.
Ventilators to stokeholds should have an aggregate transverse
area of .45 sq. in. for each pound of fuel burned per hour, or .675
sq. in. per i. h. p. for ordinary merchant vessels, or .75 sq. in. per
i.
h. p. for fast steamers on short runs and for warships.
The
large
HEATING
580
areas of the ventilator
proportions:
Sq. in per
pound
of fuel
less
PROPELLER FAN
581
Another type of multivane fan is one where the blades are curved
radially, and in addition each blade has several cup-shaped depressions which grip the air and overcome largely the tendency of
the air to slip along the blades to the side opposite the inlet. This
type is very efficient and is built by the B. F. Sturtevant Co.,
Hyde Park, Mass.
In other fans the blades are shaped somewhat like a screw proWhile the air is being rotated,
peller and the action is the same.
same
Figure 94.
They
are reversible.
Propeller Fan.
HEATING
582
coils,
ft.
To Find
the Horse
Power Required
^^
to
>
3 3,000
horse power for the air only. Hence in estimating the actual h. p.
required, the result obtained from the formula should be doubled.
For practical purposes the capacity of a fan in cubic feet per
revolution will equal .4 the cube of the diameter in feet. The
volume of air delivered by a fan varies directly as the speed, while
the power required varies as the cube of the speed. That is, doubling the
is
air,
sides increases with the square of the velocity of the flow, so if the
velocity is doubled the loss due to friction is increased four times.
.The smaller the duct the greater is the resistance to the air.
In galvanized iron, pipe turns of 90 should be constructed with
at least 5 pieces and with a radius of curvature on the inner side of
the elbow at least equal to the diameter of the pipe.
Branches should
lead from the
main duct
not be suddenly changed. Whennecessary to change the size of a pipe, this should be done
ever
it is
branch
will
Velocity,
Pressure
in
Ounces
per Square
Inch
HEATING
584
and the
size of
the
in Square Inches, for 1,000 Cubic Feet op Contents for Given Velocity and Air Change
Duct Area,
(B. F. Sturtevant
Number of
Company)
POSITIVE CIRCULATION
585
HEATING
586
pressure of 5
lb. is
standard density.
ft.
of air of
As the branches
HF
Where Hf =
F =
L =
=
d
Vi =
\F~a Fi
is
=
area
due to
friction
becomes
'
11,250,000 d
two
a thorough ventilation
of the cargo is desired, one of the two ventilators should extend to
the bottom of the hold and the other to the deck only, but generally
If
the hold
is
pairs.
If
is sufficient,
REFRIGERATION
587
REFRIGERATION
Different substances require different temperatures for their preservation.
Mutton, lamb, rabbits, and some other meats may be
frozen hard
and
if
eatable,
merely
carefully
is,
so high a price as if
reduced to a temperature a little above the
Dry
still
air is the
best insulator
known and
cotton or slag wool (obtained from the slag iron melting furnaces),
and finely divided charcoal. See Insulating Materials.
insulation
dioxide
"The
(C0 2 )
mineral wool.
The
and groove boards. The 9-in. space between the boards and the
shell plating was tightly packed with regranulated cork. Over the
%-in. boarding was placed lj^-in. sheet cork with nailing strips,
and the whole covered with waterproof paper and a layer of 1 3^-in.
tongue and groove boards, thus making an over-all thickness of
approximately
"
The
12^
ins.
in.
by
in.
groove boards.
Degrees
Fahrenheit
33-42
32-36
40
33-35
34-35
32-40
35-39
32-42
45
35-40
40-42
14-38
20-35
32-35
40
33-35
32-35
28-35
33-40
32-40
35-42
45-50
42
32-36
35
38-40
32
45-55
30-35
28
35-55
20-30
14-17
35
35-40
5
36-46
26-55
35-40
30-35
25-32
35
32-40
35-36
20*35
30-35
32-40
Ale
Apples
Apple and peach butter
Asparagus
Bananas
Beans
Beef (fresh)
Beer in casks
Beer in bottles
Berries (fresh)
Buckwheat
flour
Butter
Butterine
Cabbages
Cantaloupes
Carrots
Celery
Cheese
Chestnuts
Cider
Cigars
Clarets.
Corn meal
Cranberries
Cream
Cucumbers
Currants
Dates
Eggs.
Ferns
Figs
Fish (fresh)
Fish (frozen)
Fish (canned)
Fish (dried)
Fish (to freeze)
Flour
Fruits
Fruits (dried)
Fruits (canned)
Furs (dressed)
Furs (undressed)
Grapes
Ginger
ale
Hams
Hogs
Hops
* Sanitary Refrigeration
and
Ice
Degrees
Fahrenheit
Substance
Hops (frozen)
Honey
'.
28
36-45
34-35
33-45
30
40-45
18-35
35-40
30-35
34-40
35
32
33-36
25-28
35-40
40-42
20-35
35-45
32-40
25-35
33-43
32
32-35
34-55
40-45
32-40
33-42
34
34-40
20-40
5-22
Lard
Lemons
Liver
Meat
Meat
Meat
(brined)
(canned)
(fresh)
Melons
Milk
Mutton
Mutton
(frozen)
Nuts in shell
Oatmeal
Oleomargarine
Oil
Onions
Oysters in tubs
Oysters in shells
Oxtails
'.
Parsnips
Peaches
Pears
Plums
Porter
Pork
Potatoes
Poultry (frozen)
Poultry (to freeze) ....
Poultry (long storage)
Sardines
Sauerkraut
Sausage casings
Sugar
Syrup
Tenderloin
Tomatoes
Tobacco
Veal
Vegetables
Watermelons
Wheat
flour
Wines
Woolens
Making,
588
J. J.
Cosgrove.
10
35-40
35-38
30-35
40-45
35-45
30-35
32-42
35-42
32-36
34-40
34-40
40-42
40-50
25-35
STEAM ENGINE;
CXHAUST
589
HEATING
590
ooooooo oooooooo
r\ r\ r\ r\ c\ r\
*~\
m
d
o
a
ft
\*J \J \J \J \J \J w
IOOOOOOOOOOOOOO
"It
p
CD
L i ffi\X
9
%
^
fshs
COMPRESSION SYSTEM
591
margin plate at 4
ft.
from the
shell,
"The insulation in way of beam knees was left portable for easy
renewal of insulation filling in case of settlement. The bulkheads
were insulated, the boiler and engine room bulkheads being insulated
with mineral wool to minimize the danger of fire. The insulated
limber hatches extended the whole length of the bilges. They had
frames and coamings working from solid timbers. Each hatch
section was 6 ft. long and had two lifting rings.
All the steel work
was galvanized.
wood
on the
ceilings,
'
International
592
HEATING
o
a
a.'
be
3
pq
oooooooo
oooooooo.
oooooooo
oooooooo
oooooooo
fe
>
P?
eJ
oooooooot
l^n\f).
o o o o o o o
1
a
ft
<5r
EXPANSION
flows to the receiving tank
to commence again its cycle.
593
merged
in a solution of brine.
and
The
its
liquid
chief
ammonia
or cooler,
is
pumped through
partment.
When
down
desired to shut
On
HEATING
594
pressure necessary, ranging from 200 to 1,000 lb. per square inch,
while ammonia at a gauge pressure slightly above 15 lb. can be liquefied at a temperature of 0 F. Ammonia, if it escapes, has the disad-
coil.
be noted that the higher the sea temperature the higher the
pressure required in the compressor. Ammonia (NH 3 ) evaporates
at
28 F. when the pressure is 14.7 lb. (atmospheric), and has a
latent heat of evaporation of 555 B. t. u. Carbonic anhydride evaporates at
110 when the pressure is 14 .7 lb., and has a latent heat
of evaporation of 130 B. t. u.
The following is a description of apparatus using C0 2 as built by
It is to
&
is
it
COOLING BY AIR
either
by a steam
cylinder or
by an
electric
595
motor.
Modern war
Refrigerating Capacity
HEATING
596
the air compressor, where it is again compressed and the cycle just
outlined is gone through again. The machines are built in J^-, 1-,
2-
and 3-ton
sizes.
Figure 98.
A
in a
meat chamber
2%
l
surface for every 2 /i
to
sq. ft. of interior surface of a well insuThe piping should
lated meat chamber, omitting interior divisions.
air is
compelled to pass
all
surfaces with a
fair velocity.
Pipe, Valves, and Fittings for refrigerant piping are different from
steam and water. If the refrigerant is ammonia, no brass enters
The operating
into the design of any part of the valves and fittings.
principles of the valves are the same as for steam and water but they
are
made
On
operate, extra strong wrought iron pipe is used for ammonia and
double extra strong for CO2. Ordinary steam and water fittings are
suitable for brine circulation.
For
where
the room to be
30
correspond to ==
1.5 B.
t.
u.
AMMONIA COMPRESSORS
How many
Example.
linear feet of
1% -inch
597
would be
and 20 respectively?
stant of
5 allowed.
Total B.
1.5
8,000
= 355
1.5(15-30)
Circumference of 134 -inch pipe
5.2 X 12 - 62.4 sq. ins. or .43 sq.
Then
t.
u. lost
=5.2
ins.,
sq. ft.
hence
1 ft. of
ft.
355.
'
825.
ft.
(nearly) of
x
/i ins.
required.
pipe
4o
[Above from Cold Storage, Heating and Ventilating,
.
S. F.
Walker.]
depends upon the efficiency of the compressor and upon the suction
pressure or the pressure at which the gas is delivered into the compressor.
allowance
is
made
HEATING
598
TO
TO
^>
bO
STORED GOODS
599
How many
Example.
when
Area
Area
room 40
of wall
of floor
and
+ 40
4-
ceiling
[40
50
40
4- 50]
50
- 2160
= 4000
X 12
X 2
6160
Temperature outside, 70 F.
35
Temperature inside,
35
Difference
(T
H= 3A
Substituting in formula
There are 284,000 B.
=3 X 6160
t)
(70
35) = 646,800 B.
t.
u.
u. to
An
empirical formula
2,000 cu.
ft.
is
more
for large.
is
required
Let
= number of
required
=
S =
T =
=
H =
S would
S, Wi Si, etc., refer to different goods, as
heat
of
the
the
times
the
weight
beef, W\ Si
weight
equal
specific
times the specific heat of pork, etc.
etc.,
where
Example. Find the refrigeration required to cool 25,000 lb. of lean beef from a
temperature of 95 F. to 35 F.
From the table of Specific Heats the specific heat of beef above the freezing point
is 77, and the difference in temperature between 95 and 35 = 60.
Substituting
.
WS
(T
t)
25,000
From
.77
._
60
number
1,155,000 B.
of B.
t.
u. in
t.
u.
a ton of refrigeration),
>
4 06 tons.
.
J. J.
Cosgrove.
HEATING
600
Specific
Substance
DRAINAGE SYSTEM
The power required
for
refrigerating machinery
2. h. p. per ton of refrigeration up to 5. h. p.
601
varies
from
Meat and
linen bag.
entirely apart
the circulating sea water, the latter having the lower temperature
so that the excess heat picked up by the refrigerant from the brine
in the evaporator may be transferred to the circulating water and
so carried overboard.
proportion.
per square inch, so that the higher the sea temperature the higher
the pressure required in the compressor to maintain the necessary
difference in temperature.
and Estimates.
DRAINAGE SYSTEM
For removing the water that collects in the bilges from the
sweating of the hull and other causes, a drainage system is necesIn motor boats and other small craft a portable pump
sary.
with a rubber suction pipe is all that is required. In larger vessels
the pump is permanently fastened to the deck with pipes leading
In both cases the pumps are hand operated.
to the bilge.
For vessels say 120 ft. or over there is required a steam-driven
pump, and often other pumps, as the donkey, are connected to the
HEATING
602
drainage system,
manifold.
* **-? * ** " .r
"-"
into the
pump.
is
'
Drain pipes
may
room
room bulkheads, screw-down valves at the other main bulkheads, and screw-down non-return valves at the end of each branch.
Besides the main there is an auxiliary drain
Auxiliary Drain.
engine
about 6
ins. in
line.
*<
'
The
auxiliary drain has screw-down valves at each main bulkhead, screw-down non-return valves to the branches to the compartments, and similar valves to the double bottom. To pump
tween the
pump and
pump and
the
main
suction,
It is necessary that
LLOYD'S RULES
603
all
the
air
through them.
turn
is
With
pump and
this
Figure 99.
be not
less
than
HEATING
604
easily accessible.
pump
are to
the donkey
pump
is
pumps
If not
tanks, a separate steam pump suction is to be led to each.
used for water ballast an efficient pump is to be fitted in the fore
"Tunnel.
suction.
The
tunnel well
is
to be fitted with a
pumps when
steam
pump
HAND PUMPS
"All
005
Hand Pumps
upper or main
the pump chambers are not to be more than 24 ft. above the suction
rose and the pumps are to be tested by the surveyors to ensure
that water can be pumped from the limbers. The sizes of the hand
pumps are to be not less than those in the following table:
HEATING
606
"In cases where more than one suction to any one compartment
are connected to the pumps by a single pipe, this pipe should be
not
less
than the
on to the
and from the fire and bilge pumps. The double bottom spaces
are drained from one to the other through drain holes cut in the nonwatertight longitudinals, and sluice valves are fitted on the waterTo allow the air to escape from the double
tight longitudinals.
bottom compartments while they are being filled with water, escape
pipes are fitted at the top of each compartment.
PLUMBING
Under
copper.
For motor boats and small yachts a wash stand with a tank on
top, or a pitcher nearby, serves to hold the fresh water, the dis-
charge from the basin running into a pail below. Others are made
Some
so as to fold up, thus taking up a minimum amount of room.
have hand pumps which draw the water from the fresh water
tanks; others have faucets, thus requiring the water to be under
pressure.
SINKS
607
lined with porcelain enamel; and the cheapest, tinned sheet copper
Sizes about 5 ft. long, 2 ft. 5 ins. wide
lining over a cast iron base.
by 2
ft.
Sinks
high.
for kitchen
little
them, and are deeper than shore outfits. The kitchen sinks are
of cast iron or sheet metal and the pantry of copper.
Figure 100.Closet.
(J. L.
Molt Co.,
New
York.)
In the latter
(2)
is
forced out.
Closets with a pressure discharge are usually installed on large vesone maker advises that he has furnished more syphon closets
sels,
Pump
608
HEATING
WASTE LINES
609
necessary to do
is
to turn
The
pressure in
ft.,
Fig. 101
off
HEATING
610
Or instead
of the
above there
As
consist of a casing in
which
built
is
may
be calorifiers located in
by A.
differ-
Low &
or nickel plated.
tests.
Size of Calorifier
The
FIRE MAIN
611
when
she
is
pump which
afloat.
shall
boat-Inspection
Every steamer
be of
shall also
and
Steam-
sufficient strength
(Abstracts from U.
S.
Main
main
line so that
any
riser
can be shut
off if desired.
special
fire
down.
The
S.
fire
pumps
over 20 tons and not exceeding 1.50 gross tons shall have not less
than 50 cu. ins. pump cylinder capacity. Steamers of over 150 gross
tons and under 3,000 tons shall have not less than one-third of one
Steamers
cylinder capacity for every gross ton.
of 3,000 gross tons and over shall have pump cylinder, of not less
cubic inch
pump
every such pump shall be fitted with a gauge and a relief valve
adjusted to lift 100 lb.
"All steam fire pumps required shall be supplied with connecting
pipes leading to the hold of the vessel with stopcocks or shut-off
valves attached and so arranged that such pumps may be used
for pumping and discharging water overboard from the hold.
"All fire hose shall be tested to a pressure of 100 lb. to the square
inch at each inspection. "
612
HEATING
Water Streams
Discharge from Nozzles at Different Pressures
Nozzle,
Dia. Ins.
SPRINKLER SYSTEMS
613
pipe of sufficient area to supply all branch pipes leading from the
same to the tanks may be run the entire length of the deck, and
only the main stop valve of the main line shall be required to be
All branch pipes shall be provided with valves which shall
be left open at all times, so that the steam may enter all compart-
housed.
ments simultaneously.
after the fire
is
definitely located
may
One of the
pumped and that
destination.
only
is
is
HEATING
614
which 23^-in. branch pipes extend to 2 ft. from the floor of each
The vertical branch pipes are laid well up against the bulkheads or against the ship's frames. All the piping is of galvanized
hold.
iron.
Sprinkler Systems. There are two types, viz., the wet and the
dry pipe. In the former, water is always in the pipes and when
the valves open, due to the rise in temperature caused by a fire, it
rushes out at once. One of the disadvantages of this system is
the pipes are not well covered the water will freeze in
winter and burst them.
that
if
sufficient
by a
New
SECTION IX
SHIP EQUIPMENT
neuvering the ship; (3) to give way before any abnormal stress
such as caused by a wave, and automatically to return to its former
position; (4) to be absolutely reliable; and (5) to be economical.
Savings of as much as 6% of the running distance of vessel per
annum can be
chain to the
tiller
drum which
is
turned
by a
and Transmission.
Usually eight turns of the steam steering wheel are required to
put the rudder from hard over on one side to hard over on the other,
and 24 turns on the hand wheel are required on some vessels and
16 on others.
For steamers 250 ft. in length Lloyd's rules state "that they
are to be fitted with two independent steering gears, one of which
must be a steam or other mechanical steering gear, and it is recommended that the two controlling wheels of the mechanical gear be
placed one at the gear and the other one on the navigating bridge."
Steam
off
615
616
SHIP EQUIPMENT
Steam Steering Engines (Steam Only Type)*
(American Engineering Co.)
Cylinders
Ins.
STEERING ARRANGEMENTS
or
617
B
~ng/ne
Steer,/7y ffeer//?^
Q.
S/ng/^
/^t/rcryc/se
-^"
/7^//fe
O-
M7/74/M Steam
freer/rrp 5feer/r?f
Q.
Dot//>/e ft/rc/pcrse
(j
<L
_t
/"//9
tVa/trf*
y,/7e
^/ea'/77
$feer//?y ffeer/'/To
J*
Q_
2)ot/6/e /l//'C//C7Se
Figure 102.
-//a>r>e7''Sfeer
a
vry ca/? 6e c//'zco/?r?ec/ec/
SHIP EQUIPMENT
618
Installations
Type
Tugs up
lighters
lighters
and tugs
and tugs
Rated H. P. as
Length*
installed
by Dake Engine Co
H. P.
of
Perpendiculars,
Steering
Feet
Engine
80
to
Steam
Steam
Length Between
of Vessel *
100
80-100
100-140
190-210
5
5
7
10
15
;J**
e
t
^
o
p r^ LU
^
gg
-.
*^
* _
.d
-<
O,
a
&
w
a
c
4>
op
619
SHIP EQUIPMENT
G20
normal
One
position.
Brown steam
tiller.
and the standard in the pilot house are undesirable owing to the
settling and moving of the decks resulting in throwing the shafting
SHAFT TRANSMISSION
Figure 104a.
Plan of Steering
page 622.
out of
sists of
rope,
line.
621
ported on rollers and has a rack fitted at each end. These racks engage with pinions of which the forward one rotated by the wheel in
the pilot house gives endwise motion to the shaft. The motion thus
transmitted rotates the after pinion, thus controlling the opening of
the steam valve by operating through suitable lever connections.
SHIP EQUIPMENT
622
Figure 104b.
is
oil.
Some
Calculate the
m =
Let
to
of a Vessel.
moment
A =
V =
=
Power Required
623
constant = 2.8523
angle rudder makes with center line of boat
C =
=
6
Then m =
AxCXV XdX
2
(sin 6)
will give the strain on the rope and the reovercome by the steering engine.
When the steering engine is of the usual two-cylinder type with
cranks at right angles the American Bureau of Shipping gives the
sistance to be
formula
yd In
2
2,000
D=
To
to
by the man
by about 100 or 125 lb. Rudders in large steamseldom turn beyond 15 on account of the power required to
turn them.
The
correction for
tt:
is
area of rudder.
22 2
equal areas
is
-^
484
^rj
Moment to be resisted =
,
where d
1.5,
that
3.1416rf3
=^
16
X
v
is,
an increase of 50%.
r~z
factor of safety
"
SHIP EQUIPMENT
624
The moment
the engine, as
1 unit of work
1
horse
=
power =
power
of
foot-pound
550 units per second, or 33,000
ft.-lb.
per min-
ute.
be
550
Where d
D =
R =
given by
= .4 JU ~
The diameter
Windlasses
is
by the above
be steam or
than
rule.
may
electric driven,
weight will take the chain from the locker, the wildcat being
unlocked from the windlass shaft.
As to methods of drive, this may be by spur gears, worm and
wheel, or by messenger chain. Among the advantages claimed by
its
BRAKE WINDLASSES
625
pawl. As a guide for setting a stopper, draw a line from the bottom
of the hawse pipe to a point 4 ins. above the bottom of the chain
groove in the wildcat. Place wood chocks on this line and bolt
them
Then
per minute.
for lifting slack cable should not exceed 38 ft. per minute.
A windlass is sometimes combined with a capstan; that is, the
windlass is on one deck and on the deck above is the capstan driven
from the windlass shaft by means of bevel gears and a vertical
Speed
Speed
ft.
shaft.
gear, built
Size of
Chain
Ins.
worm and
SHIP EQUIPMENT
626
may
is
when the
load
is
627
The gear
In hoist-
Friction geared winches are designed for fast hoisting and quick
They are adapted for general cargo and wharf puroperation.
poses and are faster than spur-geared winches. The weight hoisted
is thus less for a given size of engine but the speed is correspondingly greater.
SHIP EQUIPMENT
628
or
is
Electric Winches
Drums
WARPING WINCH
Dimensions A,
and
629
C, to be in inches
Rule:
the depth of flange A to diameter of drum B.
Multiply the sum by the depth of the flange A.
Multiply the result by the width C of the drum between the
Add
flanges.
size.
Multipliers
ins.
lll3.
%
7
16-
..
9
16
1M
.16
.86
.37
.05
.828
.672
.465
.342
.262
.207
.167
.138
.116
.099
.085
.074
.066
.058
.052
.046
.042
lJi
9.1^
2Ji
same
ratio.
Warping Winch. Here there are no drums but only gypsy heads
Steam Capstans
Diameter
it is
not required to
coil
630
SHIP EQUIPMENT
and are
TOWING MACHINES
The
In
Towing Machines.
are used.
631
and
and
will
Towing Machines
(American Engineering Co.)
Diameter
of
Rope
Ins.
SHIP EQUIPMENT
632
and the automatic relief to the- hawser, without which the latter
would be continually straining and frequently breaking. There
is also installed an automatic guiding device that winds the hawser
on the drum in even layers.
ROPE
The
Lay, this means the direction or twist of the wires and strands
composing a rope. A rope is right or left lay according to the diThe regular lay of a wire
rection in which the strands are laid.
rope is to have the wires in each strand twist in the opposite direc-
same
The
advantage of
the increased distribution of the surface wear due to
direction.
chief
The
loads.
principal
If
shows that
it
from the load. Thus a rope twice as strong as needed for strength
alone could be used until one-half its strength was worn away
before it would be required to be renewed.
Speeds. Slow, derrick and crane, 50 to 100 ft. per minute.
ft.
stress
of the load
633
make a splice that will not pull out while running over sheaves. The following table gives the usual sizes of
|U9
it
is difficult
hoisting rope
Diameter
of
Ins.
to
Rope
in
load.
SHIP EQUIPMENT
634
held
by the knot,
as
it
will
not
slip,
and
is
easily untied
after
being strained.
A wall knot is made thus: Form a bight with strand 1 and pass
strand 2 around the end of it, and strand 3 around the end of 2,
Haul the
Z.
1 is
now
laid
over the center of the knot, strand 2 laid over 1, and 3 over 2,
when the end of 3 is passed through the bight of 1 as in BB. Haul
all the strands taut as in CC.
is
Here
=
=
=
=
g
t
Then
is
A weight of
Example.
4,000
lb. is
to be raised 100
ft.
+W
(or
ft.
in 5 sec.
Tension
X
g
X S
+
xp
w
W
of
Rope.
^ xX
4,000
5,
Kinds
994
4,000
100 JL
nnn
4,000
4,994 pounds
hemp,
The
and therefore
is
fiber is strong
is
tarred.
Wire ropes usually have a hemp center, the hemp forming a cushion
around which are the strands. Rope with a wire center is about 10%
The
the number of
heavier.
Capyrifkt l
<
final Co>o.iit.
Figure 106.
H York.
03.5
SHIP EQUIPMENT
636
MARLINE
637
Hemp
Approximate
Diameter
of
Each Rope
in Inches
before Serving
Outside
Approximate
Diameter
Hawser
of
after
Serving with
Marline
Outside
Circumference
after Serving
Approximate
Breaking
Strain
in
Pounds
Approximate
Weight
per Foot
in Pounds
638
SHIP EQUIPMENT
WIRE ROPE
639
Diameter
in
Inches
Each
SHIP EQUIPMENT
640
Manila Rope
WIRE ROPE
Figure 107.
641
hemp
round strand
SHIP EQUIPMENT
642
Composed
of
Diameter
Wires around a
Hemp
Core
YACHT-RIGGING
643
SHIP EQUIPMENT
644
Composed
of
to the Strand
GUY ROPES
645
SHIP EQUIPMENT
646
Composed
Diameter
of
consisting
TYPES OF BLOCKS
647
Figure 108.
A
B
C
E
F
H
I
Types of Blocks.
(Boston
Solid eye
Loose hook
Loose front hook
Jib sheet blocks to side
Jib sheet blocks fore and aft
Span and bridle block attachment
Side sister hook double block
Side sister hook single block
Regular shackle
Fiddle block
Ring, front or side
&
M Regular shackle
N
O
P
Upset shackle
swivel hook
Loose side hook
Reverse shackle
Reverse upset shackle
Stiff
S Deck
U
V
leader, bolt
hook
Coleman hook
Stiff front
Deck
leader
and nut
SHIP EQUIPMENT
648
Type
of Block
hook
Double with hook
Single with hook
Double with hook
Triple with hook
Single with hook
Double with hook
Triple with hook
Quadruple with shackle
Single with hook
Double with hook
Triple with hook
Quadruple with shackle
Single with hook
Double with hook
Triple with hook
Quadruple with hook
Single with
. .
Snatch block
Snatch block
REGULAR BLOCKS
Regular Blocks
Size
With
Loose Hooks
649
SHIP EQUIPMENT
650
Diameter
Sheave
Inches
of
With
Shackles
PULLEYS
651
rx
12
w
I
V(
S//7^/e
/?c//7r?er
/V/7/f*
J)/^ere/7//a/ /*t///ey
S/ng/e 0/ocA
Dot/6/e
tV/?//*
Figure 109.
SHIP EQUIPMENT
652
Single Fixed Pulley.
raising light weights.
Used
The
pulley
P = W
R = p +
Velocity of
is
like
w == 2P
W velocity of P
Movable
= 2P
=
P
r
-a
Velocity of
velocity of
= SP
4P
R
If
If
upper block
lower block
is
is
R =
y& velocity of P
\i velocity of P
To
P
J?
total
number
through and
attached
total
number
of ropes at the
attached
tions.
Differential Pulley.
R =
r
Then ^r =
R-r
OOi/6/e B/ock
2>ov6/e &/0cA
Gun
/ Tac/e/e
TacA/e
s/r>j/e 6/oc/c
Oot/6/e /oc
S/n^/e /oc
S/r>ff/e/oc
3/>cr/7/s/?
Figure 110
653
Svrtorr
SHIP EQUIPMENT
654
Velocity of
The
loss of
= R Dr X
power
in tackles
10%
velocity of
due to
and
rigidity of the
of the load to be raised, for every
friction
Hence
all
calcu-
by the following
formulae.
Let
Then S
is
taken as Y%
X P =
n W
W + ~-
a &
q or
and
i
strain
on rope
Knowing
and S
if
($
o
lifted
motion
+n)
= 8
(8
number
X F)
+n
of sheaves
necessary,
Put
W
j?r
and
if
off
off
the
8SW
strain
on the
fall
is
CHAIN
A
Examples.
of
two
655
weight of 10 tons
What
treble blocks.
10 tons;
Q
S
Stram
.
In the above,
if
is
n = 3
W (8 + n)
8x p
6;
P =
+ 6)
X6
10 (8
2
11
tonSa
F2
pull
strains
11
H X -gXg- S^tona
with
two
sheaves
blocks
rope
distance it moves.
pull
WX
X
Pull=f
2
2,240
^=840
4
1b.
manship.)
CHAIN
The
next, which
of the link.
To
is
is
lift
when reeved
as a tackle,
in the following table
one-third for friction; then find from the column of Ordinary Safe
Load General Use the corresponding strain and the size of the
worn, so that when finally discarded every link shall have done
its full share of work without exceeding the limit of perfect safety.
The diameter of sheaves or drums should not be less than 30
times the diameter of the chain iron used.
Hooks and
iron,
and
will
made
SHIP EQUIPMENT
65G
and
if
Size
of
Chain
D. B. G. Special Crane
Weight
From
per
Center
Foot
Out-
side
of
One
in
Link to
Width
Lb.
Center Approxof Next imately
25
27
32"
32
31
32
x 32
1
11
2V
2
O 3
*32
1*
IX
iA
13
115
5
6ft
9-3-
8^
Yl
5l(J
123
Its
2vs
^16
2t$
2Vi
6i o
13^
<>16
16
13/0
16
SA
VA
16H
19M
IVo
"16
Qli
i5
4^
4H
4M
it!
VA
$X
&A
2
9^16
f>X
VA
VA
WA
VA
9-3-
^16
2X
2Vs
^16
16
3^
3&
10H
VA
*16
2*
2^
2^
2X
12
i*
2%
2X
<Jl6
1H
1A
1H
HI
23
25
28
30
2V2
2%
2X
2A
IX
VA
d 16
VA
6^
6^
9
35
38
40
43
6i 6
6M
61-1
46^
49^
MX
MX
wy
7A
7X
70
73
76
86
7Vi
* Bradlee
16
31
33
&
4*
4^
4&
4M
5^
1A
7A
7^
8^
8^
8 34
9K
9^
9K
Proof
Test
Lb.
Average Ordinary
Breaking Safe Load
1,932
2,898
4,186
5,796
7,728
9,660
11,914
14,490
17,388
20,286
22,484
25,872
29,568
33,264
37,576
41,888
46,200
50,512
55,748
60,368
66,528
70,762
74,382
78,733
82,320
88,256
94,360
100,800
107,520
114,240
121,240
128,576
136,080
151,580
168,000
180,544
193,088
205,408
217,728
Strain
General
Lb.
Use
3,864
5,796
8,372
11,592
15,456
19,320
23,828
28,980
34,776
40,572
44,968
51,744
59,136
66,538
75,152
83,776
92,400
101,024
111,496
120,736
133,056
141,524
148,764
157,466
164,640
176,512
188,720
201,600
215,040
228,480
242,480
257,152
272,160
303,160
336,000
361,088
386,176
410,816
435,456
1,288
1,932
2,790
3,864
5,152
6,440
7,942
9,660
11,592
13,524
14,989
17,248
19,712
22,176
25,050
27,925
30,800
33,674
37,165
40,245
44,352
47,174
49,588
52,488
54,880
55,504
62,906
67,200
71,680
76,160
80,823
85,750
90,720
101,053
112,000
120,362
128,725
136,938
145,152
Crane
Proof
Test
Lb.
1,680
2,520
3,640
5,040
6,720
8,400
10,360
12,600
15,120
17,640
20,440
23,520
26,880
30,240
34,160
38,080
42,000
45,920
50,680
54,880
60,480
65,520
Ordinary
Average Safe Load
Breaking General
Strain
Lb.
3,360
5,040
7,280
10,080
13,440
16,800
20,720
25,200
30,240
35,280
40,880
47,040
53,760
60,480
68,320
76,160
84,000
91,840
101,360
109,760
120,960
131,140
Use
Lb.
1,120
1,680
2,427
3,360
4,480
5,600
6,907
8,400
10,080
11,760
13,627
15,680
17,920
20,160
22,773
25,387
28,000
30,613
33,787
36,587
40,320
43,180
ANCHORS
657
To
and catching.
Swivels are inserted in a chain to prevent the accumulation
Boat
658
SHIP EQUIPMENT
of
BOWER ANCHOR
659
of
SHIP EQUIPMENT
660
is
^fT^l ^n
ANCHOR CRANES
Sizes of
661
Anchor Cranes
(Lloyd's Requirements)
Weight
Anchor
of
including
Stock,
in
Cwts.*
20
10
11
Diameter
of
13
12
Main Post
at
Deck
14
in Inches
15
SHIP EQUIPMENT
662
Diameter at Deck
or of
Main
Davit
Inches
Inches
Diameter
'4
X4
X
XX5
x.
X.
XXX.
7
XXX8
X X
4^ X V
X X
5X X
5X
5%
6
ex
6X
7
7X
7X
7X
4
X
H
Thickness
XX-
SX
9
9
9X
13/
OCEAN STEAMERS
LIFE SAVING
663
The
than 20 nautical miles offshore. Steamers navigating the waters of the Atlantic or Pacific Ocean or the Gulf of
Mexico whose routes are restricted to one nautical mile or less offshore shall be included in the class of lake, bay and sound steamers.
"
Lifeboats and Life Rafts Required. All steamers other than
stricted to less
steamers
carrying
such equipment
passengers,
may
be in approved
life
rafts or
approved collaps-
ible lifeboats.
than 50 gross tons navigating under the provisions of Title LII, Revised Statutes of the United States, not
carrying passengers shall be equipped with lifeboats or life rafts
of sufficient capacity to accommodate at one time all persons on
"All vessels of
less
board.
"
may
"
collapsible lifeboats.
"
the 15th day of May to the 15th day of September in any one year,
both dates inclusive, will be required to be equipped with lifeboats
of only such capacity as will be sufficient to accommodate at one time
at least
of all persons on board, including passengers and
crew. Two-thir4s of such required lifeboat equipment throughout
60%
the year
may be
in
approved
collapsible lifeboats.
SHIP EQUIPMENT
664
"
Working Boat.
passengers shall have one working boat with life lines attached,
properly supplied with oars and painter, and kept in good condition
at all times and ready for immediate use, in addition to the life-
boats required.
be required to be
less
one
with
not
than
equipped
motor-propelled lifeboat as part
of their lifeboat equipment; Provided, however, That any vessel
under the jurisdiction of this service may be allowed to carry one
motor-propelled lifeboat as a part of the lifeboat equipment on
such steamer, except that on steamers carrying more than 6 lifeboats
under davits 2 of such lifeboats may be equipped with motors.
"Gasoline may be used for such motors when it is carried only
in seamless steel, welded steel, or copper tanks securely and firmly
fitted in such lifeboats and located where the greatest safety will
be secured.
"AH fittings, pipes and connections shall be of the highest standard and best workmanship and in accordance with the best modern
practice.
Storage of gasoline other than in the lifeboats using it
shall not be allowed under any circumstances.
"In computing the cubical capacity of motor-driven lifeboats,
the space required for the engine and fuel shall be excluded.
"Seine Fishing and Wrecking Vessels may substitute a wooden
surf boat or wooden seine boat for a lifeboat.
"Lifeboats and Rafts Required on Inspected Motor Vessels. All
vessels propelled by machinery other than steam, subject to the
inspection laws of the United States, shall be required to have the
same lifeboat and life raft equipment as steamers of the same class
and local inspectors shall so indicate in the certificate of inspection.
This paragraph shall not apply to such vessels under 50 tons, when
navigating in daylight only, and when equipped with air tanks
under deck of sufficient capacity to sustain afloat the vessel when
full of water with her full complement of passengers on board, or
when properly subdivided by iron or steel watertight bulkheads
665
"
the ocean or on the high seas shall require such vessels to be equip-
ped with a
life
The
of not less
.9
inch diameter)
and plugs
shall
be at%
fixes
the
be a number of rope
or wooden ladders always available for use in embarking the persons
onto the rafts.
"The number and arrangement of the boats and (where they are
allowed) of the pontoon rafts on a vessel depend upon the total
number of persons which the vessel is intended to carry; Provided,
That shall not be required on any voyage a total capacity in boats
and (where they are allowed) pontoon rafts, greater than that
necessary to accommodate
"At no moment
all
* Abstract from Seamen's Bill which went into effect in the United States in 1915.
SHIP EQUIPMENT
666
(A)
100
120
140
160
175
190
205
220
230
245
255
270
285
300
315
330
350
370
390
410
435
460
490
520
550
580
610
640
670
700
730
760
790
820
855
890
925
960
995
LIFEBOATS
667
on board.
"The remainder of the accommodation required shall be provided under regulations of the Board of Supervising Inspectors,
"At no moment
approved by the Secretary of Commerce; Provided, That during the interval from May 15th to September 15th
Inclusive, any passenger steam vessel of the United States, on
>cean routes less than 20 nautical miles offshore, shall be required
po carry accommodation for not less than 70% of the total number
persons on board in lifeboats and pontoon life rafts, of which
iccommodation not less than 50% shall be in lifeboats and 50%
nay be in collapsible boats or rafts, under regulations of the Board
vising Inspectors,
;>f
>i
"At no moment
SHIP EQUIPMENT
668
on
board in lifeboats and pontoon life rafts, of which accommodation
not less than two-fifths shall be in lifeboats and three-fifths may
be in collapsible boats or rafts under regulations of the Board of
Supervising Inspectors, Provided, further, That all passenger
steam vessels of the United States, the keels of which are laid after
July 1, 1915, for service on ocean routes or for service from September 15th to May 15th on the Great Lakes, on routes more than 3
miles offshore, shall be built to carry, and shall carry enough lifeboats and life rafts to accommodate all persons on board including
passengers and crew, And provided further, That not more than 25%
of such equipment may be in pontoon life rafts or collapsible lifequired to carry accommodation for not less than
50%
of persons
boats.
"The
Secretary of
Commerce
is
"First.
life
(b) It shall
air
compart-
CAPACITIES OF LIFEBOATS
0(59
depends upon
prohibited.
"
air
Third.
are to be provided
of lifebuoys with
of
Number
Buoys
"Fourth.
At
which vessels
fixed as follows:
is
Total
Vessels
Vessels
Vessels
Vessels
Vessels
inflated are
Number
Luminous
2
2
4
9
means
least
of attachment.
"Fifth.
All the
life
buoys and
life
months
after its
its
22
X 2V2 X
tt:
.6
198
-Tq
on
20 persons
bay
670
SHIP EQUIPMENT
COLLAPSIBLE LIFEBOATS
Lundin Decked Lifeboats
Length
Feet
671
SHIP EQUIPMENT
672
a lifeboat it shall be carried under the davits with the sides of the
boat fully extended, and only one such boat shall be allowed to
be carried under one set of davits, except that one nest of two
Engelhardt lifeboats shall be allowed to be carried under one set
of davits on each side of steam vessels of 2,000 tons and including
5,000 gross tons, and one nest of three shall be allowed to be carried
under one set of davits on each side of steam vessels of over 5,000
gross tons and when so nested the sides may be collapsed. Whether
carried as lifeboats or as life rafts, they shall be fully equipped
as lifeboats."
(Abstract from U. S. Steamboat-Inspection Rules.)
To find the cubic capacity, measure in feet and fractions of a
foot the length and breadth outside the canvas extension, and
the depth inside of the place of the minimum depth taken from the
inside of the
tended.
The product
of the
by
.7 is
the
metal not
life
rafts
less
of
than No. 18 B. w.
g.
approved construction
carried 4 Yi cu.
ft.
coastwise waters.
Length
Over
ocean and
RING BUOYS
673
24 hours.
They
shall
be fitted with a
line
festooned
efficient
self-
Boats Carried by
War
Vessels
Boat Davits
Boat davits must be
with
its full
boat to be lowered
of 15 degs.
be fitted with a gear of sufficient power to insure
list
that the boat can be turned cut against the maximum list under
which the lowering of the boats is possible on the vessel. (U. S.
These
674
SHIP EQUIPMENT
V/A
KkVfl
V/A
\\V\
F7?Cni
*f'
L\\m\Y/AWAVY/A^^
Figure 112.
Rotating Davit.
ll5\VyAVYA^^
Figure 113.
Pivoted Davit.
675
SHIP EQUIPMENT
676
by
it
circular davits.
Size of.boat
^aaaE^zisiil^i
Figure 114.
23
677
SHIP EQUIPMENT
678
Wei in davit
features in the
are:
(1)
the
athwartship traveling motion of the arm, and (2) the compensating arrangement of the falls thus giving a flattened trajectory
of the boat and a greater reduction of the power necessary for
manipulating it. Compared with a davit pivoted on a stationary
pin, the power necessary for starting it outboard is approximately
15%, and for bringing it back 75%, of the force required to manipulate a gear of that type, all conditions being equal.
a cast steel boom at the fulcrum, the boom being fastened at its
foot to the base of the frame by a movable link.
The carriage,
and with it the boom, travels inboard or outboard by a Tobin
bronze screw operated by a crank, the screw engaging a floating nut
in the carriage.
The compensating action of the link tends to
counterbalance the weight of the boat as the boom moves outboard
and to keep the davit in equilibrium at all points.
Angle of Heel of a Vessel when Lowering a Boat or a Weight.
w =
h =
Let
W=
GM =
6 =
angle of heel
move
The
~
tan 6
==X
= w
h or tan 6
Since
is
generally small,
Then 6 =
to transform
w X h
w
it
tan
6 hence
;
by
in circular
measure and
57.
Exam-pie.
from
of 2
its
ft.
G G\
G M
w X h
W XGM
= 9
tan
This gives
a distance
tt
in
t
Using the formula
or
in degrees
Xh
=
wxQM
=
=
57
X A
18
7)200
S7
/ie
50
= 3^
Jq
ft.
RIGS OF VESSELS
679
of a
Figure 115.
Let
AB =
AC
RIGS OF VESSELS
Vessels
sails.
and
aft sails.
a yawl
all
rig,
sails.
is
This
SHIP EQUIPMENT
680
Three
Barkentine.
masts, foremast square rigged, main and
mizzen mast fore and
Generally understood to have three masts,
Ship.
sail
Brig.
sail
differs
aft sail.
sail is
aft
aft.
viz., fore,
in
with square
mainland mizzen,
rigged,
and the
all
aft or jigger
sails.
mast schooner
rigged.
On many
booms
are installed,
angles, often serving as venti-
boom can
booms
handle
usually of
Between the masts are strung wires for the wireless telegraph equipment. The masts seldom have sails. As to the rake
of the masts and stacks, generally the rake of each is slightly inwood.
Warships
Battleships, armored cruisers, and sometimes light cruisers have
military masts for observation purposes, with wireless and signal
equipment. Smaller vessels, as torpedo boat destroyers, have two
pole masts with wireless equipment.
See sections on Rope; Blocks; Tackles; and Ship Machinery.
WIRELESS EQUIPMENT
"
Every steamer
of the
STORM OIL
681
must be equipped with an efficient apparatus for radio communication in good working order, capable of transmitting and receiving
messages over a distance of at least 100 miles, day or night. An
auxiliary power supply independent of the vessel's main electric
power plant, must be provided which will enable the sending set
for at least four
'
"The
'
scientific
be authorized to employ exclusively the wave length of 300, but they must be able to receive
a wave length of 600 meters."
(Abstract from Radio Communication Laws of the United States, 1916.)
of
may
STORM
"Ocean and coastwise steam
OIL
whenever
"Steamers of over 200 and not over 1,000 gross tons shall be
provided with two oil tanks of at least 15 gallons capacity each.
"Steamers of over 1,000 and not over 3,000 gross tons shall be
provided with two oil tanks of at least 20 gallons capacity each.
"Steamers of over 3,000 and not over 5,000 gross tons shall be
provided with two oil tanks of at least 25 gallons capacity each.
SHIP EQUIPMENT
682
"
tion Rules).
The
SECTION
SHIP OPERATING
LOADING AND STOWING OF CARGOES, OPERATING NOTES
PERTAINING TO MACHINERY (SEE INDEX), MAINTENANCE, SHIP CHARTERING, MARINE INSURANCE, SHIPPING AND EXPORT TERMS
of safe stability.
and the
stowage weight per cubic foot of the cargo to be carried, the tons
But in making this calculation no
of cargo can be calculated.
account is taken of the draft or freeboard, although it is evident
that a vessel with a cargo of iron ore will sink much deeper than
with one of cotton, as the weight per cubic foot of the former is more
than of the latter. On the sides of all vessels classed by Lloyd's,
British Corporation, and Bureau Veritas, there are markings which
indicate the minimum freeboard a vessel can have at certain times
of the year.
See section on Freeboard.
Loading. Even with a freeboard assigned to a vessel, yet the
cargo she carries and the way it is loaded play a most important
part with regard to her stability. While perhaps, when loading a
general cargo which arrives alongside a vessel at all sorts of times,
SHIP OPERATING
C84
difficult to
oil
in
bulk.
is
kept full,
treated
as
the
be
a
of
same
homogeneous cargo
weight.
may
However, if the tank is only partly filled, the center of gravity of
the liquid moves from side to side as the vessel rolls, and acts like
a suspended or movable weight, which is a most dangerous conit
dition.
When
685
only affecting the stability but also the structural strength. Every
captain who is obliged to go to sea with only part of a cargo should
be given a plan or other data as to the tanks that should be filled
is
oil in
bulk.
When
shipped in barrels
and cases, no special structural features such as expansion trunks or
cofferdams are required to be built in the vessel as when carrying
oil in
bulk.
The
New
York,
"Stowage
of Oil in Barrels.
All
barrels
SHIP OPERATING
686
up, and care must be taken that the chimes are kept free from
the sides of the vessel in the ends.
"No
barrel
is
to be stowed in a place
where there
is
fore
not sufficient
and
aft.
In
will it
tier.
"No
hanging beds
"The
barrels
of
"No
barrel to be stowed athwartships without special permission of the surveyor, and in no case will it be permitted when the
barrel
is
"Single deck vessels with hold beams, not more than eight feet
apart from center to center, taking over six heights of barrels
must lay a temporary between-deck with two and a half (2%) inch
planks, with the ends interlocked, not less than nine inches in
width directly under the bilge of the barrels fore and aft, from side
to side.
feet,
a half inch plank laid on the beams may be used, from side to side.
"Where the beams are farther apart than eight feet, heavier
material in proportion must be used, all to be regulated by the
surveyor.
"A stanchion well secured at both ends
between-deck beam.
In
"Stowage
of Oil in Cases.
the trim of the ship, and not to leave spaces there in order to raise
the tiers higher by stowing cases on the flat, especially where the
687
upper tier beam fills or comes near to the deck above. Should the
ship prove to be tender, then the top tier, or a part of it, should
be left out. It is imperative that the cases be kept as low as possible,
so as not to destroy the stability of the ship, especially those that
have nearly perpendicular sides and deep holds.
"The ballast should not be trimmed in the run of the ship, abaft
the two after stanchions, higher than one step for cases above
the ground tier, and from thence forward. If the ballast does not
cover the floor forward, do not use wooden dunnage forward of
the ballast, but stow the cases over one tier of boards, as it only
requires sufficient protection to prevent any vice remaining on the
cargo platform from staining the cases, which would injure their
must
All cases
tops up.
"All places oi broken stowage must be filled with wood or other
proper dunnage cut the length of the case. The dunnage must be
clean
and dry.
"The amidship
sagging,
next
tier.
"When
filled
SHIP OPERATING
688
oil
wise.
"Any amount
Steamboat-Inspection Rules.
Grain Cargoes. The structural features of a steamer carrying
grain in bulk are practically similar to those of a steamer for general
cargo in the sense that no close riveting (as for oiltightness for
tankers) nor special requirements are called for by Lloyd's or the
by the
rules of the
Board
of
GRAIN CARGOES
Trade (Marine Dept.), London,
permitted by those rules.
shall not
689
be loaded deeper than
"2. Shifting boards except as provided for in Rule 11, must extend from the upper deck to the floor when grain is carried in bulk,
and must be grain tight, with grain tight fillings between the beams,
of all
The
the 1st of October and the 1st of April beyond such a supply as
will be consumed prior to vessel's reaching the ocean.
SHIP OPERATING
690
or four
by
six (4
6) ins.
decks, nor where a ship has more than two decks, between the two
upper decks, unless in feeders, properly constructed to fill the
and lower
Bulk grain
hold.
may
four (4) tiers of bags or other suitable cargo. All bags or other
cargo to be stowed on two tiers of boards as provided for in Rule 7.
bulkhead in said holds and the nearest end of the hatchway feeders
exceeds sixteen (16) feet (unless in the opinion of the surveyor
the distance should be less) then vessel must have a wing feeder
known
must be dunnaged.
deck and beams, may load full cargoes of grain in bulk but
must have shifting boards as required in Rules 2, 3 and 13, and if
required by survey ois trimming bulkheads forward and aft extend-
single
BUNKER HATCHES
691
less
end of the midship feeders four (4) heights of bags must be put
on top of the bulk grain from the bulkheads to within sixteen. (16)
feet of the feeders, unless in the opinion of the
tance should be
less.
as feeders
when
feasible.
The
and/or cotton seed (except as provided for in Rule 8), but if with
two or more decks must have tight wing and hatch feeders to feed
the lower hold or orlop as provided for in Rule 17.
"22. Part Cargo of Oats and/or Cotton Seed. When the quantity of oats and /or cotton seed carried in bulk between the two upper
decks exceeds 60% of the capacity of said deck, the excess over
50% may be stowed in bulk in compartments fitted with wing
shifting boards extending from bulkheads at each end of hold to
within four (4) feet of the hatches, one of such compartments
shall be the largest between-deck compartment; or, where a steamer
has four or more compartments in between-decks oats and/or cotton
seed may be loaded in bulk in all of these compartments if they
are provided with wing feeders of increased size to reach from the
forward and after bulkhead to within four feet of hatches. The
hatch feeders or feeders for lower hold must be capped box feeders,
All holds are to be so fitted.
five or six feet in depth.
SHIP OPERATING
692
"24.
may have
large
trimming hatches
sixteen feet.
boiler.
When already properly sheathed, surveyor
but
not unless nine inches of space will be
the
vessel,
may pass
required where the sheathing is to be erected or renewed. This
room
or
donkey
rule applies
where the
fires
donkey
damage by
excessive
boiler.
full
"a.
sufficient size to
admit
of not less
on the grain
'tween-decks
in bulk.
is
for
COAL CARGOES
693
allowed provided there are separate feeders for the holds and 'tweendecks, or else sufficiently large feeders to the 'tween-decks, and the
hatches and other openings there made available for feeding the
these shifting boards extending from beam to deck and from beam to
keelson, and in the case of bulk grain must also be fitted between
Although coal
is
tween the top of the coal and the under side of the deck, so that
the coal will not shift when the steamer is rolling.
Attention should be called to the effect of using bunker, coal
on the stability. In preparing the design of a steamer care must
be taken that she has ample stability both with bunkers full and
empty. In the case of some vessels, as the transatlantic liner
New
York, where the bunkers are carried to the upper deck, she gains
in stability as the coal is burned and as she continues on her voyage,
until near the end, for the center of gravity of the coal is above her
center of gravity when leaving port with the bunkers full, and as
the voyage progresses the coal is used; consequently its center of
is
The Board
of Underwriters of
New York
"
Steamers
of the Three Deck rule and Spar Deck Vessels are permitted where
the stability and spare buoyancy are guaranteed, to carry during
the winter months, October 1st to April 1st, eight to ten per cent,
of their *iet register tonnage of coal on deck for consumption during
the voyage.
SHIP OPERATING
694
If
the coal
is
carried
on the raised
tonnage.
"
and cover
the loose coal, the same not to be higher than the rail.
"Where suitable bins are provided of a moderate size the coal
in bags may be omitted.
as previously
mentioned.
Steamers engaging in the lumber trade should be broad in proportion to their draft thus giving a fairly high position of the metacenter and sufficient margin of stability without resorting to ballast,
Such a deck load,
particularly when carrying a heavy deck load.
if well fastened in place, gives valuable surplus buoyancy.
On the
deck
the
load
is
secured
chains
fastened
to
the
sheer
Pacific Coast
by
strake and extending over the load from side to side with turnbuckles to take up the slack.
The Board
of 1906, intervene.
meant any
deals, bat-
tens, or other
Act
ft.
The U.
S.
Department
of Agriculture publishes
695
a special
and stowed
All such other provisions shall be made on every steamer carrying passengers or freight,
to guard against and extinguish fire, as shall be prescribed by the
any
fire
or heat.
Act shall
steam
vessels
of
by
gasoline or any
when carried by motor vehicles (autothe
same
as a source of motor power; Provided,
mobiles) using
"Nothing
however, that
all fire,
if
SHIP OPERATING
696
leave the vessel; Provided further, that any owner, master, agent,
or other person having charge of passenger steam vessels shall have
the right to refuse to transport automobile vehicles the tanks of
which contain gasoline, naphtha or other dangerous burning fluids.
"
Provided, however, that nothing in the provisions of this Title
shall prohibit the transportation by vessels not carrying passengers
for hire, of gasoline or any of the products of petroleum for use
as a source of motive
power
for the
of
such vessels.
system independent
of
Machinery Operating.
See Index.
MAINTENANCE
Hull
"
Vessels intended for classification in
Lloyd's Rules state:
the Register Book are to be built under the Society's special survey,
in the Register
and vessels so built will be entitled to the mark
Book.
To
MAINTENANCE
697
her sufficiency and that of her equipment. The local inspectors shall once in every year, at least, carefully inspect the hull
of each sail vessel of over 700 tons carrying passengers for hire and all
test
other vessels and barges of over 100 tons burden carrying passenger?
Vessels while laid up
for hire within their respective districts.
and dismantled and out of commission may, by regulations established by the Board of Supervising Inspectors be exempted fiom
any or all inspection as outlined above and in sections 44 IS, 4426
and 4427.
"The
which she is to be employed, has suitable accommodations for the crew, and is in a condition to warrant the belief that she may be used in navigation
is
SHIP OPERATING
398
Details.
life.
They
shall
butts the bilge strakc butts may show signs of working, with the
result the plates are slightly drawn apart, and in the opening thus
the bilges.
The
fore
and be
and
aft
ventilated.
crevices should be
far as possible,
If the
filled
nous compound.
The proximity
of certain metals
set
result.
To prevent
which pierce the hull below the water line might be coated with
an enamel paint that is impervious to sea water, so that when the
valves are closed there will be no action between them and the
shell plating.
THE LIFEBOATS
699
The
room
floors.
In making a hull survey, the condition of the coal bunker bulkheads should be noted, particularly around the boilers, for coal
when loaded wet into a hot bunker gives off acids that attack
The
steel plates
lifeboats should be
their blocks
When
and
and
angles.
swung out
is
To
bottom, or
if
drilled out.
The
number
of times a vessel
docked in a year
depends on the water in which she runs; in the tropics perhaps once
every six months; elsewhere it may be once a year.
Prior to docking a vessel a docking plan should be given to the
dock superintendent if he is not familiar with the underwater
form of the vessel. The plan consists of a longitudinal section
with the transverse bulkheads and engine and boiler spaces indiDocking.
is
SHIP OPERATING
700
The
in,
is
at the en-
generally 3 to 4
ft.
apart, but the distance depends on the weight of the vessel per foot,
some requiring additional shoring at the bilges. In one with a
considerable part of the keel not in a straight line, the blocks must
be close together at the ends and additional ones placed to take the
overhang. Side blocks should come under all parts where the
weights are concentrated, but they must not interfere with the
sea connections. Sometimes in graving docks side shores are
necessary, that is, shores from the sides of the vessel to the walls
of the dock.
In floating docks such shores are not possible and
instead the side blocks are placed nearly to the turn of the bilge
of the vessel.
Machinery
No
matter
how
careful a
of coal,
sumption
oil,
can easily be wiped out
company may be
and other
if
in
all
the
to the
of 12
months.
The
tail
shaft
is
to be exam-
INDICATOR CARDS
701
ined annually and drawn at intervals of not more than two years.
On the application of owners, the Committee will be prepared to
give consideration to the circumstances of any special case."
The U.
bushes are to be
years,
made,
drawn
all
Propeller shafts
carefully examined.
for examination at least once in every
of all cranks
and
two
and crank
of air, feed,
and
bilge
The
and
of them.
for
by so doing there
and piping.
To
is
LOG
702
Engine
Time Account per
Coal,
S. S.
Account
Tons
Quality
received at
mm
mm
Total
days steaming at
Consumption
Average speed per hour throughout
Revolu-
Distance
Run per
Date
Day
tions
of
in
Miles
Daily
Consump-
Engine
tion
tons
Time and
Cause
of
Remarks
Stoppages
s
5
e
09
Summary
t.
u 2
<
(-CO
Total
Coal received
main
Consumed
by
"
"
*
Own
boilers
donkey
galley and ship
tons
Tons
"
use
Remaining on board
tons
CHARTERING
703
etc.,
CHARTERING
There are three ways of chartering a
vessel:
In trip charters
(1)
it is
some
oil,
definite
or so
Among
and
it
is
may
The
discharging port
may
agreed that the merchant may order the steamer to a second and
possibly a third port of discharge by paying some agreed extra rate.
It is also arranged in negotiation just when the steamer is to be
ready for loading; that is to say, two dates are mentioned between
which the vessel must report. The first date is known as the date
before which lay days cannot commence, so that if the steamer
tenders any time before a certain date she cannot demand the cargo.
known
before
is
and should
SHIP OPERATING
704
an agreed number
(3)
Time
of consecutive voyages.
Charter.
her with a complete crew and thoroughly equipped and ready for
business, but pay no expenses incidental with the loading and
discharging of the cargo or going into or proceeding from ports,
nor for the motive power for the vessel at sea, that is, the coal
burned, but they must keep the steamer in good condition and
furnish the necessary provisions, etc., for the maintenance of the
crew, and the necessary stores for the proper upkeep of the steamer.
is
cient condition, while the charterers pay practically all other expenses as for coal, various port charges as government dues, light-
&
Co.,
New
York.]
Charter Forms.
Department
is
charter forms.
S.
Navy
705
tinent between
of the
war
in
and there
many
of the
European War
Under
charter, for a period of from three to six months, at charterer's option; the following conditions to govern in the case of each vessel:
The vessel to be used for the transportation of/ or, at charterer's option.
Payment to be made at a flat rate per calendar day for the time actually
under charter, payable at the end of each month or as soon thereafter as may
2.
3.
be practicable.
charges and expenses incident to the operation and
item of coal, in the case of which the charterers shall accept and pay for all coal in the steamer's bunkers at the commencement of the hire, and the owners shall, at the expiration of the charter, pay for
all coal left in the bunkers, each at the current market price at the respective
4.
Owners
shall
maintenance of the
pay
all
ports where the hire begins and ends. All coal used
poses will be furnished by the charterer.
by the
vessels for
bunker pur-
The only cost in connection with this charter to be borne by the charterer
be the per diem rate asked by the owners of the vessel, plus the cost of the
coal consumed, necessary pilotage fees and, in the case of passage of the vessel
through the Panama Canal, the usual canal tolls; all other expenses and charges
to be defrayed by the owners.
Expense of loading and discharging cargo to be
5.
will
aorne
6.
t
by the charterer.
The charterer shall pay
seven A.
M. on
the
first legal
loading port (unless otherwise mutually arranged), the vessel then being ready
and tight, staunch, strong and in every way fitted for the service,
to receive cargo
with a clean and clear hold, notice whereof to be given to the charterer before
Hire to continue from the time specified for comfive P. M. on a working day.
mencement of charter until the vessel's redelivery to the owners at a port to be
agreed upon at the time of execution of contract. Owners to take all steps necssary for the proper care of vessels while under charter, with the understanding
hat the charterers are to repair proven damages caused through the charterer's
* A foim that has been used by the U. S. Navy Dept.
SHIP OPERATING
706
negligence or fault beyond ordinary wear and tear, but not to pay for time occupied by such repairs.
7.
All steam winches and steamer's tackle to be at charterer's disposal at
all times during loading and unloading, by day and night, and sufficient steam to
be furnished to effectively run all winches at once. Steamer to work day and
if
required
by
charterers.
terer insists,
to time with all requisite inkeep a correct log of the voyage or voyages,
which are to be patent to the charterer or its agents, and copy furnished if requested.
When, on account of any accident to steamer or for any other reason the steamer
shall be off hire, the Master shall furnish written advices to charterer whenever
steamer is off hire, stating the cause of same, and when service is resumed, make
special report to charterer, giving particulars of such time off hire and also advice3
of quantity of bunkers consumed during said period.
11.
That any loss of time from deficiency of men or stores, or from any defect
or breakdown of machinery, steering apparatus, etc., or damage from fire, collision, stranding or damage which prevents the working of or continuance on
the voyage of the vessel for twelve hours or more shall be for account of owners
and in such case the payment of hire shall cease from the commencement of the
loss of time till she again resumes actual service for charterer, tight, staunch,
and strong, and in every way fitted at the place of accident, or should the vessel
put back from any of the above-mentioned causes or put into any other port
than that to which she is bound, the hire shall be suspended from time of her putting back or putting in until she be again in the same position and the voyage
resumed therefrom, and the pilotage fees at such port shall be borne by steamer's
owners. Also, if any loss of time is incurred through fault of ship, after cargo
and coals are on board, or cargo discharged and ship ready for sea as far as charterer is concerned and hour of sailing has been fixed by charterer and notice given
to Captain, if he is on board, if not, to the officer in charge at the time, such lost
time is to be for steamer's account; but should the vessel be driven into port or
anchorage through stress of weather, or from any accident to the cargo, such detention or loss of time shall be at the charterer's risk and expense. If upon the
voyage the 'steamer's speed be reduced by breakdown of machinery or other casualty, the time lost and the cost of the extra coal, if any, consumed in consequence
thereof, shall be borne by the owners.
12.
Charterer reserves the right to cancel this charter should steamer meet
with any casualty causing her to be withdrawn from charterer's service tempoIt is to be mutually agreed that this charter shall be subrarily or permanently.
10.
structions
and
NOTES ON CHARTERING
707
ject to all the terms and provisions of and all the exemptions from liability contained in the Act of Congress of the United States approved on the 13th day
February, 1893, and entitled "An Act relating to navigation of vessels, etc."
Master to accomplish all bills of lading for cargoes delivered on board
13.
vessel, his signature being accepted as binding on the owners.
of
Notes on Chartering*
1. The first point for owners is to stipulate for (a) delivery of
the vessel being accepted where she lies, after completion of discharge, or dry docking and repairs, so that the vessel may be placed
on
ment in view.
The preamble clause of some time charter parties is so phrased
and constructed as to constitute a warranty as regards (a) deadweight and measurement capacity, (b) speed, and (c) consumption.
To
ft.
and capable
of steaming about
knots per hour
weather
conditions
on
under favorable
a consumption of about
tons of best Welsh coal per day of 24 hours."
builder's plan
from the hour and date of the vessel being placed at the time charterer's disposal at such safe and suitable dock, wharf, or place
immediately available, and written notice given within office hours.
But some time charterers stipulate for hire not to commence for
24 hours (Sundays and holidays excepted) after written notice has
been given, and even make full use of the vessel for loading purposes
from the hour she is presented. Such a stipulation, being unfair
and one-sided, should be eliminated, or in a case where that cannot
* From Shipping Illustrated, New York.
SHIP OPERATING
708
Owners are
"
defined
5.
When,
for
to be paid
Speed and
by the time
charterer.
Consumption. A
and make the distance when the elements are battling against her.
Section 4286 of the United States laws governing Steamboat
Inspection Service states:
"The
charterer of
any
vessel, in case
BERTH TERMS
he shall man, victual and navigate
or by his own procurement, shall
vessel within the meaning of the
to the limitation of the liability of
709
>
same manner as
if
ports tonnage
Cotton rates are either quoted in so many cents per 100 lb. or in
fractions of an English penny per lb. or on the net register basis.
"F.t." refers to ore charters, and means "full terms," that is,
with despatch-money both ends.
is
loading port.
Spot
signifies
is
Tampa
inclusive.
SHIP OPERATING
710
and port
conditions to owners,
Form O
being
full of
clauses
more favorable
to charterers.
3s. 3d.
if
no reduction (3s.
Northern range
Boston,
Norfolk.
Boat
New
3d.).
York,
Philadelphia,
Baltimore,
Portland,
Newport News,
in canal boat.
bushels
8,000
grain
Dispatch
loading only.
Direct
D.p.
port.
D.w. Deadweight.
E.C. Ireland East Coast Ireland.
Free alongside
Free of freight brokerage.
F.o.w. First open water.
L.H.A.R. London, Hull, Antwerp or Rotterdam.
No red B/Ch. No reduction Bristol Channel.
O/COpen Charter.
O.T. On track or railway.
loads,
D.l.o.
F.a.s.
ship.
F.f.b.
Private terms.
Sundays excepted lay days.
Sun./ext.
U.K.f.o. United Kingdom for orders.
U.K.H.A.D. United Kingdom, Havre, Antwerp
P.t.
in
W.B.West
or Dunkirk.
Britain.
MARINE INSURANCE
A contract of marine insurance is a contract of indemnity whereby
the insurer undertakes to indemnify the insured, in the manner
and to the extent agreed, against marine losses, that is, the losses
INSURABLE VALUE
711
W. Gow.
Value. Where
no special contract
is
made between
the insured and the underwriter the insurable value of certain matters of insurance is fixed
(1)
law as follows:
expended to
make
and
Whether
paid in advance or otherwise, the insurable value in the gross amount of the freight at the risk of the
insured, plus the charges of insurance.
(2) Freight.
(3)
Goods
or Merchandise.
The
insurable value
is
the prime
cost of in-
Terms
The term
and provisions
and
outfit,
stores,,
the
The
SHIP OPERATING
712
is,
or, in case of
distinctly specified.
4.
5.
underwriters.
Any
loss
may
Where goods
and
if
Where the leak arises from the unseaworthy state of the ship
when she sailed, or from wear and tear or natural decay, and is
only in consequence of that ordinary amount of straining to which
she would unavoidably be exposed in the general and average course
of the voyage insured, the underwriter is not liable.
A clause is often inserted in a policy admitting the seaworthiness
VOYAGE POLICY
713
purpose of the insurance. Where this is attached to a policy, it is a concession on the part of the underwriter
that any leak arising must be from a peril of the sea.
The term "All other perils" includes only perils similar in kind
of ths vessel for the
value of the goods which were jettisoned less the assessment which
the owner is called upon to pay. It is safe to figure that all policies
of insurance on goods cover and protect the merchant against
assessments in general average.
A sacrifice to protect the ship alone or the cargo alone is not
covered by general average. It is the opposite of an accidental loss
caused by a maritime peril. A loss caused by water to extinguish
fire is
were on
SHIP OPERATING
714
other than general average and salvage charges, are called parParticular charges are not included in general
ticular charges.
average or particular average. They are covered in the policy by
permission granted to sue, labor and travel in and about the defense,
safeguard and recovery of the goods.
the vessel
is
force, the
vessel
Per
cent. Particular
Average Clause.
"Subject
to Particular
is
if
so
made
up, or per
715
York-Antwerp
rules
if
in
whichever
This clause
ing,
may
first
occur.
being quite generally insisted on by the companies, particularly on policies to Brazil, Buenos Aires, and the
River Plate, as, owing to the large number and size of shore losses, the
is
any goods, merchandise, freight or other things or interest whatsoever on board such other ship or boat caused proximately or
otherwise by the ship insured in so far as the same is not covered
of
freight or other
whatever."
The
P.
and
I.
ordinary rate.
Collision or Ruling or Running Down Clause (R. D. C.) is a
clause in which the underwriters take a burden of a proportion,
usually three-quarters of the damage inflicted on other vessels by
Four-Fourths Running
and S.
Inchmaree
F. C.
Down
Clause.
seizure.
damage
to hull
and
SHIP OPERATING
716
vided such loss or damage has not resulted from want of due diligence by the owner or owners of the vessel or by the manager.
Rates. The rate of insurance depends on the age and condition
Lading
should add the amount of the freight to the value of the goods
when making declaration to the underwriters. In foreign trade,
bills of lading are generally made out in triplicate, one for the
Manifest. A
it is
the ship as
for
Salvage
is
by law
and property
at sea.
and Freight) means that the seller furnishes the goods and pays the freight no other expenses to the
C. F. or C. A. F. (Cost
port of destination. All risks while the goods are in transit are
for the account of the buyer.
Here the seller furC. I. F. (Cost, Insurance and Freight).
nishes the goods and pays the freight and insurance to port of
destination, all other risks while goods are in transit being for the
seller is to deliver
the goods
F. A. S.
STEAMER
717
in
all
whom
it is
drawn.
is
said to be
article
on board a
of necessity.
Drawback.
is
when an imported
is
Lay Days are the days agreed on by the shipper and master or
agent for loading and discharging cargo and beyond which a demurrage will be paid to the vessel. Sundays and legal holidays
do not count unless the term " running days" is inserted, in which
days are included.
Clearance Papers. When ready for sea the custom officials
must be provided with a detailed manifest of the ship's cargo. If
the port charges have been paid and her cargo is properly accounted
for, then the collector of the port will furnish the master with
clearance papers, without which the vessel must not leave port.
Bill of Health is a certificate stating that the vessel comes from
a port where no contagious disease prevails, and that none of the
passengers (if carried) or the crew at the time of departure was
infected with any disease.
case
all
SHIP OPERATING
718
AUTHORITIES QUOTED
The
will
be included in future
G. Nicol.
Modern Seamanship.
"
A.
M. Knight.
Naval Constructor.
Lloyd's Rules.
Am. Bureau
of Shipping Rules.
J.
W. M.
Sothern.
AUTHORITIES QUOTED
719
In the handbook are quotations of articles published in International Marine Engineering, New York; Shipping Illustrated, New
720
SHIP OPERATING
INDEX
Absolute pressure, 449
Absolute zero, 344
Admiralty bronze, 156
Air, cooling by, 595
escape of, 583
velocity
of,
phere, 390
Air change, duct area
Air ducts, 582
for,
584
of,
452, 460
157
Aluminum, 155
American Bureau of Shipping, 235
Ammeter, 543
Ammonia, 591, 594, 597, 601
piping
for, 527,
Ammonia
596
compressors, 597
Ammunition, 245
Ampere, 531
Anchor cranes, 661
Anchors,
Avoirdupois weight, 1
Awning deck vessels, 239
freeboard of, 206, 211
390
lifting speed,
625
of,
Apothecaries' weight, 1
351
721
INDEX
722
Bilge pumps, 603, 477
Bitt or bollard, sizes of, 92
366
387
cleaning of,
cleaning tubes
life of,
701
oil for,
356
of,
387
weights
of,
in,
28
power
of,
for
Bronzes, 156
an engine, 371
Boiler plates, 72
Boiler pressure, 364, 370, 421
125
310
length of, 305,
painting in, 281
ventilators to, 579
Boiler saddles, 277
floor plates of,
93
Boiler feed
of,
stove, 132
off, 386
washing out, 387
Boiler accessories, 376
Boiler circulators, 379
Boiler covering, 163
weight of, 307
Boiler efficiency, 374
371, 375
308, 370
388
387
locomotive, 366
of,
of,
604
and
sizes
sizes
of,
272, 321
aft, 268,
299, 320
INDEX
Buoyancy, center
of,
Center of gravity, 50
of a ship, 200
172
pressures
tubes, 91
effect of
wrought
of
iron
610
steamer,
cost
of
fitting
331
Cattle steamers, fittings for, 330
Caulking, deck planking, 285
Caulking bulkheads, 272, 321
Caulking cotton, 162
Cavitation, 425
288
Cement, Portland, 162
Ceiling, 285,
Cement
of,
179
from water
line,
173
up,
moving weights
heights of,
to find by
on, 203
202
Calorifiers,
723
INDEX
724
Coal consumption, 363, 421
per i.h.p., 349, 350, 411, 443
See also Trials
cut-off,
vacuum
210
propulsive, 223
tubes, 91
oil, 356
Columns, 84
cast iron, formula for, 85, 87
H and I sections, safe loads for, 86
steel, formulae for, 84, 85
wood, formulae for, 85, 87
safe loads for, 87, 88
#
Color of
89
350
lb. of,
226
Compression, 70
71
450, 456
keel or outboard, 459
jet,
steam temperatures
surface, 450
data on, 452, 421
operating, 453
in,
456
337
machinery, 339
of steam engines, 377
of refrigerating systems, 337
Cotangent of an angle, 40
Cotangents, table of, 43
Cotton, caulking, 162
Cotton seed, cargo of, 691
Coulomb, definition of, 531
Couplings, pipe, 526
Covering, pipe, 163, 165
tank top, 263
Coverings, deck, 264
Cranes, anchor, 661
stresses in, 98
Crank sequences, 396
Crew's quarters, painting in, 288
Cross bunker, volume of, 38
Cross curves of stability, 185
of electric installations,
of propelling
of,
519
for, 598
Cold storage temperatures, 588
Collapsing pressures of wrought iron
in,
126, 127
materials
prismatic, 171
Comparison, law
455, 456
Copper, 155, 71
Copper pipe, 518
wrought
in,
of
457
Cross section,
of, 50
ship's, center of
gravity
INDEX
725
light,
ube
248
ruisers, battle,
248
root, 27,
29
ubes, of numbers, 29
^ubic capacity, 170
operating cost
of deadweight, 168
of displacement, 169
of loads, 295,
296
298
295
lurves, of stability,
183
measures
of,
trim, 192
415
36
formula for, 90
steam engine, formula for, 413
steam, pressure in, 404, 405
ylinders, bursting
Dangerous
articles, carrying,
695
660
Deadweight, 169
fractions
Lloyd's, 167
98
of
wood
vessels, 282
Displacement calculation, 168
Displacement curve, 168
Displacement sheet, 177, 180, 181
Distributing systems, electric, 547
Docking, 699
Docking keels, 264
Doctor, 476
Double bottom, 261
corrosion in, 699
draining of, 604
Draft, 388
air for, 390
closed fireroom, 389
Ellis and Eaves' system, 389
at fan, 421
forced, installations of, 392
heat absorbed in creating, 389
Howden's system, 389
measurement of, 389
resistance of funnel to, 393
velocity of air, 390
of
of,
628
INDEX
726
Dry steam, 343
Duct area for air
change, 584
location
Ducts,
of, 584
materials used in, 582
Duplex pumps, 474
systems, 539
Electrical
and mechanical
units,
23
33
Ellipse, properties
Ellipsoid, volume of, 38
Enamel, bitumastic, 280
of,
Engine room
Engine room
70
coefficient of,
floors,
419, 125
544,
547,
550,
of
wire,
552, 556
Electric
motor
circuit,
size
539
Electric
628
Electric motors, 547
types
of,
564
561
558
measurement
running
sizes of,
of,
wiring
551
Electric wiring of
of
gasoline
Fans, 580
Farad, 531
533
545
537
of,
Electric
floor plates
engines,
Feed
Feed
Feed
Feed
tank, 462
INDEX
Feed water heaters, 465
fuel saved by, 467
Field rheostat, 543
Filler, wood, 288
Filter, feed water, 464
Filter tank, 462
Filtering materials, 463
Fire alarms, 614
Fire bars, weights of, 307
Fire bricks, weights of, 307
Fire extinguishing apparatus for oil carriers,
325
water, 610
Fire point of
oil,
356
Fire tube
Forced
draft,
388
Foundations, boilers
116
wood
282
265
Framing, 255,
Freeboard, 205
of awning deck vessel, 206, 211
of flush deck vessel, 205, 210
of hurricane deck vessel, 220
of shelter deck vessel, 216
Freeboard calculations, 210, 213, 218
of
vessels,
727
Furnace, temperature
Furnaces, 364
Fuse, 543, 549
Fusible plugs, 379
Galleys, 673
of,
393
of,
544, 550
Geometrical propositions,
Gig, 673
31.
INDEX
728
Grate area, boiler, 363, 364
coal consumption, 421, 363
Great Lakes Register, 237
Ground detector, 543
Grouping battery cells, 557
Gross tonnage, 169
Gunboats, 249
Gun metal, 155
Guy ropes, ships', 645
yacht, 643
Gypsy capstan, 630
of,
137
Hitches, 633
Hogging, 298
Hoisting engines, 626
Hoisting rope, data on, 632, 634
tables of, 638, 639
Hold, depth of, 167
Hold
268, 269
142
Hexagons,
pillar,
600
Hot
well,
of,
318
492
462
beams,
sizes
Ignition, electric,
486
222
INDEX
Indicated horse power, steam consumption per, 342, 421
,
729
Keels, 264
bilge,
264
docking, 264
of
wood
vessels,
282
Keelsons, 263
in,
292
of,
532, 23
fuels for,
478
357
479
starting of, 482
valves of, 484
operation
of,
71
malleable, 121, 71
650
Jump
in keg,
292
289
tests of, 293
weight of, 292
sizes of,
Launches, 673
Launching, 227
228
233
data, 232,
devices, 231
ways, 228, 232, 233
weight, 233
Law of comparison, 226
Lay, 632
Lead, 155
Lead of valve, 400
Leg boiler, 366
Length, of boiler and engine rooms, 305,
310
for freeboard, 208
Lloyd's, 166
over all, 166
between perpendiculars, 166
Launching
Launching
Launching
Launching
Launching
calculations,
Lifeboat,
distance
heeled, 679
INDEX
730
Lifeboats, 663, 664, 665
Magnesia, 162
Magnetos, 489
Main drain, 602
547,
550,
552, 556
of saloons,
288
Manganese
loss, electric,
536
Liners, 258
of,
28
Lubricating
oil,
358, 359
Lumber
Lumber
Lumber
steel,
112
Manifold, 530
Manila, 634
Linear measure, 2
Line carrying guns, 682
Line
cargoes, 694
schooners, 283
steamers, 327
ft.
per ton, 16
piping, 527
117
111-165
shipbuilding,
rivet, 104, 110,
strength
weights
Mean
of,
of,
70-110
13
410
421
trial,
Measurement
of draft, 389
Measuring screws, 289
Mechanical and electrical units, 23
Mechanical equivalent of heat, 341
Merchant vessels, types of, 238, 309
Messenger chains, 624
INDEX
section, schooner,
Midship
283
50
sections, 52
Monitors, 248
of parts,
334
323, 325
ventilation
of,
Beaum6
gravity
of,
354, 355
356
of, 356
combustion engines, 357
lubricating, 358, 359
specific gravities of, 354, 355, 356
weights of, 354, 356
in,
684
578
heat values
293
113
pumping arrangements
for internal
Nautical mile, 2
Naval brass, 157
steel,
for boilers,
ships,
vessel,
356
356
data on, 354, 356
kerosene, 478
storm, 681
stowage in barrels, 685
stowage in cases, 686
viscosity of, 356, 359
Oil barrels, 21, 355
Oil burners, 362
Oil burning systems, 360
Oil cargoes, 684
Oils,
Nickel
of,
337
Nails,
or cold test
flash point,
Motor
chill
fuel,
calculations, 297
Moment
law, 532
353
fire
of inertia,
Ohm's
Oil,
density
Moment
731
of,
113, 116
Nipples, 526
3akum, 162
3hm, 531
INDEX
732
Packing, 526
Paddle
Paddle
Paddle
data
slip,
and pitch
steel,
of,
wrought
509
anti-fouling, 279
copper, 231
cork, 289
red lead, 279
520
520
in,
Piping, ammonia, 596
carbonic anhydride, 596
Piping oil burners, 362
loss of pressure in,
water flow
279
staterooms, 287
wood, 288
Panels, electric motor, 565
Planking, of
deck, 284
wood
Plough
Peak
Plumbing, 606
604
draining of,
Perishable products, keeping
282
639
Plumbing
of,
587
358
Petroleum and products, 353
Phosphor Ironze, 156, 71
Petrol,
268
Pintles, rudder,
vessels,
Pillars,
571
436
hull,
in,
507
275
333
of boilers,
337
331
of,
699
INDEX
Propellers,
back
of blade,
blade thickness
of,
424
Pyramid, measures
and
slip,
of,
36
432
bosses
formulae for
733
speed, revolutions
428
helicoidal area of, 429
keys for, 430
motor boat, 317, 431, 434
number of blades, 425, 426
nuts for, 430
nuts, covering of, 699
pitch, 424, 428, 430
pitch ratio, 424
pressure on, 430
projected area, 310, 425, 429
right or left-handed, 424
shape of blades, 424
slip of, 425, 427, 428, 430, 434
struts for, 273
thrust of, 424, 429
turbine ship, 429
weights of, 432
Proportions, extreme, of a vessel, 168,
212, 294
Propulsion, i.h.p. for, 222
turbo-electric, 444
Propulsive coefficient, 223
Protective deck, 245
Pulleys, 652
pitch,
davits, 676
Quadrant, rudder, 621
Quarter sawing, 157
Quadrant
Radians, 3
Radiators, steam, size required, 569
337
of,
Register ton,
hand, 605
Pumping arrangements,
oil
322, 325
459
474
circulating, 462
duty of, 472
Pumps,
air,
centrifugal,
installing
lifts of,
471
carriers,
587
for,
102
INDEX
734
removing
388
of,
282, 283
data on, 319
motor, data on, 318, 320
Scotch boiler, weight of water in, 307
Scotch boilers, data on, 364, 365, 366
proportions of, 363
Scouts, 249
101
shearing strength
signs for, 103
strength
types
of,
of,
of,
105, 107
104
lag, 289,
Rockets, 682
Rope, cast
641
formulae, 642
hemp
kinds
of,
634
of,
636
wire, 637
measuring
Rope
Rope
Rope
of,
capacity, of
Schooners, construction
293
'
Segment
640
a drum, 628
of,
33
lamps wired
in,
540
hitches, 633
knots, 633
Round-cornered squares,
Rounds, sizes of, 137
Rudder, chain to, 624
pintles, 275
power to turn, 623
pressure on, 623
Rudder areas, 276
sizes of,
of,
140
steam consumption
274
Shearing strain, 70
Shearing strength of bolts, 93
Shearing strength of rivets, 105
Shearing stresses, curve of, 295, 298
Shearing value of rivets, 107
Shear poles, stresses in, 98
Sheaves, block,
number
of,
654
Sheer, 210
Shellac,
Sagging, 298
447
448
of,
Rudders, 274
per, 312,
288
plugs
INDEX
Shell plating, stresses in, 297, 298
Shelter deck vessels, 239, 240
freeboard
of,
216
calculations, 166-233
chartering, 703
construction, systems of, 253
equipment, 615
Ship
Ship
Ship
Ship
735
Shipping weight, 1
Shipping weights of lumber, 18
Shunt motors, 561
Shutting off boilers, 386
Side girders, 262
Side wheel steamers, data on, 313, 314,
315
Signal lights, 546
Signal wires, 546
Signals, Ardois, 566
Silicon steel, 113
Simpson's first rule, 34
Simpson's second rule, 35
Sine of an angle, 40
Sines, table of, 43
Sinks, 607
Skylights, 286, 287
Slide valve, 394, 399
Sluice valves, 602, 606
Societies, classification, 234
Soft coal, sizes of, 352
600
224
Speed
table,
434
Sphere, measures
of,
36
of,
of, 36,
36,
37
37
694
of oil carriers, 320,
Stack, area
rake
of,
of,
684
363
680
287
Stanchions, 268
342
cut-off,
405
INDEX
736
Steam
in con-
in turbines,
405
405
steam pressure
expansion
fittings
in,
and
in,
of,
404, 405
411
accessories,
405
456
cut-off
Steam expansion,
cut-off, 395,
371
off,
414
400
lead, 400
lap,
439
421
404
421
receiver,
in cylinder,
lumber, 327
shallow draft, 328
Steel, carbon, 112, 114,
116
405
number
of
expansions by volumes,
elongation
of,
112, 116, 72
manganese, 112
405
operating, 419
496
operating cost,
paddle wheel, 314, 329, 397
nickel, 113,
pistons, 414
silicon,
properties
of,
111, 116, 72
72
113
INDEX
Steel, tungsten, 113
vanadium, 114
Steel bars, flat, weights of, 149
weights, circumferences and areas
737
Strength of ship
of timber, 74
of tubes,
91
formula
of,
fittings,
for,
90
pipe, 507
structural, of vessels, 294
143
of
wrought iron
ultimate, 71
70
Stress,
Steel heads,
maximum
sizes of,
128
maximum
sizes of,
128
ordering, 130
pickling
weights
of,
an inch, 122
in lOOths of
and
624
618
Stem, 272, 116
Stephenson valve mechanism, 402
Stern frame, 272, 116, 698
Stern tube, 273
Stern wheel engines, 329, 397
Stern wheel vessels, 329
Stokeholds, ventilators to, 579
of
oil,
in barrels,
Am.
See Condensers
298
268
Stroke, steam pressure at end of, 404,
405
Structural details, 253
Structural features, merchant vessels,
238
Stringers,
Surfaces of solids, 36
Stowage
poles,
in materials, 71, 73
Steel plates,
and shear
98
685
Swivels, 657
686
Tackles, 650
INDEX
738
Tees, 140, 141
Timon
Tin, 155, 72
344
stack, 393, 421
uptake, 393, 421
shipping, 2
Tonnage,
length
of eye bolts, 95
96
165
293
96
of steel forgings, 113
of superheaters, 383
of lag screws,
of shackles, 95,
560
97
Timers, 487
169
transverse
for,
120, 523
Tension in hoisting rope, 634
Tests, for carbon steel, 112, 114
for cast steel, 118
for rivet steel, 117
for steel plates, 114, 116
for steel shapes, 114
of turnbuckles,
gross, 169
net, 169
of turbo-generator sets,
of steam,
of hooks, 94,
charter, 705
Triangle, area
of,
447
33
of, 41
Trigonometry, 39
Trigonometric formulae, 42
Trigonometric functions, 40
Trim, 190
moment to alter, 190, 192
Triangles, solution
in,
278
Troy weight, 1
Trunk vessels, 243
Tubes, brass, 511, 514
bursting, formula for, 90, 518
cleaning boiler, 387
copper, 511, 513, 514, 519
trade customs, 507
Tugs, construction of wood, 282
data on, 314, 315
Tungsten steel, 113
<
.;
$$!%
f ;
INDEX
Tunnel, draining
of,
Vanadium
604
444
Versed sine
an angle, 40
of
Viscosity of
oil,
356, 359
Volt, 531
Voltages, 532
Voltmeter, 543
Volumes of solids, 36
Voyage policy, 713
vessels,
for,
243
673
421, 454
to find, 455
See also Trials
Vacuum,
con-
denser, 456
in boilers, 371,
per
lb. of coal,
606
377
moment
throttle, 414
Valve travel, 401
and
drain, 415
of inertia of,
of,
375
349
457, 421
Water plane, center of gravity
coefficient of fineness, 171
376
stop,
of oil
boats
sluice, 602,
of engine
War
Ultimate strength, 71
Unions, 526
Unvalued policy, 713
safety,
575
room, 579
steamers, 578
air required,
S.
Varnish, 288
Ventilation, 575
679
for,
U.
114
steel,
Vaporizers, 482
in,
hydraulic transmitter
739
of,
of,
449,
51
176
INDEX
740
Watt, 531
equivalent value
Wattmeter, 543
Wave
23
of,
forming, 225
and
gauges
running
126,
i.h.p.,
sawing
Wood
Wood
of propellers,
of,
steel bars,
143
127
of, 74,
160
290
282
inch,
on, 507
508, 509
iron pipe columns, safe loads
of,
Wrought
for, 88,
Wrought
an
159, 160
157
vessels,
tables
of,
326
and
157
iron,
356
of steel plates
87
310
432
of square and round
of,
for, 85,
288
filler,
primer, 288
of miscellaneous units, 19
oils,
columns, formulae
304
of oil carriers,
Wood
of materials, 13
of
533
steamer, 547
Wiring gasoline engines, 551
Wiring systems, electric, 539
grain
of lumber, 18
per
of,
545
of logs, 18
of machinery, 304,
of,
cone head
of
538
of,
measurement
rivets, 110
copper sheets and plates,
127
of Diesel engines, 309
effect of moving, 203
of engines, 305, 306
of flat steel bars, 149
of fire bars, 307
of fire bricks, 307
of hulls, 303, 310
formulae for, 302
of lag screws, 292
of
of,
534, 535
Weight, of water, 8
in Scotch boiler, 307
Weight curve of a vessel, 294, 295
Weights, of a battleship, 247
of boiler covering, 307
of boilers, 306, 370
of brass sheets
638, 639
of,
89
91
122
of structural shapes, 129
of water tube boilers, 308
Well deck vessel, 230
Wet steam, 343
Wetted surface, 172, 421
Whale boats, 673
Whips, 650
Winches, 626, 629
Windlasses, 624
Wire rope, 637
hemp clad, 636, 637
measuring of, 640
Wire rope blocks, 648
of,
142
Zinc, 155, 72
THIS BOOK
AN INITIAL FINE OF
25
CENTS
:!..
44
.3fiJ
*5onBj
f-f-
JUN
w^MB%
s.^t
LD
21-100m-12,'43 (8796s)
Y3 51729
3G(2.6T?
Hs
THE UNIVERSITY OF CALIFORNIA LIBRARY